mirror of
https://github.com/zoriya/vim.git
synced 2025-12-25 00:25:21 +00:00
Compare commits
271 Commits
| Author | SHA1 | Date | |
|---|---|---|---|
|
|
321a9ec680 | ||
|
|
09ba6d766b | ||
|
|
52cc266dae | ||
|
|
21691f896a | ||
|
|
34feacbcce | ||
|
|
32c8f1cb19 | ||
|
|
60ec5f35a5 | ||
|
|
57e4ee4d38 | ||
|
|
a54bf40017 | ||
|
|
9750bb199e | ||
|
|
0f9d0869c7 | ||
|
|
81484f4215 | ||
|
|
15d55dec03 | ||
|
|
862cfa356d | ||
|
|
2a94225c23 | ||
|
|
f135435f80 | ||
|
|
2e18a12780 | ||
|
|
97d4ea71d6 | ||
|
|
f4f1956724 | ||
|
|
2df58b4a58 | ||
|
|
9411615985 | ||
|
|
d4ad0d4e21 | ||
|
|
b347963869 | ||
|
|
dd53a41553 | ||
|
|
442b5c48fd | ||
|
|
8866d277c9 | ||
|
|
02e14d67b9 | ||
|
|
7854e3abcf | ||
|
|
c83a44bf8f | ||
|
|
ff8cf2be66 | ||
|
|
fe9fb927ae | ||
|
|
7331304fd3 | ||
|
|
ef6585abef | ||
|
|
77642c0fef | ||
|
|
65d7396cb4 | ||
|
|
8d4eecc5e8 | ||
|
|
d59762dcb6 | ||
|
|
c0d4759373 | ||
|
|
7c5f120410 | ||
|
|
8288149866 | ||
|
|
0ac24e1ef4 | ||
|
|
b031626427 | ||
|
|
99a547d3a1 | ||
|
|
97d62497f5 | ||
|
|
41b884b273 | ||
|
|
b826ddb034 | ||
|
|
3ab72c5c72 | ||
|
|
e3a2246227 | ||
|
|
9c9cbf1351 | ||
|
|
12a753a5ca | ||
|
|
95e09eaaad | ||
|
|
a80888d296 | ||
|
|
17aa8cc255 | ||
|
|
a9a2d8f4d0 | ||
|
|
707cfb82dc | ||
|
|
f00dc2627b | ||
|
|
e8d8fd2add | ||
|
|
3a0d8090b1 | ||
|
|
67a4f6cfb4 | ||
|
|
faca84059a | ||
|
|
cfb807026f | ||
|
|
bffa06ddb8 | ||
|
|
003d14a267 | ||
|
|
c4b98fbb3e | ||
|
|
f3408e76fb | ||
|
|
b6101cf77f | ||
|
|
2d17fa3ebd | ||
|
|
9f340fa57b | ||
|
|
205f9f5e2d | ||
|
|
b88adbf844 | ||
|
|
dac7569612 | ||
|
|
d04da7cb4a | ||
|
|
7bc4f93c07 | ||
|
|
172ddb60c2 | ||
|
|
b73568149f | ||
|
|
0c17875ef3 | ||
|
|
b35c338f96 | ||
|
|
0c5fa7d740 | ||
|
|
d1f13fd597 | ||
|
|
4ccb265bd4 | ||
|
|
7d11244c99 | ||
|
|
97cc2384c0 | ||
|
|
14f5827940 | ||
|
|
8139889a5f | ||
|
|
6f3d6b48a6 | ||
|
|
e1704bada4 | ||
|
|
b213da0b57 | ||
|
|
ec3cfeb199 | ||
|
|
1e91f2606b | ||
|
|
718f007499 | ||
|
|
d09acef44b | ||
|
|
66b7985ec9 | ||
|
|
770456589e | ||
|
|
696c2116dc | ||
|
|
f94a13c286 | ||
|
|
01c10524d2 | ||
|
|
f5fe79a5f3 | ||
|
|
6f586de755 | ||
|
|
2b017fae8f | ||
|
|
4fabd7dd4a | ||
|
|
be1e9e9fc1 | ||
|
|
2623b4f412 | ||
|
|
e8cdcef875 | ||
|
|
fca93c093e | ||
|
|
c11073c9aa | ||
|
|
afa6b9af86 | ||
|
|
cdab905136 | ||
|
|
77fceb8908 | ||
|
|
e48a2dd3af | ||
|
|
231e1a1723 | ||
|
|
e2db4361d2 | ||
|
|
ac0ddc15e9 | ||
|
|
7c0a86b1e8 | ||
|
|
b4a80cdd91 | ||
|
|
7c82130a76 | ||
|
|
2c66669c33 | ||
|
|
57c0ea8692 | ||
|
|
465748e411 | ||
|
|
dd7d846475 | ||
|
|
0551410a14 | ||
|
|
3633dc0129 | ||
|
|
8f91399366 | ||
|
|
002a4edc5b | ||
|
|
18a1b9bd5f | ||
|
|
c6c1d8b802 | ||
|
|
1c75a03501 | ||
|
|
451cf63751 | ||
|
|
00b8ae0d3d | ||
|
|
dde0efed85 | ||
|
|
4d93dc2699 | ||
|
|
b9ce83e135 | ||
|
|
9b4512500a | ||
|
|
dd82d699c8 | ||
|
|
2b9578f0f8 | ||
|
|
2430586629 | ||
|
|
2dac213ac6 | ||
|
|
14f2474147 | ||
|
|
b02612b641 | ||
|
|
07e31c571a | ||
|
|
c1a995db49 | ||
|
|
ba6ba36fa2 | ||
|
|
04b2751899 | ||
|
|
c271c48e80 | ||
|
|
e66822e3d1 | ||
|
|
09168a77e4 | ||
|
|
da3cb831e9 | ||
|
|
e4195c5d84 | ||
|
|
8a0f3c78fe | ||
|
|
a07c831bef | ||
|
|
dad937f77f | ||
|
|
6c35beaa11 | ||
|
|
848f87633a | ||
|
|
0cbba94b7e | ||
|
|
9bdb9a0987 | ||
|
|
5fb9ec5ed7 | ||
|
|
9581b5f70e | ||
|
|
641e286153 | ||
|
|
058bdcfd5d | ||
|
|
6763c140d6 | ||
|
|
049d8e79cf | ||
|
|
94c465c53d | ||
|
|
1a0cee53d4 | ||
|
|
b5c9cb555e | ||
|
|
bdb620560b | ||
|
|
c2ece10274 | ||
|
|
97f38d9540 | ||
|
|
30b6581799 | ||
|
|
dfef15481d | ||
|
|
89af439409 | ||
|
|
cfa3caec0c | ||
|
|
c0885aad5c | ||
|
|
f65e5667df | ||
|
|
773c1ef81b | ||
|
|
52bf469f6f | ||
|
|
77c604d3ff | ||
|
|
6c4b646d84 | ||
|
|
8cb8dca2f0 | ||
|
|
0306ac33a5 | ||
|
|
bef4790c23 | ||
|
|
756287da38 | ||
|
|
e25865a7f3 | ||
|
|
95b557b1dc | ||
|
|
5967abb97f | ||
|
|
221d6872c4 | ||
|
|
e721122b79 | ||
|
|
49346f4155 | ||
|
|
cc3e85f169 | ||
|
|
3cd3e7ab17 | ||
|
|
2afa3238a1 | ||
|
|
f27839c1a9 | ||
|
|
11b73d668f | ||
|
|
96b7ca5142 | ||
|
|
89f940fcac | ||
|
|
e79abddb2f | ||
|
|
88b1ba151a | ||
|
|
a53c60d33c | ||
|
|
f6a2b08c54 | ||
|
|
8f5c6f003a | ||
|
|
db91395312 | ||
|
|
a7014df975 | ||
|
|
002850940e | ||
|
|
22189a4bd6 | ||
|
|
3943156034 | ||
|
|
d12f811816 | ||
|
|
50a12b4078 | ||
|
|
38bdbd6c6f | ||
|
|
5e1a0a9a65 | ||
|
|
ed46560bf0 | ||
|
|
9158f9e423 | ||
|
|
dc7e85ee5d | ||
|
|
9e931224db | ||
|
|
36105782d2 | ||
|
|
77c193579b | ||
|
|
795ec43112 | ||
|
|
5641f38d41 | ||
|
|
bfe3bf806a | ||
|
|
a8596c4772 | ||
|
|
e04a48f204 | ||
|
|
48d279215f | ||
|
|
27ba088549 | ||
|
|
802053f14a | ||
|
|
3b393a0b53 | ||
|
|
362ce48048 | ||
|
|
3b53dfb3b0 | ||
|
|
ab984db296 | ||
|
|
08bc274e88 | ||
|
|
8134039744 | ||
|
|
bc256d91ea | ||
|
|
64fdf5ceae | ||
|
|
c873442b15 | ||
|
|
f13de07e49 | ||
|
|
24ee83b0a0 | ||
|
|
88178de99f | ||
|
|
9a920d8c31 | ||
|
|
704984ac87 | ||
|
|
d2aed44c77 | ||
|
|
112f318551 | ||
|
|
ae084bb97c | ||
|
|
6a3c1b44e5 | ||
|
|
6057b9c658 | ||
|
|
bef1c36ab6 | ||
|
|
936347b6bf | ||
|
|
0c50a6ba59 | ||
|
|
17bd9dc2bd | ||
|
|
1763969e5c | ||
|
|
8e52a59376 | ||
|
|
bd1d560895 | ||
|
|
455981e69b | ||
|
|
f9de140e7f | ||
|
|
2969570036 | ||
|
|
8a4c136a90 | ||
|
|
a0149c7401 | ||
|
|
1aeaf8c0e0 | ||
|
|
dbb4a42cdc | ||
|
|
18e00d2c86 | ||
|
|
2fc8802fcc | ||
|
|
8071607aa5 | ||
|
|
2d0b92f8f9 | ||
|
|
5ae636b9bb | ||
|
|
8320da42bc | ||
|
|
b41d9689f1 | ||
|
|
7da9c37a17 | ||
|
|
9a7224b5a0 | ||
|
|
e8938e507e | ||
|
|
ddbb5550b4 | ||
|
|
d38b055ab8 | ||
|
|
7f51a82c1b | ||
|
|
b429cdeb6e | ||
|
|
8218f60b61 | ||
|
|
68fb5dcd13 | ||
|
|
68a33fc704 |
3
.gitignore
vendored
3
.gitignore
vendored
@@ -30,6 +30,7 @@ src/auto/pathdef.c
|
||||
*.suo
|
||||
*.res
|
||||
*.RES
|
||||
src/if_perl.c
|
||||
src/pathdef.c
|
||||
src/Obj*/pathdef.c
|
||||
gvimext.dll
|
||||
@@ -41,11 +42,13 @@ gvimext.lib
|
||||
*.mo
|
||||
*.swp
|
||||
*~
|
||||
src/po/vim.pot
|
||||
|
||||
# Generated by "make test"
|
||||
src/po/*.ck
|
||||
src/testdir/mbyte.vim
|
||||
src/testdir/mzscheme.vim
|
||||
src/testdir/lua.vim
|
||||
src/testdir/small.vim
|
||||
src/testdir/tiny.vim
|
||||
src/testdir/test*.out
|
||||
|
||||
23
Filelist
23
Filelist
@@ -261,6 +261,7 @@ SRC_DOS = \
|
||||
src/Make_mvc.mak \
|
||||
src/Make_w16.mak \
|
||||
src/bigvim.bat \
|
||||
src/bigvim64.bat \
|
||||
src/msvcsetup.bat \
|
||||
src/msvc2008.bat \
|
||||
src/msvc2010.bat \
|
||||
@@ -349,6 +350,13 @@ SRC_DOS_BIN = \
|
||||
src/vim*.ico \
|
||||
src/vim.tlb \
|
||||
src/vimtbar.lib \
|
||||
src/xpm/COPYRIGHT \
|
||||
src/xpm/README.txt \
|
||||
src/xpm/include/*.h \
|
||||
src/xpm/x64/lib/libXpm.a \
|
||||
src/xpm/x64/lib/libXpm.lib \
|
||||
src/xpm/x86/lib/libXpm.a \
|
||||
src/xpm/x86/lib/libXpm.lib \
|
||||
src/vimtbar.dll \
|
||||
nsis/icons/*.bmp \
|
||||
nsis/icons/*.ico \
|
||||
@@ -463,6 +471,7 @@ RT_ALL = \
|
||||
runtime/macros/hanoi/hanoi.vim \
|
||||
runtime/macros/hanoi/poster \
|
||||
runtime/macros/justify.vim \
|
||||
runtime/macros/less.bat \
|
||||
runtime/macros/less.sh \
|
||||
runtime/macros/less.vim \
|
||||
runtime/macros/life/click.me \
|
||||
@@ -666,6 +675,8 @@ EXTRA = \
|
||||
|
||||
# generic language files
|
||||
LANG_GEN = \
|
||||
runtime/doc/*-de.1 \
|
||||
runtime/doc/*-de.UTF-8.1 \
|
||||
runtime/doc/*-fr.1 \
|
||||
runtime/doc/*-fr.UTF-8.1 \
|
||||
runtime/doc/*-it.1 \
|
||||
@@ -682,9 +693,17 @@ LANG_GEN = \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/Makefile \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.utf-8 \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.?? \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.??.* \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.??.utf-8 \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.??.euc \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.??.sjis \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.??.iso9 \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.??.big5 \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.??.cp1250 \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.??.cp1251 \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.??.cp737 \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.??_??.utf-8 \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.bar \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.bar.* \
|
||||
runtime/tutor/tutor.bar.utf-8 \
|
||||
runtime/spell/README.txt \
|
||||
runtime/spell/??/*.diff \
|
||||
runtime/spell/??/main.aap \
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -97,10 +97,12 @@ The latest news about Vim can be found on the Vim home page:
|
||||
If you have problems, have a look at the Vim FAQ:
|
||||
http://vimdoc.sf.net/vimfaq.html
|
||||
|
||||
Send bug reports to:
|
||||
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
|
||||
If you still have problems or any other questions, use one of the mailing
|
||||
lists to discuss them with Vim users and developers:
|
||||
http://www.vim.org/maillist.php
|
||||
|
||||
There are several mailing lists for Vim, see http://www.vim.org/maillist.php.
|
||||
If nothing else works, report bugs directly:
|
||||
Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
MAIN AUTHOR
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -29,6 +29,8 @@
|
||||
if version < 700
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
" Section: Constants {{{1
|
||||
"
|
||||
@@ -619,6 +621,9 @@ lockvar g:ada#Comment
|
||||
lockvar! g:ada#Keywords
|
||||
lockvar! g:ada#Ctags_Kinds
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
finish " 1}}}
|
||||
|
||||
"------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Vim completion script
|
||||
" Language: C
|
||||
" Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2011 Dec 30
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Jun 20
|
||||
|
||||
let s:cpo_save = &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
@@ -500,7 +500,7 @@ function! s:StructMembers(typename, items, all)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
if !cached
|
||||
while 1
|
||||
exe 'silent! ' . n . 'vimgrep /\t' . typename . '\(\t\|$\)/j ' . fnames
|
||||
exe 'silent! keepj noautocmd ' . n . 'vimgrep /\t' . typename . '\(\t\|$\)/j ' . fnames
|
||||
|
||||
let qflist = getqflist()
|
||||
if len(qflist) > 0 || match(typename, "::") < 0
|
||||
|
||||
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
@@ -106,7 +106,7 @@ fun! netrwSettings#NetrwSettings()
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_browsex_viewer = (not defined)'
|
||||
endif
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_compress = '.g:netrw_compress
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_cursorline = '.g:netrw_cursorline
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_cursor = '.g:netrw_cursor
|
||||
let decompressline= line("$")
|
||||
put ='let g:netrw_decompress...'
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_dirhistmax = '.g:netrw_dirhistmax
|
||||
@@ -125,9 +125,9 @@ fun! netrwSettings#NetrwSettings()
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_list_hide = '.g:netrw_list_hide
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_liststyle = '.g:netrw_liststyle
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_localcopycmd = '.g:netrw_localcopycmd
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_local_mkdir = '.g:netrw_local_mkdir
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_localmkdir = '.g:netrw_localmkdir
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_localmovecmd = '.g:netrw_localmovecmd
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_local_rmdir = '.g:netrw_local_rmdir
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_localrmdir = '.g:netrw_localrmdir
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_maxfilenamelen = '.g:netrw_maxfilenamelen
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_menu = '.g:netrw_menu
|
||||
put = 'let g:netrw_mkdir_cmd = '.g:netrw_mkdir_cmd
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,23 +1,43 @@
|
||||
" Vim OMNI completion script for SQL
|
||||
" Language: SQL
|
||||
" Maintainer: David Fishburn <dfishburn dot vim at gmail dot com>
|
||||
" Version: 12.0
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Feb 08
|
||||
" Version: 14.0
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Dec 04
|
||||
" Homepage: http://www.vim.org/scripts/script.php?script_id=1572
|
||||
" Usage: For detailed help
|
||||
" ":help sql.txt"
|
||||
" or ":help ft-sql-omni"
|
||||
" or read $VIMRUNTIME/doc/sql.txt
|
||||
|
||||
" History
|
||||
" Version 12.0
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 14.0 (Dec 2012)
|
||||
" - BF: Added check for cpo
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 13.0 (Dec 2012)
|
||||
" - NF: When completing column lists or drilling into a table
|
||||
" and g:omni_sql_include_owner is enabled, the
|
||||
" only the table name would be replaced with the column
|
||||
" list instead of the table name and owner (if specified).
|
||||
" - NF: When completing column lists using table aliases
|
||||
" and g:omni_sql_include_owner is enabled, account
|
||||
" for the owner name when looking up the table
|
||||
" list instead of the table name and owner (if specified).
|
||||
" - BF: When completing column lists or drilling into a table
|
||||
" and g:omni_sql_include_owner is enabled, the
|
||||
" column list could often not be found for the table.
|
||||
" - BF: When OMNI popped up, possibly the wrong word
|
||||
" would be replaced for column and column list options.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 12.0 (Feb 2012)
|
||||
" - Partial column name completion did not work when a table
|
||||
" name or table alias was provided (Jonas Enberg).
|
||||
" - Improved the handling of column completion. First we match any
|
||||
" columns from a previous completion. If not matches are found, we
|
||||
" consider the partial name to be a table or table alias for the
|
||||
" consider the partial name to be a table or table alias for the
|
||||
" query and attempt to match on it.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 11.0
|
||||
" Version 11.0 (Jan 2012)
|
||||
" Added g:omni_sql_default_compl_type variable
|
||||
" - You can specify which type of completion to default to
|
||||
" when pressing <C-X><C-O>. The entire list of available
|
||||
@@ -40,7 +60,7 @@
|
||||
" - Prepends error message with SQLComplete so you know who issued
|
||||
" the error.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 9.0
|
||||
" Version 9.0 (May 2010)
|
||||
" This change removes some of the support for tables with spaces in their
|
||||
" names in order to simplify the regexes used to pull out query table
|
||||
" aliases for more robust table name and column name code completion.
|
||||
@@ -51,10 +71,10 @@
|
||||
" Incorrectly re-executed the g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key_right and g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key_left
|
||||
" when drilling in and out of a column list for a table.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 7.0
|
||||
" Version 7.0 (Jan 2010)
|
||||
" Better handling of object names
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 6.0
|
||||
" Version 6.0 (Apr 2008)
|
||||
" Supports object names with spaces "my table name"
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Set completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O to autoloaded function.
|
||||
@@ -71,7 +91,9 @@ endif
|
||||
if exists('g:loaded_sql_completion')
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let g:loaded_sql_completion = 120
|
||||
let g:loaded_sql_completion = 130
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
" Maintains filename of dictionary
|
||||
let s:sql_file_table = ""
|
||||
@@ -137,6 +159,13 @@ if !exists('g:omni_sql_default_compl_type')
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" This function is used for the 'omnifunc' option.
|
||||
" It is called twice by omni and it is responsible
|
||||
" for returning the completion list of items.
|
||||
" But it must also determine context of what to complete
|
||||
" and what to "replace" with the completion.
|
||||
" The a:base, is replaced directly with what the user
|
||||
" chooses from the choices.
|
||||
" The s:prepend provides context for the completion.
|
||||
function! sqlcomplete#Complete(findstart, base)
|
||||
|
||||
" Default to table name completion
|
||||
@@ -145,6 +174,7 @@ function! sqlcomplete#Complete(findstart, base)
|
||||
if exists('b:sql_compl_type')
|
||||
let compl_type = b:sql_compl_type
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let begindot = 0
|
||||
|
||||
" First pass through this function determines how much of the line should
|
||||
" be replaced by whatever is chosen from the completion list
|
||||
@@ -153,7 +183,6 @@ function! sqlcomplete#Complete(findstart, base)
|
||||
let line = getline('.')
|
||||
let start = col('.') - 1
|
||||
let lastword = -1
|
||||
let begindot = 0
|
||||
" Check if the first character is a ".", for column completion
|
||||
if line[start - 1] == '.'
|
||||
let begindot = 1
|
||||
@@ -179,7 +208,10 @@ function! sqlcomplete#Complete(findstart, base)
|
||||
" If lastword has already been set for column completion
|
||||
" break from the loop, since we do not also want to pickup
|
||||
" a table name if it was also supplied.
|
||||
" Unless g:omni_sql_include_owner == 1, then we can
|
||||
" include the ownername.
|
||||
if lastword != -1 && compl_type == 'column'
|
||||
\ && g:omni_sql_include_owner == 0
|
||||
break
|
||||
endif
|
||||
" If column completion was specified stop at the "." if
|
||||
@@ -191,7 +223,7 @@ function! sqlcomplete#Complete(findstart, base)
|
||||
" If omni_sql_include_owner = 0, do not include the table
|
||||
" name as part of the substitution, so break here
|
||||
if lastword == -1 &&
|
||||
\ compl_type =~ 'table\|view\|procedure\column_csv' &&
|
||||
\ compl_type =~ '\<\(table\|view\|procedure\|column\|column_csv\)\>' &&
|
||||
\ g:omni_sql_include_owner == 0
|
||||
let lastword = start
|
||||
break
|
||||
@@ -288,6 +320,12 @@ function! sqlcomplete#Complete(findstart, base)
|
||||
let table = matchstr( base, '^\(.*\.\)\?\zs.*\ze\..*' )
|
||||
let column = matchstr( base, '.*\.\zs.*' )
|
||||
|
||||
if g:omni_sql_include_owner == 1 && owner == '' && table != '' && column != ''
|
||||
let owner = table
|
||||
let table = column
|
||||
let column = ''
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" It is pretty well impossible to determine if the user
|
||||
" has entered:
|
||||
" owner.table
|
||||
@@ -370,7 +408,16 @@ function! sqlcomplete#Complete(findstart, base)
|
||||
let list_type = 'csv'
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let compl_list = s:SQLCGetColumns(table, list_type)
|
||||
" If we are including the OWNER for the objects, then for
|
||||
" table completion, if we have it, it should be included
|
||||
" as there can be the same table names in a database yet
|
||||
" with different owner names.
|
||||
if g:omni_sql_include_owner == 1 && owner != '' && table != ''
|
||||
let compl_list = s:SQLCGetColumns(owner.'.'.table, list_type)
|
||||
else
|
||||
let compl_list = s:SQLCGetColumns(table, list_type)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
if column != ''
|
||||
" If no column prefix has been provided and the table
|
||||
" name was provided, append it to each of the items
|
||||
@@ -393,11 +440,14 @@ function! sqlcomplete#Complete(findstart, base)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
elseif compl_type == 'resetCache'
|
||||
" Reset all cached items
|
||||
let s:tbl_name = []
|
||||
let s:tbl_alias = []
|
||||
let s:tbl_cols = []
|
||||
let s:syn_list = []
|
||||
let s:syn_value = []
|
||||
let s:tbl_name = []
|
||||
let s:tbl_alias = []
|
||||
let s:tbl_cols = []
|
||||
let s:syn_list = []
|
||||
let s:syn_value = []
|
||||
let s:sql_file_table = ""
|
||||
let s:sql_file_procedure = ""
|
||||
let s:sql_file_view = ""
|
||||
|
||||
let msg = "All SQL cached items have been removed."
|
||||
call s:SQLCWarningMsg(msg)
|
||||
@@ -423,12 +473,27 @@ function! sqlcomplete#Complete(findstart, base)
|
||||
" let expr = 'v:val '.(g:omni_sql_ignorecase==1?'=~?':'=~#').' "\\(^'.base.'\\|\\(\\.\\)\\?'.base.'\\)"'
|
||||
" let expr = 'v:val '.(g:omni_sql_ignorecase==1?'=~?':'=~#').' "\\(^'.base.'\\|\\([^.]*\\)\\?'.base.'\\)"'
|
||||
let compl_list = filter(deepcopy(compl_list), expr)
|
||||
|
||||
if empty(compl_list) && compl_type == 'table' && base =~ '\.$'
|
||||
" It is possible we could be looking for column name completion
|
||||
" and the user simply hit C-X C-O to lets try it as well
|
||||
" since we had no hits with the tables.
|
||||
" If the base ends with a . it is hard to know if we are
|
||||
" completing table names or column names.
|
||||
let list_type = ''
|
||||
|
||||
let compl_list = s:SQLCGetColumns(base, list_type)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
if exists('b:sql_compl_savefunc') && b:sql_compl_savefunc != ""
|
||||
let &omnifunc = b:sql_compl_savefunc
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
if empty(compl_list)
|
||||
call s:SQLCWarningMsg( 'Could not find type['.compl_type.'] using prepend[.'.s:prepended.'] base['.a:base.']' )
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
return compl_list
|
||||
endfunc
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -664,8 +729,26 @@ function! s:SQLCGetObjectOwner(object)
|
||||
endfunction
|
||||
|
||||
function! s:SQLCGetColumns(table_name, list_type)
|
||||
if a:table_name =~ '\.'
|
||||
" Check if the owner/creator has been specified
|
||||
let owner = matchstr( a:table_name, '^\zs.*\ze\..*\..*' )
|
||||
let table = matchstr( a:table_name, '^\(.*\.\)\?\zs.*\ze\..*' )
|
||||
let column = matchstr( a:table_name, '.*\.\zs.*' )
|
||||
|
||||
if g:omni_sql_include_owner == 1 && owner == '' && table != '' && column != ''
|
||||
let owner = table
|
||||
let table = column
|
||||
let column = ''
|
||||
endif
|
||||
else
|
||||
let owner = ''
|
||||
let table = matchstr(a:table_name, '^["\[\]a-zA-Z0-9_ ]\+\ze\.\?')
|
||||
let column = ''
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Check if the table name was provided as part of the column name
|
||||
let table_name = matchstr(a:table_name, '^["\[\]a-zA-Z0-9_ ]\+\ze\.\?')
|
||||
" let table_name = matchstr(a:table_name, '^["\[\]a-zA-Z0-9_ ]\+\ze\.\?')
|
||||
let table_name = table
|
||||
let table_cols = []
|
||||
let table_alias = ''
|
||||
let move_to_top = 1
|
||||
@@ -786,7 +869,12 @@ function! s:SQLCGetColumns(table_name, list_type)
|
||||
|
||||
if table_name_new != ''
|
||||
let table_alias = table_name
|
||||
let table_name = matchstr( table_name_new, '^\(.*\.\)\?\zs.*\ze' )
|
||||
if g:omni_sql_include_owner == 1
|
||||
let table_name = matchstr( table_name_new, '^\zs\(.\{-}\.\)\?\(.\{-}\.\)\?.*\ze' )
|
||||
else
|
||||
" let table_name = matchstr( table_name_new, '^\(.*\.\)\?\zs.*\ze' )
|
||||
let table_name = matchstr( table_name_new, '^\(.\{-}\.\)\?\zs\(.\{-}\.\)\?.*\ze' )
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let list_idx = index(s:tbl_name, table_name, 0, &ignorecase)
|
||||
if list_idx > -1
|
||||
@@ -828,7 +916,8 @@ function! s:SQLCGetColumns(table_name, list_type)
|
||||
if empty(table_cols)
|
||||
" Specify silent mode, no messages to the user (tbl, 1)
|
||||
" Specify do not comma separate (tbl, 1, 1)
|
||||
let table_cols_str = DB_getListColumn(table_name, 1, 1)
|
||||
" let table_cols_str = DB_getListColumn(table_name, 1, 1)
|
||||
let table_cols_str = DB_getListColumn((owner!=''?owner.'.':'').table_name, 1, 1)
|
||||
|
||||
if table_cols_str != ""
|
||||
let s:tbl_name = add( s:tbl_name, table_name )
|
||||
@@ -854,3 +943,7 @@ function! s:SQLCGetColumns(table_name, list_type)
|
||||
|
||||
return table_cols
|
||||
endfunction
|
||||
" Restore:
|
||||
let &cpo= s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
" vim: ts=4 fdm=marker
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,12 +1,32 @@
|
||||
" Vim completion script
|
||||
" Language: All languages, uses existing syntax highlighting rules
|
||||
" Maintainer: David Fishburn <dfishburn dot vim at gmail dot com>
|
||||
" Version: 8.0
|
||||
" Last Change: 2011 Nov 02
|
||||
" Usage: For detailed help, ":help ft-syntax-omni"
|
||||
" Version: 11.0
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Dec 04
|
||||
" Usage: For detailed help, ":help ft-syntax-omni"
|
||||
|
||||
" History
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 11.0
|
||||
" Corrected which characters required escaping during
|
||||
" substitution calls.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 10.0
|
||||
" Cycle through all the character ranges specified in the
|
||||
" iskeyword option and build a list of valid word separators.
|
||||
" Prior to this change, only actual characters were used,
|
||||
" where for example ASCII "45" == "-". If "45" were used
|
||||
" in iskeyword the hyphen would not be picked up.
|
||||
" This introduces a new option, since the character ranges
|
||||
" specified could be multibyte:
|
||||
" let g:omni_syntax_use_single_byte = 1
|
||||
" This by default will only allow single byte ASCII
|
||||
" characters to be added and an additional check to ensure
|
||||
" the charater is printable (see documentation for isprint).
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 9.0
|
||||
" Add the check for cpo.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 8.0
|
||||
" Updated SyntaxCSyntaxGroupItems()
|
||||
" - Some additional syntax items were also allowed
|
||||
@@ -16,7 +36,7 @@
|
||||
" Version 7.0
|
||||
" Updated syntaxcomplete#OmniSyntaxList()
|
||||
" - Looking up the syntax groups defined from a syntax file
|
||||
" looked for only 1 format of {filetype}GroupName, but some
|
||||
" looked for only 1 format of {filetype}GroupName, but some
|
||||
" syntax writers use this format as well:
|
||||
" {b:current_syntax}GroupName
|
||||
" OmniSyntaxList() will now check for both if the first
|
||||
@@ -24,11 +44,11 @@
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 6.0
|
||||
" Added syntaxcomplete#OmniSyntaxList()
|
||||
" - Allows other plugins to use this for their own
|
||||
" - Allows other plugins to use this for their own
|
||||
" purposes.
|
||||
" - It will return a List of all syntax items for the
|
||||
" syntax group name passed in.
|
||||
" - XPTemplate for SQL will use this function via the
|
||||
" syntax group name passed in.
|
||||
" - XPTemplate for SQL will use this function via the
|
||||
" sqlcomplete plugin to populate a Choose box.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 5.0
|
||||
@@ -38,7 +58,7 @@
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Set completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O to autoloaded function.
|
||||
" This check is in place in case this script is
|
||||
" sourced directly instead of using the autoload feature.
|
||||
" sourced directly instead of using the autoload feature.
|
||||
if exists('+omnifunc')
|
||||
" Do not set the option if already set since this
|
||||
" results in an E117 warning.
|
||||
@@ -48,9 +68,13 @@ if exists('+omnifunc')
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
if exists('g:loaded_syntax_completion')
|
||||
finish
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let g:loaded_syntax_completion = 80
|
||||
let g:loaded_syntax_completion = 110
|
||||
|
||||
" Turn on support for line continuations when creating the script
|
||||
let s:cpo_save = &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
" Set ignorecase to the ftplugin standard
|
||||
" This is the default setting, but if you define a buffer local
|
||||
@@ -67,6 +91,18 @@ if !exists('g:omni_syntax_use_iskeyword')
|
||||
let g:omni_syntax_use_iskeyword = 1
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" When using iskeyword, this setting controls whether the characters
|
||||
" should be limited to single byte characters.
|
||||
if !exists('g:omni_syntax_use_single_byte')
|
||||
let g:omni_syntax_use_single_byte = 1
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" When using iskeyword, this setting controls whether the characters
|
||||
" should be limited to single byte characters.
|
||||
if !exists('g:omni_syntax_use_iskeyword_numeric')
|
||||
let g:omni_syntax_use_iskeyword_numeric = 1
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Only display items in the completion window that are at least
|
||||
" this many characters in length.
|
||||
" This is the default setting, but if you define a buffer local
|
||||
@@ -158,7 +194,7 @@ endfunc
|
||||
function! syntaxcomplete#OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
if a:0 > 0
|
||||
let parms = []
|
||||
if 3 == type(a:1)
|
||||
if 3 == type(a:1)
|
||||
let parms = a:1
|
||||
elseif 1 == type(a:1)
|
||||
let parms = split(a:1, ',')
|
||||
@@ -172,7 +208,7 @@ endfunc
|
||||
function! OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
let list_parms = []
|
||||
if a:0 > 0
|
||||
if 3 == type(a:1)
|
||||
if 3 == type(a:1)
|
||||
let list_parms = a:1
|
||||
elseif 1 == type(a:1)
|
||||
let list_parms = split(a:1, ',')
|
||||
@@ -208,18 +244,18 @@ function! OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
|
||||
let saveL = @l
|
||||
let filetype = substitute(&filetype, '\.', '_', 'g')
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
if empty(list_parms)
|
||||
" Default the include group to include the requested syntax group
|
||||
let syntax_group_include_{filetype} = ''
|
||||
" Check if there are any overrides specified for this filetype
|
||||
if exists('g:omni_syntax_group_include_'.filetype)
|
||||
let syntax_group_include_{filetype} =
|
||||
\ substitute( g:omni_syntax_group_include_{filetype},'\s\+','','g')
|
||||
\ substitute( g:omni_syntax_group_include_{filetype},'\s\+','','g')
|
||||
let list_parms = split(g:omni_syntax_group_include_{filetype}, ',')
|
||||
if syntax_group_include_{filetype} =~ '\w'
|
||||
let syntax_group_include_{filetype} =
|
||||
\ substitute( syntax_group_include_{filetype},
|
||||
let syntax_group_include_{filetype} =
|
||||
\ substitute( syntax_group_include_{filetype},
|
||||
\ '\s*,\s*', '\\|', 'g'
|
||||
\ )
|
||||
endif
|
||||
@@ -229,11 +265,11 @@ function! OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Loop through all the syntax groupnames, and build a
|
||||
" syntax file which contains these names. This can
|
||||
" syntax file which contains these names. This can
|
||||
" work generically for any filetype that does not already
|
||||
" have a plugin defined.
|
||||
" This ASSUMES the syntax groupname BEGINS with the name
|
||||
" of the filetype. From my casual viewing of the vim7\syntax
|
||||
" of the filetype. From my casual viewing of the vim7\syntax
|
||||
" directory this is true for almost all syntax definitions.
|
||||
" As an example, the SQL syntax groups have this pattern:
|
||||
" sqlType
|
||||
@@ -246,7 +282,7 @@ function! OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
let syntax_full = "\n".@l
|
||||
let @l = saveL
|
||||
|
||||
if syntax_full =~ 'E28'
|
||||
if syntax_full =~ 'E28'
|
||||
\ || syntax_full =~ 'E411'
|
||||
\ || syntax_full =~ 'E415'
|
||||
\ || syntax_full =~ 'No Syntax items'
|
||||
@@ -256,7 +292,7 @@ function! OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
let filetype = substitute(&filetype, '\.', '_', 'g')
|
||||
|
||||
let list_exclude_groups = []
|
||||
if a:0 > 0
|
||||
if a:0 > 0
|
||||
" Do nothing since we have specific a specific list of groups
|
||||
else
|
||||
" Default the exclude group to nothing
|
||||
@@ -264,11 +300,11 @@ function! OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
" Check if there are any overrides specified for this filetype
|
||||
if exists('g:omni_syntax_group_exclude_'.filetype)
|
||||
let syntax_group_exclude_{filetype} =
|
||||
\ substitute( g:omni_syntax_group_exclude_{filetype},'\s\+','','g')
|
||||
\ substitute( g:omni_syntax_group_exclude_{filetype},'\s\+','','g')
|
||||
let list_exclude_groups = split(g:omni_syntax_group_exclude_{filetype}, ',')
|
||||
if syntax_group_exclude_{filetype} =~ '\w'
|
||||
let syntax_group_exclude_{filetype} =
|
||||
\ substitute( syntax_group_exclude_{filetype},
|
||||
if syntax_group_exclude_{filetype} =~ '\w'
|
||||
let syntax_group_exclude_{filetype} =
|
||||
\ substitute( syntax_group_exclude_{filetype},
|
||||
\ '\s*,\s*', '\\|', 'g'
|
||||
\ )
|
||||
endif
|
||||
@@ -285,14 +321,14 @@ function! OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
while ftindex > -1
|
||||
let ft_part_name = matchstr( &filetype, '\w\+', ftindex )
|
||||
|
||||
" Syntax rules can contain items for more than just the current
|
||||
" Syntax rules can contain items for more than just the current
|
||||
" filetype. They can contain additional items added by the user
|
||||
" via autocmds or their vimrc.
|
||||
" Some syntax files can be combined (html, php, jsp).
|
||||
" We want only items that begin with the filetype we are interested in.
|
||||
let next_group_regex = '\n' .
|
||||
\ '\zs'.ft_part_name.'\w\+\ze'.
|
||||
\ '\s\+xxx\s\+'
|
||||
\ '\s\+xxx\s\+'
|
||||
let index = 0
|
||||
let index = match(syntax_full, next_group_regex, index)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -306,11 +342,11 @@ function! OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
" syn keyword {syntax_filename}Keyword values ...
|
||||
" let b:current_syntax = "mysql"
|
||||
" So, we will make the format of finding the syntax group names
|
||||
" a bit more flexible and look for both if the first fails to
|
||||
" a bit more flexible and look for both if the first fails to
|
||||
" find a match.
|
||||
let next_group_regex = '\n' .
|
||||
\ '\zs'.b:current_syntax.'\w\+\ze'.
|
||||
\ '\s\+xxx\s\+'
|
||||
\ '\s\+xxx\s\+'
|
||||
let index = 0
|
||||
let index = match(syntax_full, next_group_regex, index)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
@@ -324,9 +360,9 @@ function! OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
let get_syn_list = 0
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endfor
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
" This code is no longer needed in version 6.0 since we have
|
||||
" augmented the syntax list command to only retrieve the syntax
|
||||
" augmented the syntax list command to only retrieve the syntax
|
||||
" groups we are interested in.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" if get_syn_list == 1
|
||||
@@ -338,7 +374,7 @@ function! OmniSyntaxList(...)
|
||||
" endif
|
||||
|
||||
if get_syn_list == 1
|
||||
" Pass in the full syntax listing, plus the group name we
|
||||
" Pass in the full syntax listing, plus the group name we
|
||||
" are interested in.
|
||||
let extra_syn_list = s:SyntaxCSyntaxGroupItems(group_name, syntax_full)
|
||||
let syn_list = syn_list . extra_syn_list . "\n"
|
||||
@@ -392,7 +428,7 @@ function! s:SyntaxCSyntaxGroupItems( group_name, syntax_full )
|
||||
" \| - 2nd potential match
|
||||
" \%$ - matches end of the file or string
|
||||
" \) - end a group
|
||||
let syntax_group = matchstr(a:syntax_full,
|
||||
let syntax_group = matchstr(a:syntax_full,
|
||||
\ "\n".a:group_name.'\s\+xxx\s\+\zs.\{-}\ze\(\n\w\|\%$\)'
|
||||
\ )
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -402,42 +438,42 @@ function! s:SyntaxCSyntaxGroupItems( group_name, syntax_full )
|
||||
|
||||
" We only want the words for the lines begining with
|
||||
" containedin, but there could be other items.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
" Tried to remove all lines that do not begin with contained
|
||||
" but this does not work in all cases since you can have
|
||||
" contained nextgroup=...
|
||||
" So this will strip off the ending of lines with known
|
||||
" keywords.
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute(
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute(
|
||||
\ syntax_group, '\<\('.
|
||||
\ substitute(
|
||||
\ escape(s:syn_remove_words, '\\/.*$^~[]')
|
||||
\ , ',', '\\|', 'g'
|
||||
\ ).
|
||||
\ '\).\{-}\%($\|'."\n".'\)'
|
||||
\ , "\n", 'g'
|
||||
\ , "\n", 'g'
|
||||
\ )
|
||||
|
||||
" Now strip off the newline + blank space + contained.
|
||||
" Also include lines with nextgroup=@someName skip_key_words syntax_element
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute(
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute(
|
||||
\ syn_list, '\%(^\|\n\)\@<=\s*\<\(contained\|nextgroup=\)'
|
||||
\ , "", 'g'
|
||||
\ , "", 'g'
|
||||
\ )
|
||||
|
||||
" This can leave lines like this
|
||||
" =@vimMenuList skipwhite onoremenu
|
||||
" Strip the special option keywords first
|
||||
" :h :syn-skipwhite*
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute(
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute(
|
||||
\ syn_list, '\<\(skipwhite\|skipnl\|skipempty\)\>'
|
||||
\ , "", 'g'
|
||||
\ , "", 'g'
|
||||
\ )
|
||||
|
||||
" Now remove the remainder of the nextgroup=@someName lines
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute(
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute(
|
||||
\ syn_list, '\%(^\|\n\)\@<=\s*\(@\w\+\)'
|
||||
\ , "", 'g'
|
||||
\ , "", 'g'
|
||||
\ )
|
||||
|
||||
if b:omni_syntax_use_iskeyword == 0
|
||||
@@ -446,19 +482,74 @@ function! s:SyntaxCSyntaxGroupItems( group_name, syntax_full )
|
||||
" This will replace non-word characters with spaces.
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute( syn_list, '[^0-9A-Za-z_ ]', ' ', 'g' )
|
||||
else
|
||||
let accept_chars = ','.&iskeyword.','
|
||||
" Remove all character ranges
|
||||
" let accept_chars = substitute(accept_chars, ',[^,]\+-[^,]\+,', ',', 'g')
|
||||
let accept_chars = substitute(accept_chars, ',\@<=[^,]\+-[^,]\+,', '', 'g')
|
||||
" Remove all numeric specifications
|
||||
" let accept_chars = substitute(accept_chars, ',\d\{-},', ',', 'g')
|
||||
let accept_chars = substitute(accept_chars, ',\@<=\d\{-},', '', 'g')
|
||||
" Remove all commas
|
||||
let accept_chars = substitute(accept_chars, ',', '', 'g')
|
||||
" Escape special regex characters
|
||||
let accept_chars = escape(accept_chars, '\\/.*$^~[]' )
|
||||
" Remove all characters that are not acceptable
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute( syn_list, '[^0-9A-Za-z_ '.accept_chars.']', ' ', 'g' )
|
||||
if g:omni_syntax_use_iskeyword_numeric == 1
|
||||
" iskeyword can contain value like this
|
||||
" 38,42,43,45,47-58,60-62,64-90,97-122,_,+,-,*,/,%,<,=,>,:,$,?,!,@-@,94
|
||||
" Numeric values convert to their ASCII equivalent using the
|
||||
" nr2char() function.
|
||||
" & 38
|
||||
" * 42
|
||||
" + 43
|
||||
" - 45
|
||||
" ^ 94
|
||||
" Iterate through all numeric specifications and convert those
|
||||
" to their ascii equivalent ensuring the character is printable.
|
||||
" If so, add it to the list.
|
||||
let accepted_chars = ''
|
||||
for item in split(&iskeyword, ',')
|
||||
if item =~ '-'
|
||||
" This is a character range (ie 47-58),
|
||||
" cycle through each character within the range
|
||||
let [b:start, b:end] = split(item, '-')
|
||||
for range_item in range( b:start, b:end )
|
||||
if range_item <= 127 || g:omni_syntax_use_single_byte == 0
|
||||
if nr2char(range_item) =~ '\p'
|
||||
let accepted_chars = accepted_chars . nr2char(range_item)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endfor
|
||||
elseif item =~ '^\d\+$'
|
||||
" Only numeric, translate to a character
|
||||
if item < 127 || g:omni_syntax_use_single_byte == 0
|
||||
if nr2char(item) =~ '\p'
|
||||
let accepted_chars = accepted_chars . nr2char(item)
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endif
|
||||
else
|
||||
if char2nr(item) < 127 || g:omni_syntax_use_single_byte == 0
|
||||
if item =~ '\p'
|
||||
let accepted_chars = accepted_chars . item
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endfor
|
||||
" Escape special regex characters
|
||||
" Looks like the wrong chars are escaped. In a collection,
|
||||
" :h /[]
|
||||
" only `]', `\', `-' and `^' are special:
|
||||
" let accepted_chars = escape(accepted_chars, '\\/.*$^~[]' )
|
||||
let accepted_chars = escape(accepted_chars, ']\-^' )
|
||||
" Remove all characters that are not acceptable
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute( syn_list, '[^A-Za-z'.accepted_chars.']', ' ', 'g' )
|
||||
else
|
||||
let accept_chars = ','.&iskeyword.','
|
||||
" Remove all character ranges
|
||||
" let accept_chars = substitute(accept_chars, ',[^,]\+-[^,]\+,', ',', 'g')
|
||||
let accept_chars = substitute(accept_chars, ',\@<=[^,]\+-[^,]\+,', '', 'g')
|
||||
" Remove all numeric specifications
|
||||
" let accept_chars = substitute(accept_chars, ',\d\{-},', ',', 'g')
|
||||
let accept_chars = substitute(accept_chars, ',\@<=\d\{-},', '', 'g')
|
||||
" Remove all commas
|
||||
let accept_chars = substitute(accept_chars, ',', '', 'g')
|
||||
" Escape special regex characters
|
||||
" Looks like the wrong chars are escaped. In a collection,
|
||||
" :h /[]
|
||||
" only `]', `\', `-' and `^' are special:
|
||||
" let accept_chars = escape(accept_chars, '\\/.*$^~[]' )
|
||||
let accept_chars = escape(accept_chars, ']\-^' )
|
||||
" Remove all characters that are not acceptable
|
||||
let syn_list = substitute( syn_list, '[^0-9A-Za-z_'.accept_chars.']', ' ', 'g' )
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
if b:omni_syntax_minimum_length > 0
|
||||
@@ -471,3 +562,27 @@ function! s:SyntaxCSyntaxGroupItems( group_name, syntax_full )
|
||||
|
||||
return syn_list
|
||||
endfunction
|
||||
|
||||
function! OmniSyntaxShowChars(spec)
|
||||
let result = []
|
||||
for item in split(a:spec, ',')
|
||||
if len(item) > 1
|
||||
if item == '@-@'
|
||||
call add(result, char2nr(item))
|
||||
else
|
||||
call extend(result, call('range', split(item, '-')))
|
||||
endif
|
||||
else
|
||||
if item == '@' " assume this is [A-Za-z]
|
||||
for [c1, c2] in [['A', 'Z'], ['a', 'z']]
|
||||
call extend(result, range(char2nr(c1), char2nr(c2)))
|
||||
endfor
|
||||
else
|
||||
call add(result, char2nr(item))
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endfor
|
||||
return join(map(result, 'nr2char(v:val)'), ', ')
|
||||
endfunction
|
||||
let &cpo = s:cpo_save
|
||||
unlet s:cpo_save
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,6 +1,6 @@
|
||||
" Vim autoload file for the tohtml plugin.
|
||||
" Maintainer: Ben Fritz <fritzophrenic@gmail.com>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2011 Apr 05
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Jun 30
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Additional contributors:
|
||||
"
|
||||
@@ -11,7 +11,7 @@
|
||||
|
||||
" this file uses line continuations
|
||||
let s:cpo_sav = &cpo
|
||||
set cpo-=C
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
" Automatically find charsets from all encodings supported natively by Vim. With
|
||||
" the 8bit- and 2byte- prefixes, Vim can actually support more encodings than
|
||||
@@ -391,12 +391,25 @@ func! tohtml#Diff2HTML(win_list, buf_list) "{{{
|
||||
call add(html, '<meta name="plugin-version" content="'.g:loaded_2html_plugin.'"'.tag_close)
|
||||
call add(html, '<meta name="settings" content="'.
|
||||
\ join(filter(keys(s:settings),'s:settings[v:val]'),',').
|
||||
\ ',prevent_copy='.s:settings.prevent_copy.
|
||||
\ '"'.tag_close)
|
||||
call add(html, '<meta name="colorscheme" content="'.
|
||||
\ (exists('g:colors_name')
|
||||
\ ? g:colors_name
|
||||
\ : 'none'). '"'.tag_close)
|
||||
|
||||
call add(html, '</head>')
|
||||
let body_line_num = len(html)
|
||||
call add(html, '<body>')
|
||||
call add(html, '<table border="1" width="100%">')
|
||||
if !empty(s:settings.prevent_copy)
|
||||
call add(html, "<body onload='FixCharWidth();'>")
|
||||
call add(html, "<!-- hidden divs used by javascript to get the width of a char -->")
|
||||
call add(html, "<div id='oneCharWidth'>0</div>")
|
||||
call add(html, "<div id='oneInputWidth'><input size='1' value='0'".tag_close."</div>")
|
||||
call add(html, "<div id='oneEmWidth' style='width: 1em;'></div>")
|
||||
else
|
||||
call add(html, '<body>')
|
||||
endif
|
||||
call add(html, "<table border='1' width='100%' id='vimCodeElement'>")
|
||||
|
||||
call add(html, '<tr>')
|
||||
for buf in a:win_list
|
||||
@@ -454,16 +467,19 @@ func! tohtml#Diff2HTML(win_list, buf_list) "{{{
|
||||
let insert_index = diff_style_start
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Delete those parts that are not needed so
|
||||
" we can include the rest into the resulting table
|
||||
1,/^<body/d_
|
||||
" Delete those parts that are not needed so we can include the rest into the
|
||||
" resulting table.
|
||||
1,/^<body.*\%(\n<!--.*-->\_s\+.*id='oneCharWidth'.*\_s\+.*id='oneInputWidth'.*\_s\+.*id='oneEmWidth'\)\?\zs/d_
|
||||
$
|
||||
?</body>?,$d_
|
||||
let temp = getline(1,'$')
|
||||
" clean out id on the main content container because we already set it on
|
||||
" the table
|
||||
let temp[0] = substitute(temp[0], " id='vimCodeElement'", "", "")
|
||||
" undo deletion of start and end part
|
||||
" so we can later save the file as valid html
|
||||
" TODO: restore using grabbed lines if undolevel is 1?
|
||||
normal 2u
|
||||
normal! 2u
|
||||
if s:settings.use_css
|
||||
call add(html, '<td valign="top"><div>')
|
||||
elseif s:settings.use_xhtml
|
||||
@@ -520,12 +536,47 @@ func! tohtml#Diff2HTML(win_list, buf_list) "{{{
|
||||
1
|
||||
let style_start = search('^</head>')-1
|
||||
|
||||
" add required javascript in reverse order so we can just call append again
|
||||
" and again without adjusting {{{
|
||||
|
||||
" insert script closing tag if any javascript is needed
|
||||
if s:settings.dynamic_folds || !empty(s:settings.prevent_copy)
|
||||
call append(style_start, [
|
||||
\ '',
|
||||
\ s:settings.use_xhtml ? '//]]>' : '-->',
|
||||
\ "</script>"
|
||||
\ ])
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" insert script which corrects the size of small input elements in
|
||||
" prevent_copy mode. See 2html.vim for details on why this is needed and how
|
||||
" it works.
|
||||
if !empty(s:settings.prevent_copy)
|
||||
call append(style_start, [
|
||||
\ '',
|
||||
\ '/* simulate a "ch" unit by asking the browser how big a zero character is */',
|
||||
\ 'function FixCharWidth() {',
|
||||
\ ' /* get the hidden element which gives the width of a single character */',
|
||||
\ ' var goodWidth = document.getElementById("oneCharWidth").clientWidth;',
|
||||
\ ' /* get all input elements, we''ll filter on class later */',
|
||||
\ ' var inputTags = document.getElementsByTagName("input");',
|
||||
\ ' var ratio = 5;',
|
||||
\ ' var inputWidth = document.getElementById("oneInputWidth").clientWidth;',
|
||||
\ ' var emWidth = document.getElementById("oneEmWidth").clientWidth;',
|
||||
\ ' if (inputWidth > goodWidth) {',
|
||||
\ ' while (ratio < 100*goodWidth/emWidth && ratio < 100) {',
|
||||
\ ' ratio += 5;',
|
||||
\ ' }',
|
||||
\ ' document.getElementById("vimCodeElement").className = "em"+ratio;',
|
||||
\ ' }',
|
||||
\ '}'
|
||||
\ ])
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Insert javascript to toggle matching folds open and closed in all windows,
|
||||
" if dynamic folding is active. {{{
|
||||
" if dynamic folding is active.
|
||||
if s:settings.dynamic_folds
|
||||
call append(style_start, [
|
||||
\ "<script type='text/javascript'>",
|
||||
\ s:settings.use_xhtml ? '//<![CDATA[' : " <!--",
|
||||
\ " function toggleFold(objID)",
|
||||
\ " {",
|
||||
\ " for (win_num = 1; win_num <= ".len(a:buf_list)."; win_num++)",
|
||||
@@ -542,9 +593,14 @@ func! tohtml#Diff2HTML(win_list, buf_list) "{{{
|
||||
\ " }",
|
||||
\ " }",
|
||||
\ " }",
|
||||
\ s:settings.use_xhtml ? '//]]>' : " -->",
|
||||
\ "</script>"
|
||||
\ ])
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" insert script tag if any javascript is needed
|
||||
if s:settings.dynamic_folds || s:settings.prevent_copy != ""
|
||||
call append(style_start, [
|
||||
\ "<script type='text/javascript'>",
|
||||
\ s:settings.use_xhtml ? '//<![CDATA[' : "<!--"])
|
||||
endif "}}}
|
||||
|
||||
" Insert styles from all the generated html documents and additional styles
|
||||
@@ -609,9 +665,10 @@ func! tohtml#GetUserSettings() "{{{
|
||||
call tohtml#GetOption(user_settings, 'ignore_conceal', 0 )
|
||||
call tohtml#GetOption(user_settings, 'ignore_folding', 0 )
|
||||
call tohtml#GetOption(user_settings, 'dynamic_folds', 0 )
|
||||
call tohtml#GetOption(user_settings, 'no_foldcolumn', 0 )
|
||||
call tohtml#GetOption(user_settings, 'no_foldcolumn', user_settings.ignore_folding)
|
||||
call tohtml#GetOption(user_settings, 'hover_unfold', 0 )
|
||||
call tohtml#GetOption(user_settings, 'no_pre', 0 )
|
||||
call tohtml#GetOption(user_settings, 'no_invalid', 0 )
|
||||
call tohtml#GetOption(user_settings, 'whole_filler', 0 )
|
||||
call tohtml#GetOption(user_settings, 'use_xhtml', 0 )
|
||||
" }}}
|
||||
@@ -637,6 +694,8 @@ func! tohtml#GetUserSettings() "{{{
|
||||
" dynamic folding implies css
|
||||
if user_settings.dynamic_folds
|
||||
let user_settings.use_css = 1
|
||||
else
|
||||
let user_settings.no_foldcolumn = 1 " won't do anything but for consistency and for the test suite
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" if we're not using CSS we cannot use a pre section because <font> tags
|
||||
@@ -663,6 +722,7 @@ func! tohtml#GetUserSettings() "{{{
|
||||
endif
|
||||
" }}}
|
||||
|
||||
" textual options
|
||||
if exists("g:html_use_encoding") "{{{
|
||||
" user specified the desired MIME charset, figure out proper
|
||||
" 'fileencoding' from it or warn the user if we cannot
|
||||
@@ -705,6 +765,45 @@ func! tohtml#GetUserSettings() "{{{
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endif "}}}
|
||||
|
||||
" Default to making nothing uncopyable, because we default to
|
||||
" not-standards way of doing things, and also because Microsoft Word and
|
||||
" others paste the <input> elements anyway.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" html_prevent_copy only has an effect when using CSS.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" All options:
|
||||
" f - fold column
|
||||
" n - line numbers (also within fold text)
|
||||
" t - fold text
|
||||
" d - diff filler
|
||||
" c - concealed text (reserved future)
|
||||
" l - listchars (reserved possible future)
|
||||
" s - signs (reserved possible future)
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Normal text is always selectable.
|
||||
let user_settings.prevent_copy = ""
|
||||
if user_settings.use_css
|
||||
if exists("g:html_prevent_copy")
|
||||
if user_settings.dynamic_folds && !user_settings.no_foldcolumn && g:html_prevent_copy =~# 'f'
|
||||
let user_settings.prevent_copy .= 'f'
|
||||
endif
|
||||
if user_settings.number_lines && g:html_prevent_copy =~# 'n'
|
||||
let user_settings.prevent_copy .= 'n'
|
||||
endif
|
||||
if &diff && g:html_prevent_copy =~# 'd'
|
||||
let user_settings.prevent_copy .= 'd'
|
||||
endif
|
||||
if !user_settings.ignore_folding && g:html_prevent_copy =~# 't'
|
||||
let user_settings.prevent_copy .= 't'
|
||||
endif
|
||||
else
|
||||
let user_settings.prevent_copy = ""
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endif
|
||||
if empty(user_settings.prevent_copy)
|
||||
let user_settings.no_invalid = 0
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" TODO: font
|
||||
|
||||
return user_settings
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -2,12 +2,14 @@
|
||||
" Compiler: Microsoft Visual Studio C#
|
||||
" Maintainer: Zhou YiChao (broken.zhou@gmail.com)
|
||||
" Previous Maintainer: Joseph H. Yao (hyao@sina.com)
|
||||
" Last Change: 2011 Apr 21
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("current_compiler")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = "cs"
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -19,3 +21,6 @@ CompilerSet errorformat+=%f(%l\\,%v):\ %t%*[^:]:\ %m,
|
||||
\%tarning%*[^:]:\ %m
|
||||
|
||||
CompilerSet makeprg=csc\ %
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -15,11 +15,11 @@
|
||||
" Help Page: compiler-decada
|
||||
"------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
if (exists("current_compiler") &&
|
||||
\ current_compiler == "decada") ||
|
||||
\ version < 700
|
||||
if (exists("current_compiler") && current_compiler == "decada") || version < 700
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
let current_compiler = "decada"
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -44,6 +44,9 @@ endif
|
||||
execute "CompilerSet makeprg=" . escape (g:decada.Make_Command, ' ')
|
||||
execute "CompilerSet errorformat=" . escape (g:decada.Error_Format, ' ')
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
finish " 1}}}
|
||||
|
||||
"------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Compiler: G95
|
||||
" Maintainer: H Xu <xuhdev@gmail.com>
|
||||
" Version: 0.1.3
|
||||
" Last Change: 2011 Apr 01
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
" Homepage: http://www.vim.org/scripts/script.php?script_id=3492
|
||||
" https://bitbucket.org/xuhdev/compiler-g95.vim
|
||||
" License: Same as Vim
|
||||
@@ -10,6 +10,8 @@ if exists('current_compiler')
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = 'g95'
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -21,3 +23,6 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=
|
||||
\%-Z%trror:\ %m,
|
||||
\%-Z%tarning\ (%n):\ %m,
|
||||
\%-C%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Compiler: GNU Fortran Compiler
|
||||
" Maintainer: H Xu <xuhdev@gmail.com>
|
||||
" Version: 0.1.3
|
||||
" Last Change: 19 March 2011
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
" Homepage: http://www.vim.org/scripts/script.php?script_id=3496
|
||||
" https://bitbucket.org/xuhdev/compiler-gfortran.vim
|
||||
" License: Same as Vim
|
||||
@@ -10,6 +10,8 @@ if exists('current_compiler')
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = 'gfortran'
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -20,3 +22,6 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=
|
||||
\%-Z%trror:\ %m,
|
||||
\%-Z%tarning:\ %m,
|
||||
\%-C%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -17,11 +17,11 @@
|
||||
" Help Page: compiler-gnat
|
||||
"------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
if (exists("current_compiler") &&
|
||||
\ current_compiler == "gnat") ||
|
||||
\ version < 700
|
||||
if (exists("current_compiler")&& current_compiler == "gnat") || version < 700
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
let current_compiler = "gnat"
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -62,6 +62,9 @@ endif
|
||||
execute "CompilerSet makeprg=" . escape (g:gnat.Get_Command('Make'), ' ')
|
||||
execute "CompilerSet errorformat=" . escape (g:gnat.Error_Format, ' ')
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
finish " 1}}}
|
||||
|
||||
"------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -2,7 +2,7 @@
|
||||
" Compiler: HP aCC
|
||||
" Maintainer: Matthias Ulrich <matthias-ulrich@web.de>
|
||||
" URL: http://www.subhome.de/vim/hp_acc.vim
|
||||
" Last Change: 2005 Nov 19
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
"
|
||||
" aCC --version says: "HP ANSI C++ B3910B A.03.13"
|
||||
" This compiler has been tested on:
|
||||
@@ -19,6 +19,8 @@ if exists("current_compiler")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = "hp_acc"
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -30,4 +32,7 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=%A%trror\ %n\:\ \"%f\"\\,\ line\ %l\ \#\ %m,
|
||||
\%Z\ \ \ \ %p^%.%#,
|
||||
\%-C%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
" vim:ts=8:sw=4:cindent
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Compiler: Intel Fortran Compiler
|
||||
" Maintainer: H Xu <xuhdev@gmail.com>
|
||||
" Version: 0.1.1
|
||||
" Last Change: 19 March 2011
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
" Homepage: http://www.vim.org/scripts/script.php?script_id=3497
|
||||
" https://bitbucket.org/xuhdev/compiler-ifort.vim
|
||||
" License: Same as Vim
|
||||
@@ -10,6 +10,8 @@ if exists('current_compiler')
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = 'ifort'
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -20,3 +22,6 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=
|
||||
\%A%f(%l):\ %tarning\ \#%n:\ %m,
|
||||
\%-Z%p^,
|
||||
\%-G%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,12 +1,14 @@
|
||||
" Vim compiler file
|
||||
" Compiler: Intel C++ 7.1
|
||||
" Maintainer: David Harrison <david_jr@users.sourceforge.net>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2004 May 16
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("current_compiler")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = "intel"
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -19,3 +21,6 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=%E%f(%l):\ error:\ %m,
|
||||
\%-Z\ \ %p^,
|
||||
\%-G\\s%#,
|
||||
\%-G%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,12 +1,14 @@
|
||||
" Vim compiler file
|
||||
" Compiler: SGI IRIX 5.3 cc
|
||||
" Maintainer: David Harrison <david_jr@users.sourceforge.net>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2004 Mar 27
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("current_compiler")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = "irix5_c"
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -19,3 +21,6 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=\%Ecfe:\ Error:\ %f\\,\ line\ %l:\ %m,
|
||||
\%-Z\ %p^,
|
||||
\-G\\s%#,
|
||||
\%-G%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,12 +1,14 @@
|
||||
" Vim compiler file
|
||||
" Compiler: SGI IRIX 5.3 CC or NCC
|
||||
" Maintainer: David Harrison <david_jr@users.sourceforge.net>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2004 Mar 27
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("current_compiler")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = "irix5_cpp"
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -19,3 +21,6 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=%E\"%f\"\\,\ line\ %l:\ error(%n):\ ,
|
||||
\%-Z\ \ %p%^,
|
||||
\%+C\ %\\{10}%.%#,
|
||||
\%-G%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,8 @@
|
||||
" Vim compiler file
|
||||
" Compiler: Mono C# Compiler
|
||||
" Maintainer: Jarek Sobiecki <harijari@go2.pl>
|
||||
" Latest Revision: 2006-06-18
|
||||
" Last Updated By: Peter Collingbourne
|
||||
" Latest Revision: 2012 Jul 19
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("current_compiler")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
@@ -12,13 +13,18 @@ let s:cpo_save = &cpo
|
||||
set cpo-=C
|
||||
|
||||
setlocal errorformat=
|
||||
\%D%.%#Project\ \"%f/%[%^/\"]%#\"%.%#,
|
||||
\%X%.%#Done\ building\ project\ \"%f/%[%^/\"]%#\"%.%#,
|
||||
\%-G%\\s%.%#,
|
||||
\%E%f(%l):\ error\ CS%n:%m,
|
||||
\%W%f(%l):\ warning\ CS%n:%m,
|
||||
\%E%f(%l\\,%c):\ error\ CS%n:%m,
|
||||
\%W%f(%l\\,%c):\ warning\ CS%n:%m,
|
||||
\%E%>syntax\ error\\,%m,%Z%f(%l\\,%c):\ error\ CS%n:%m,
|
||||
\%D%*\\a[%*\\d]:\ Entering\ directory\ `%f',
|
||||
\%X%*\\a[%*\\d]:\ Leaving\ directory\ `%f',
|
||||
\%DMaking\ %*\\a\ in\ %f,
|
||||
\%G-%.%#
|
||||
\%-G%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:cpo_save
|
||||
unlet s:cpo_save
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,12 +1,14 @@
|
||||
" Vim compiler file
|
||||
" Compiler: SGI IRIX 6.5 MIPS C (cc)
|
||||
" Maintainer: David Harrison <david_jr@users.sourceforge.net>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2004 Mar 27
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("current_compiler")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = "mips_c"
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -19,3 +21,6 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=%Ecc\-%n\ %.%#:\ ERROR\ File\ =\ %f\%\\,\ Line\ =\ %l,
|
||||
\%-Z\ \ %p^,
|
||||
\%-G\\s%#,
|
||||
\%-G%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,12 +1,14 @@
|
||||
" Vim compiler file
|
||||
" Compiler: SGI IRIX 6.5 MIPSPro C (c89)
|
||||
" Maintainer: David Harrison <david_jr@users.sourceforge.net>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2004 Mar 27
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("current_compiler")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = "mipspro_c89"
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -20,3 +22,6 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=%Ecc\-%n\ %.%#:\ ERROR\ File\ =\ %f\%\\,\ Line\ =\ %l,
|
||||
\%+C\ \ %m,
|
||||
\%-G\\s%#,
|
||||
\%-G%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,12 +1,14 @@
|
||||
" Vim compiler file
|
||||
" Compiler: SGI IRIX 6.5 MIPSPro C++ (CC)
|
||||
" Maintainer: David Harrison <david_jr@users.sourceforge.net>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2004 Mar 27
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("current_compiler")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let current_compiler = "mipspro_cpp"
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -19,3 +21,6 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=%Ecc\-%n\ %.%#:\ ERROR\ File\ =\ %f\%\\,\ Line\ =\ %l,
|
||||
\%-Z\ \ %p^,
|
||||
\%-G\\s%#,
|
||||
\%-G%.%#
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,11 +1,13 @@
|
||||
" Vim compiler file
|
||||
" Compiler: TeX
|
||||
" Maintainer: Artem Chuprina <ran@ran.pp.ru>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2004 Mar 27
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("current_compiler")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
if exists(":CompilerSet") != 2 " older Vim always used :setlocal
|
||||
command -nargs=* CompilerSet setlocal <args>
|
||||
@@ -30,9 +32,6 @@ else
|
||||
let current_compiler = 'make'
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let s:cpo_save = &cpo
|
||||
set cpo-=C
|
||||
|
||||
" Value errorformat are taken from vim help, see :help errorformat-LaTeX, with
|
||||
" addition from Srinath Avadhanula <srinath@fastmail.fm>
|
||||
CompilerSet errorformat=%E!\ LaTeX\ %trror:\ %m,
|
||||
@@ -64,5 +63,5 @@ CompilerSet errorformat=%E!\ LaTeX\ %trror:\ %m,
|
||||
\%+Q%*[^()])%r,
|
||||
\%+Q[%\\d%*[^()])%r
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:cpo_save
|
||||
unlet s:cpo_save
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*autocmd.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Feb 22
|
||||
*autocmd.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Sep 05
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -263,8 +263,10 @@ Name triggered by ~
|
||||
Startup and exit
|
||||
|VimEnter| after doing all the startup stuff
|
||||
|GUIEnter| after starting the GUI successfully
|
||||
|GUIFailed| after starting the GUI failed
|
||||
|TermResponse| after the terminal response to |t_RV| is received
|
||||
|
||||
|QuitPre| when using `:quit`, before deciding whether to quit
|
||||
|VimLeavePre| before exiting Vim, before writing the viminfo file
|
||||
|VimLeave| before exiting Vim, after writing the viminfo file
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -312,6 +314,7 @@ Name triggered by ~
|
||||
|SessionLoadPost| after loading a session file
|
||||
|
||||
|MenuPopup| just before showing the popup menu
|
||||
|CompleteDone| after Insert mode completion is done
|
||||
|
||||
|User| to be used in combination with ":doautocmd"
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -385,6 +388,10 @@ BufRead or BufReadPost When starting to edit a new buffer, after
|
||||
This does NOT work for ":r file". Not used
|
||||
when the file doesn't exist. Also used after
|
||||
successfully recovering a file.
|
||||
Also triggered for the filetypedetect group
|
||||
when executing ":filetype detect" and when
|
||||
writing an unnamed buffer in a way that the
|
||||
buffer gets a name.
|
||||
*BufReadCmd*
|
||||
BufReadCmd Before starting to edit a new buffer. Should
|
||||
read the file into the buffer. |Cmd-event|
|
||||
@@ -474,6 +481,11 @@ CmdwinLeave Before leaving the command-line window.
|
||||
*ColorScheme*
|
||||
ColorScheme After loading a color scheme. |:colorscheme|
|
||||
|
||||
*CompleteDone*
|
||||
CompleteDone After Insert mode completion is done. Either
|
||||
when something was completed or abandoning
|
||||
completion. |ins-completion|
|
||||
|
||||
*CursorHold*
|
||||
CursorHold When the user doesn't press a key for the time
|
||||
specified with 'updatetime'. Not re-triggered
|
||||
@@ -717,6 +729,12 @@ QuickFixCmdPost Like QuickFixCmdPre, but after a quickfix
|
||||
it is run after error file is read and before
|
||||
moving to the first error.
|
||||
See |QuickFixCmdPost-example|.
|
||||
*QuitPre*
|
||||
QuitPre When using `:quit`, before deciding whether it
|
||||
closes the current window or quits Vim. Can
|
||||
be used to close any non-essential window if
|
||||
the current window is the last ordinary
|
||||
window.
|
||||
*RemoteReply*
|
||||
RemoteReply When a reply from a Vim that functions as
|
||||
server was received |server2client()|. The
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*change.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Jan 04
|
||||
*change.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Nov 02
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -80,8 +80,8 @@ For inserting text see |insert.txt|.
|
||||
(default: current line |cmdline-ranges|) [into
|
||||
register x].
|
||||
|
||||
These commands delete text. You can repeat them with the "." command
|
||||
(except ":d") and undo them. Use Visual mode to delete blocks of text. See
|
||||
These commands delete text. You can repeat them with the `.` command
|
||||
(except `:d`) and undo them. Use Visual mode to delete blocks of text. See
|
||||
|registers| for an explanation of registers.
|
||||
|
||||
An exception for the d{motion} command: If the motion is not linewise, the
|
||||
@@ -132,7 +132,7 @@ gJ Join [count] lines, with a minimum of two lines.
|
||||
See |ex-flags| for [flags].
|
||||
|
||||
These commands delete the <EOL> between lines. This has the effect of joining
|
||||
multiple lines into one line. You can repeat these commands (except ":j") and
|
||||
multiple lines into one line. You can repeat these commands (except `:j`) and
|
||||
undo them.
|
||||
|
||||
These commands, except "gJ", insert one space in place of the <EOL> unless
|
||||
@@ -260,6 +260,12 @@ r{char} Replace the character under the cursor with {char}.
|
||||
<CR>. CTRL-V <NL> replaces with a <Nul>.
|
||||
{Vi: CTRL-V <CR> still replaces with a line break,
|
||||
cannot replace something with a <CR>}
|
||||
|
||||
If {char} is CTRL-E or CTRL-Y the character from the
|
||||
line below or above is used, just like with |i_CTRL-E|
|
||||
and |i_CTRL-Y|. This also works with a count, thus
|
||||
`10r<C-E>` copies 10 characters from the line below.
|
||||
|
||||
If you give a [count], Vim replaces [count] characters
|
||||
with [count] {char}s. When {char} is a <CR> or <NL>,
|
||||
however, Vim inserts only one <CR>: "5r<CR>" replaces
|
||||
@@ -465,9 +471,9 @@ much as possible to make the indent. You can use ">><<" to replace an indent
|
||||
made out of spaces with the same indent made out of <Tab>s (and a few spaces
|
||||
if necessary). If the 'expandtab' option is on, Vim uses only spaces. Then
|
||||
you can use ">><<" to replace <Tab>s in the indent by spaces (or use
|
||||
":retab!").
|
||||
`:retab!`).
|
||||
|
||||
To move a line several 'shiftwidth's, use Visual mode or the ":" commands.
|
||||
To move a line several 'shiftwidth's, use Visual mode or the `:` commands.
|
||||
For example: >
|
||||
Vjj4> move three lines 4 indents to the right
|
||||
:<<< move current line 3 indents to the left
|
||||
@@ -487,7 +493,7 @@ Examples of filters are "sort", which sorts lines alphabetically, and
|
||||
works like a filter; not all versions do). The 'shell' option specifies the
|
||||
shell Vim uses to execute the filter command (See also the 'shelltype'
|
||||
option). You can repeat filter commands with ".". Vim does not recognize a
|
||||
comment (starting with '"') after the ":!" command.
|
||||
comment (starting with '"') after the `:!` command.
|
||||
|
||||
*!*
|
||||
!{motion}{filter} Filter {motion} text lines through the external
|
||||
@@ -574,34 +580,37 @@ For other systems the tmpnam() library function is used.
|
||||
Repeat last :substitute with same search pattern and
|
||||
substitute string, but without the same flags. You
|
||||
may add [flags], see |:s_flags|.
|
||||
Note that after ":substitute" the '&' flag can't be
|
||||
Note that after `:substitute` the '&' flag can't be
|
||||
used, it's recognized as a pattern separator.
|
||||
The space between ":substitute" and the 'c', 'g' and
|
||||
The space between `:substitute` and the 'c', 'g' and
|
||||
'r' flags isn't required, but in scripts it's a good
|
||||
idea to keep it to avoid confusion.
|
||||
|
||||
:[range]~[&][flags] [count] *:~*
|
||||
Repeat last substitute with same substitute string
|
||||
but with last used search pattern. This is like
|
||||
":&r". See |:s_flags| for [flags].
|
||||
`:&r`. See |:s_flags| for [flags].
|
||||
|
||||
*&*
|
||||
& Synonym for ":s" (repeat last substitute). Note
|
||||
& Synonym for `:s` (repeat last substitute). Note
|
||||
that the flags are not remembered, thus it might
|
||||
actually work differently. You can use ":&&" to keep
|
||||
actually work differently. You can use `:&&` to keep
|
||||
the flags.
|
||||
|
||||
*g&*
|
||||
g& Synonym for ":%s//~/&" (repeat last substitute on all
|
||||
lines with the same flags).
|
||||
g& Synonym for `:%s//~/&` (repeat last substitute with
|
||||
last search pattern on all lines with the same flags).
|
||||
For exaple, when you first do a substitution with
|
||||
`:s/pattern/repl/flags` and then `/search` for
|
||||
something else, `g&` will do `:%s/search/repl/flags`.
|
||||
Mnemonic: global substitute. {not in Vi}
|
||||
|
||||
*:snomagic* *:sno*
|
||||
:[range]sno[magic] ... Same as ":substitute", but always use 'nomagic'.
|
||||
:[range]sno[magic] ... Same as `:substitute`, but always use 'nomagic'.
|
||||
{not in Vi}
|
||||
|
||||
*:smagic* *:sm*
|
||||
:[range]sm[agic] ... Same as ":substitute", but always use 'magic'.
|
||||
:[range]sm[agic] ... Same as `:substitute`, but always use 'magic'.
|
||||
{not in Vi}
|
||||
|
||||
*:s_flags*
|
||||
@@ -611,7 +620,7 @@ The flags that you can use for the substitute commands:
|
||||
command. Examples: >
|
||||
:&&
|
||||
:s/this/that/&
|
||||
< Note that ":s" and ":&" don't keep the flags.
|
||||
< Note that `:s` and `:&` don't keep the flags.
|
||||
{not in Vi}
|
||||
|
||||
[c] Confirm each substitution. Vim highlights the matching string (with
|
||||
@@ -660,6 +669,8 @@ The flags that you can use for the substitute commands:
|
||||
[n] Report the number of matches, do not actually substitute. The [c]
|
||||
flag is ignored. The matches are reported as if 'report' is zero.
|
||||
Useful to |count-items|.
|
||||
If \= |sub-replace-expression| is used, the expression will be
|
||||
evaluated in the |sandbox| at every match.
|
||||
|
||||
[p] Print the line containing the last substitute.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -667,14 +678,14 @@ The flags that you can use for the substitute commands:
|
||||
|
||||
[l] Like [p] but print the text like |:list|.
|
||||
|
||||
[r] Only useful in combination with ":&" or ":s" without arguments. ":&r"
|
||||
works the same way as ":~": When the search pattern is empty, use the
|
||||
[r] Only useful in combination with `:&` or `:s` without arguments. `:&r`
|
||||
works the same way as `:~`: When the search pattern is empty, use the
|
||||
previously used search pattern instead of the search pattern from the
|
||||
last substitute or ":global". If the last command that did a search
|
||||
was a substitute or ":global", there is no effect. If the last
|
||||
last substitute or `:global`. If the last command that did a search
|
||||
was a substitute or `:global`, there is no effect. If the last
|
||||
command was a search command such as "/", use the pattern from that
|
||||
command.
|
||||
For ":s" with an argument this already happens: >
|
||||
For `:s` with an argument this already happens: >
|
||||
:s/blue/red/
|
||||
/green
|
||||
:s//red/ or :~ or :&r
|
||||
@@ -691,9 +702,9 @@ reason is that the flags can only be found by skipping the pattern, and in
|
||||
order to skip the pattern the "magicness" must be known. Catch 22!
|
||||
|
||||
If the {pattern} for the substitute command is empty, the command uses the
|
||||
pattern from the last substitute or ":global" command. If there is none, but
|
||||
pattern from the last substitute or `:global` command. If there is none, but
|
||||
there is a previous search pattern, that one is used. With the [r] flag, the
|
||||
command uses the pattern from the last substitute, ":global", or search
|
||||
command uses the pattern from the last substitute, `:global`, or search
|
||||
command.
|
||||
|
||||
If the {string} is omitted the substitute is done as if it's empty. Thus the
|
||||
@@ -848,7 +859,7 @@ This replaces each 'E' character with a euro sign. Read more in |<Char->|.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
4.4 Changing tabs *change-tabs*
|
||||
*:ret* *:retab*
|
||||
*:ret* *:retab* *:retab!*
|
||||
:[range]ret[ab][!] [new_tabstop]
|
||||
Replace all sequences of white-space containing a
|
||||
<Tab> with new strings of white-space using the new
|
||||
@@ -867,7 +878,7 @@ This replaces each 'E' character with a euro sign. Read more in |<Char->|.
|
||||
Careful: This command modifies any <Tab> characters
|
||||
inside of strings in a C program. Use "\t" to avoid
|
||||
this (that's a good habit anyway).
|
||||
":retab!" may also change a sequence of spaces by
|
||||
`:retab!` may also change a sequence of spaces by
|
||||
<Tab> characters, which can mess up a printf().
|
||||
{not in Vi}
|
||||
Not available when |+ex_extra| feature was disabled at
|
||||
@@ -977,8 +988,12 @@ inside of strings can change! Also see 'softtabstop' option. >
|
||||
current line). This always works |linewise|, thus
|
||||
this command can be used to put a yanked block as new
|
||||
lines.
|
||||
The cursor is left on the first non-blank in the last
|
||||
new line.
|
||||
If no register is specified, it depends on the 'cb'
|
||||
option: If 'cb' contains "unnamedplus", paste from the
|
||||
+ register |quoteplus|. Otherwise, if 'cb' contains
|
||||
"unnamed", paste from the * register |quotestar|.
|
||||
Otherwise, paste from the unnamed register
|
||||
|quote_quote|.
|
||||
The register can also be '=' followed by an optional
|
||||
expression. The expression continues until the end of
|
||||
the command. You need to escape the '|' and '"'
|
||||
@@ -1183,7 +1198,7 @@ nothing is returned. {not in Vi}
|
||||
|
||||
9. Last search pattern register "/ *quote_/* *quote/*
|
||||
Contains the most recent search-pattern. This is used for "n" and 'hlsearch'.
|
||||
It is writable with ":let", you can change it to have 'hlsearch' highlight
|
||||
It is writable with `:let`, you can change it to have 'hlsearch' highlight
|
||||
other matches without actually searching. You can't yank or delete into this
|
||||
register. The search direction is available in |v:searchforward|.
|
||||
Note that the valued is restored when returning from a function
|
||||
@@ -1191,12 +1206,12 @@ Note that the valued is restored when returning from a function
|
||||
{not in Vi}
|
||||
|
||||
*@/*
|
||||
You can write to a register with a ":let" command |:let-@|. Example: >
|
||||
You can write to a register with a `:let` command |:let-@|. Example: >
|
||||
:let @/ = "the"
|
||||
|
||||
If you use a put command without specifying a register, Vim uses the register
|
||||
that was last filled (this is also the contents of the unnamed register). If
|
||||
you are confused, use the ":dis" command to find out what Vim will put (this
|
||||
you are confused, use the `:dis` command to find out what Vim will put (this
|
||||
command displays all named and numbered registers; the unnamed register is
|
||||
labelled '"').
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1492,6 +1507,7 @@ n When formatting text, recognize numbered lists. This actually uses
|
||||
first line of a paragraph
|
||||
second line of the same paragraph
|
||||
third line.
|
||||
< This also works inside comments, ignoring the comment leader.
|
||||
v Vi-compatible auto-wrapping in insert mode: Only break a line at a
|
||||
blank that you have entered during the current insert command. (Note:
|
||||
this is not 100% Vi compatible. Vi has some "unexpected features" or
|
||||
@@ -1512,6 +1528,12 @@ B When joining lines, don't insert a space between two multi-byte
|
||||
characters. Overruled by the 'M' flag.
|
||||
1 Don't break a line after a one-letter word. It's broken before it
|
||||
instead (if possible).
|
||||
j Where it makes sense, remove a comment leader when joining lines. For
|
||||
example, joining:
|
||||
int i; // the index ~
|
||||
// in the list ~
|
||||
Becomes:
|
||||
int i; // the index in the list ~
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
With 't' and 'c' you can specify when Vim performs auto-wrapping:
|
||||
@@ -1555,7 +1577,7 @@ Some examples:
|
||||
:set fo=tcrq
|
||||
<
|
||||
|
||||
Automatic formatting *auto-format*
|
||||
Automatic formatting *auto-format* *autoformat*
|
||||
|
||||
When the 'a' flag is present in 'formatoptions' text is formatted
|
||||
automatically when inserting text or deleting text. This works nice for
|
||||
@@ -1664,7 +1686,7 @@ found here: |sort()|.
|
||||
last search pattern is used. This allows trying out
|
||||
a pattern first.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that using ":sort" with ":global" doesn't sort the matching lines, it's
|
||||
Note that using `:sort` with `:global` doesn't sort the matching lines, it's
|
||||
quite useless.
|
||||
|
||||
The details about sorting depend on the library function used. There is no
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*cmdline.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Feb 05
|
||||
*cmdline.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Oct 11
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -217,7 +217,7 @@ CTRL-\ e {expr} *c_CTRL-\_e*
|
||||
:return cmd
|
||||
:endfunc
|
||||
< This doesn't work recursively, thus not when already editing
|
||||
an expression.
|
||||
an expression. But it is possible to use in a mapping.
|
||||
|
||||
*c_CTRL-Y*
|
||||
CTRL-Y When there is a modeless selection, copy the selection into
|
||||
@@ -330,12 +330,12 @@ terminals)
|
||||
|
||||
:his[tory] [{name}] [{first}][, [{last}]]
|
||||
List the contents of history {name} which can be:
|
||||
c[md] or : command-line history
|
||||
s[earch] or / search string history
|
||||
e[xpr] or = expression register history
|
||||
i[nput] or @ input line history
|
||||
d[ebug] or > debug command history
|
||||
a[ll] all of the above
|
||||
c[md] or : command-line history
|
||||
s[earch] or / or ? search string history
|
||||
e[xpr] or = expression register history
|
||||
i[nput] or @ input line history
|
||||
d[ebug] or > debug command history
|
||||
a[ll] all of the above
|
||||
{not in Vi}
|
||||
|
||||
If the numbers {first} and/or {last} are given, the respective
|
||||
@@ -826,10 +826,11 @@ These modifiers can be given, in this order:
|
||||
the home directory. If the name is a directory a path
|
||||
separator is added at the end. For a file name that does not
|
||||
exist and does not have an absolute path the result is
|
||||
unpredictable.
|
||||
unpredictable. On MS-Windows an 8.3 filename is expanded to
|
||||
the long name.
|
||||
:8 Converts the path to 8.3 short format (currently only on
|
||||
win32). Will act on as much of a path that is an existing
|
||||
path.
|
||||
MS-Windows). Will act on as much of a path that is an
|
||||
existing path.
|
||||
:~ Reduce file name to be relative to the home directory, if
|
||||
possible. File name is unmodified if it is not below the home
|
||||
directory.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*diff.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2011 Apr 14
|
||||
*diff.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Sep 05
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -86,16 +86,16 @@ diff mode. You could use a construct like this: >
|
||||
While already in Vim you can start diff mode in three ways.
|
||||
|
||||
*E98*
|
||||
:diffsplit {filename} *:diffs* *:diffsplit*
|
||||
:diffs[plit] {filename} *:diffs* *:diffsplit*
|
||||
Open a new window on the file {filename}. The options are set
|
||||
as for "vimdiff" for the current and the newly opened window.
|
||||
Also see 'diffexpr'.
|
||||
|
||||
*:difft* *:diffthis*
|
||||
:diffthis Make the current window part of the diff windows. This sets
|
||||
:difft[his] Make the current window part of the diff windows. This sets
|
||||
the options like for "vimdiff".
|
||||
|
||||
:diffpatch {patchfile} *E816* *:diffp* *:diffpatch*
|
||||
:diffp[atch] {patchfile} *E816* *:diffp* *:diffpatch*
|
||||
Use the current buffer, patch it with the diff found in
|
||||
{patchfile} and open a buffer on the result. The options are
|
||||
set as for "vimdiff".
|
||||
@@ -123,9 +123,9 @@ Since the option values are remembered with the buffer, you can edit another
|
||||
file for a moment and come back to the same file and be in diff mode again.
|
||||
|
||||
*:diffo* *:diffoff*
|
||||
:diffoff Switch off diff mode for the current window.
|
||||
:diffo[ff] Switch off diff mode for the current window.
|
||||
|
||||
:diffoff! Switch off diff mode for the current window and in all windows
|
||||
:diffo[ff]! Switch off diff mode for the current window and in all windows
|
||||
in the current tab page where 'diff' is set.
|
||||
|
||||
The ":diffoff" command resets the relevant options to their default value.
|
||||
@@ -178,7 +178,7 @@ buffer. If you don't want a buffer to remain used for the diff do ":set
|
||||
nodiff" before hiding it.
|
||||
|
||||
*:diffu* *:diffupdate*
|
||||
:diffu[pdate] Update the diff highlighting and folds.
|
||||
:diffu[pdate][!] Update the diff highlighting and folds.
|
||||
|
||||
Vim attempts to keep the differences updated when you make changes to the
|
||||
text. This mostly takes care of inserted and deleted lines. Changes within a
|
||||
@@ -187,6 +187,9 @@ To force the differences to be updated use: >
|
||||
|
||||
:diffupdate
|
||||
|
||||
If the ! is included Vim will check if the file was changed externally and
|
||||
needs to be reloaded. It will prompt for each changed file, like `:checktime`
|
||||
was used.
|
||||
|
||||
Vim will show filler lines for lines that are missing in one window but are
|
||||
present in another. These lines were inserted in another file or deleted in
|
||||
@@ -330,7 +333,7 @@ diff. This example explains the format that Vim expects: >
|
||||
|
||||
The "1a2" item appends the line "bbb".
|
||||
The "4d4" item deletes the line "111".
|
||||
The '7c7" item replaces the line "GGG" with "ggg".
|
||||
The "7c7" item replaces the line "GGG" with "ggg".
|
||||
|
||||
When 'diffexpr' is not empty, Vim evaluates it to obtain a diff file in the
|
||||
format mentioned. These variables are set to the file names used:
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*editing.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Apr 03
|
||||
*editing.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 08
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -377,8 +377,9 @@ command that accepts more than one file name (like ":next file1 file2")
|
||||
embedded spaces must be escaped with a backslash.
|
||||
|
||||
*wildcard* *wildcards*
|
||||
Wildcards in {file} are expanded. Which wildcards are supported depends on
|
||||
the system. These are the common ones:
|
||||
Wildcards in {file} are expanded, but as with file completion, 'wildignore'
|
||||
and 'suffixes' apply. Which wildcards are supported depends on the system.
|
||||
These are the common ones:
|
||||
? matches one character
|
||||
* matches anything, including nothing
|
||||
** matches anything, including nothing, recurses into directories
|
||||
@@ -392,7 +393,7 @@ is to use "path\[[]abc]". Then the file "path[abc]" literally.
|
||||
*starstar-wildcard*
|
||||
Expanding "**" is possible on Unix, Win32, Mac OS/X and a few other systems.
|
||||
This allows searching a directory tree. This goes up to 100 directories deep.
|
||||
Note there are some commands where this works slightly different, see
|
||||
Note there are some commands where this works slightly differently, see
|
||||
|file-searching|.
|
||||
Example: >
|
||||
:n **/*.txt
|
||||
@@ -422,9 +423,11 @@ You can have the backticks expanded as a Vim expression, instead of an
|
||||
external command, by using the syntax `={expr}` e.g.: >
|
||||
:e `=tempname()`
|
||||
The expression can contain just about anything, thus this can also be used to
|
||||
avoid the special meaning of '"', '|', '%' and '#'. Names are to be separated
|
||||
with line breaks. When the result is a |List| then each item is used as a
|
||||
name. Line breaks also separate names.
|
||||
avoid the special meaning of '"', '|', '%' and '#'. However, 'wildignore'
|
||||
does apply like to other wildcars.
|
||||
If the expression returns a string then names are to be separated with line
|
||||
breaks. When the result is a |List| then each item is used as a name. Line
|
||||
breaks also separate names.
|
||||
|
||||
*++opt* *[++opt]*
|
||||
The [++opt] argument can be used to force the value of 'fileformat',
|
||||
@@ -1066,6 +1069,7 @@ The names can be in upper- or lowercase.
|
||||
If there are other tab pages and quitting the last
|
||||
window in the current tab page the current tab page is
|
||||
closed |tab-page|.
|
||||
Triggers the |QuitPre| autocommand event.
|
||||
|
||||
:conf[irm] q[uit] Quit, but give prompt when changes have been made, or
|
||||
the last file in the argument list has not been
|
||||
@@ -1215,13 +1219,13 @@ For versions of Vim where browsing is not supported, the command is executed
|
||||
unmodified.
|
||||
|
||||
*browsefilter*
|
||||
For MS Windows, you can modify the filters that are used in the browse dialog.
|
||||
By setting the g:browsefilter or b:browsefilter variables, you can change the
|
||||
filters globally or locally to the buffer. The variable is set to a string in
|
||||
the format "{filter label}\t{pattern};{pattern}\n" where {filter label} is the
|
||||
text that appears in the "Files of Type" comboBox, and {pattern} is the
|
||||
pattern which filters the filenames. Several patterns can be given, separated
|
||||
by ';'.
|
||||
For MS Windows and GTK, you can modify the filters that are used in the browse
|
||||
dialog. By setting the g:browsefilter or b:browsefilter variables, you can
|
||||
change the filters globally or locally to the buffer. The variable is set to
|
||||
a string in the format "{filter label}\t{pattern};{pattern}\n" where {filter
|
||||
label} is the text that appears in the "Files of Type" comboBox, and {pattern}
|
||||
is the pattern which filters the filenames. Several patterns can be given,
|
||||
separated by ';'.
|
||||
|
||||
For Motif the same format is used, but only the very first pattern is actually
|
||||
used (Motif only offers one pattern, but you can edit it).
|
||||
@@ -1229,7 +1233,7 @@ used (Motif only offers one pattern, but you can edit it).
|
||||
For example, to have only Vim files in the dialog, you could use the following
|
||||
command: >
|
||||
|
||||
let g:browsefilter="Vim Scripts\t*.vim\nVim Startup Files\t*vimrc\n"
|
||||
let g:browsefilter = "Vim Scripts\t*.vim\nVim Startup Files\t*vimrc\n"
|
||||
|
||||
You can override the filter setting on a per-buffer basis by setting the
|
||||
b:browsefilter variable. You would most likely set b:browsefilter in a
|
||||
@@ -1239,6 +1243,13 @@ difficult to start editing a file of a different type. To overcome this, you
|
||||
may want to add "All Files\t*.*\n" as the final filter, so that the user can
|
||||
still access any desired file.
|
||||
|
||||
To avoid setting browsefilter when Vim does not actually support it, you can
|
||||
use has("browsefilter"): >
|
||||
|
||||
if has("browsefilter")
|
||||
let g:browsefilter = "whatever"
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
==============================================================================
|
||||
7. The current directory *current-directory*
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*eval.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Apr 13
|
||||
*eval.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Dec 05
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -91,8 +91,8 @@ For boolean operators Numbers are used. Zero is FALSE, non-zero is TRUE.
|
||||
Note that in the command >
|
||||
:if "foo"
|
||||
"foo" is converted to 0, which means FALSE. To test for a non-empty string,
|
||||
use strlen(): >
|
||||
:if strlen("foo")
|
||||
use empty(): >
|
||||
:if !empty("foo")
|
||||
< *E745* *E728* *E703* *E729* *E730* *E731*
|
||||
List, Dictionary and Funcref types are not automatically converted.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -759,7 +759,7 @@ of a |List| is different from the original |List|. When using "is" without
|
||||
a |List| or a |Dictionary| it is equivalent to using "equal", using "isnot"
|
||||
equivalent to using "not equal". Except that a different type means the
|
||||
values are different: "4 == '4'" is true, "4 is '4'" is false and "0 is []" is
|
||||
false and not a error. "is#"/"isnot#" and "is?"/"isnot?" can be used to match
|
||||
false and not an error. "is#"/"isnot#" and "is?"/"isnot?" can be used to match
|
||||
and ignore case.
|
||||
|
||||
When comparing a String with a Number, the String is converted to a Number,
|
||||
@@ -1544,15 +1544,18 @@ v:profiling Normally zero. Set to one after using ":profile start".
|
||||
|
||||
*v:progname* *progname-variable*
|
||||
v:progname Contains the name (with path removed) with which Vim was
|
||||
invoked. Allows you to do special initialisations for "view",
|
||||
"evim" etc., or any other name you might symlink to Vim.
|
||||
invoked. Allows you to do special initialisations for |view|,
|
||||
|evim| etc., or any other name you might symlink to Vim.
|
||||
Read-only.
|
||||
|
||||
*v:register* *register-variable*
|
||||
v:register The name of the register in effect for the current normal mode
|
||||
command. If none is supplied it is the default register '"',
|
||||
unless 'clipboard' contains "unnamed" or "unnamedplus", then
|
||||
it is '*' or '+'.
|
||||
command (regardless of whether that command actually used a
|
||||
register). Or for the currently executing normal mode mapping
|
||||
(use this in custom commands that take a register).
|
||||
If none is supplied it is the default register '"', unless
|
||||
'clipboard' contains "unnamed" or "unnamedplus", then it is
|
||||
'*' or '+'.
|
||||
Also see |getreg()| and |setreg()|
|
||||
|
||||
*v:scrollstart* *scrollstart-variable*
|
||||
@@ -1844,6 +1847,7 @@ lispindent( {lnum}) Number Lisp indent for line {lnum}
|
||||
localtime() Number current time
|
||||
log( {expr}) Float natural logarithm (base e) of {expr}
|
||||
log10( {expr}) Float logarithm of Float {expr} to base 10
|
||||
luaeval( {expr}[, {expr}]) any evaluate |Lua| expression
|
||||
map( {expr}, {string}) List/Dict change each item in {expr} to {expr}
|
||||
maparg( {name}[, {mode} [, {abbr} [, {dict}]]])
|
||||
String or Dict
|
||||
@@ -1876,6 +1880,8 @@ pow( {x}, {y}) Float {x} to the power of {y}
|
||||
prevnonblank( {lnum}) Number line nr of non-blank line <= {lnum}
|
||||
printf( {fmt}, {expr1}...) String format text
|
||||
pumvisible() Number whether popup menu is visible
|
||||
pyeval( {expr}) any evaluate |Python| expression
|
||||
py3eval( {expr}) any evaluate |python3| expression
|
||||
range( {expr} [, {max} [, {stride}]])
|
||||
List items from {expr} to {max}
|
||||
readfile( {fname} [, {binary} [, {max}]])
|
||||
@@ -1897,6 +1903,8 @@ repeat( {expr}, {count}) String repeat {expr} {count} times
|
||||
resolve( {filename}) String get filename a shortcut points to
|
||||
reverse( {list}) List reverse {list} in-place
|
||||
round( {expr}) Float round off {expr}
|
||||
screencol() Number current cursor column
|
||||
screenrow() Number current cursor row
|
||||
search( {pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]])
|
||||
Number search for {pattern}
|
||||
searchdecl( {name} [, {global} [, {thisblock}]])
|
||||
@@ -1926,6 +1934,7 @@ setwinvar( {nr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in window {nr} to {val}
|
||||
shellescape( {string} [, {special}])
|
||||
String escape {string} for use as shell
|
||||
command argument
|
||||
shiftwidth() Number effective value of 'shiftwidth'
|
||||
simplify( {filename}) String simplify filename as much as possible
|
||||
sin( {expr}) Float sine of {expr}
|
||||
sinh( {expr}) Float hyperbolic sine of {expr}
|
||||
@@ -2313,7 +2322,7 @@ col({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the byte index of the column
|
||||
position given with {expr}. The accepted positions are:
|
||||
. the cursor position
|
||||
$ the end of the cursor line (the result is the
|
||||
number of characters in the cursor line plus one)
|
||||
number of bytes in the cursor line plus one)
|
||||
'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is
|
||||
returned)
|
||||
Additionally {expr} can be [lnum, col]: a |List| with the line
|
||||
@@ -3282,8 +3291,9 @@ getfperm({fname}) *getfperm()*
|
||||
"rwx" flags represent, in turn, the permissions of the owner
|
||||
of the file, the group the file belongs to, and other users.
|
||||
If a user does not have a given permission the flag for this
|
||||
is replaced with the string "-". Example: >
|
||||
is replaced with the string "-". Examples: >
|
||||
:echo getfperm("/etc/passwd")
|
||||
:echo getfperm(expand("~/.vimrc"))
|
||||
< This will hopefully (from a security point of view) display
|
||||
the string "rw-r--r--" or even "rw-------".
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -3561,6 +3571,9 @@ histadd({history}, {item}) *histadd()*
|
||||
"search" or "/" search pattern history
|
||||
"expr" or "=" typed expression history
|
||||
"input" or "@" input line history
|
||||
"debug" or ">" debug command history
|
||||
The {history} string does not need to be the whole name, one
|
||||
character is sufficient.
|
||||
If {item} does already exist in the history, it will be
|
||||
shifted to become the newest entry.
|
||||
The result is a Number: 1 if the operation was successful,
|
||||
@@ -3744,10 +3757,10 @@ inputdialog({prompt} [, {text} [, {cancelreturn}]]) *inputdialog()*
|
||||
Like |input()|, but when the GUI is running and text dialogs
|
||||
are supported, a dialog window pops up to input the text.
|
||||
Example: >
|
||||
:let n = inputdialog("value for shiftwidth", &sw)
|
||||
:if n != ""
|
||||
: let &sw = n
|
||||
:endif
|
||||
:let n = inputdialog("value for shiftwidth", shiftwidth())
|
||||
:if n != ""
|
||||
: let &sw = n
|
||||
:endif
|
||||
< When the dialog is cancelled {cancelreturn} is returned. When
|
||||
omitted an empty string is returned.
|
||||
Hitting <Enter> works like pressing the OK button. Hitting
|
||||
@@ -3997,6 +4010,20 @@ log10({expr}) *log10()*
|
||||
< -2.0
|
||||
{only available when compiled with the |+float| feature}
|
||||
|
||||
luaeval({expr}[, {expr}]) *luaeval()*
|
||||
Evaluate Lua expression {expr} and return its result converted
|
||||
to Vim data structures. Second {expr} may hold additional
|
||||
argument accessible as _A inside first {expr}.
|
||||
Strings are returned as they are.
|
||||
Boolean objects are converted to numbers.
|
||||
Numbers are converted to |Float| values if vim was compiled
|
||||
with |+float| and to numbers otherwise.
|
||||
Dictionaries and lists obtained by vim.eval() are returned
|
||||
as-is.
|
||||
Other objects are returned as zero without any errors.
|
||||
See |lua-luaeval| for more details.
|
||||
{only available when compiled with the |+lua| feature}
|
||||
|
||||
map({expr}, {string}) *map()*
|
||||
{expr} must be a |List| or a |Dictionary|.
|
||||
Replace each item in {expr} with the result of evaluating
|
||||
@@ -4015,7 +4042,7 @@ map({expr}, {string}) *map()*
|
||||
|
||||
The operation is done in-place. If you want a |List| or
|
||||
|Dictionary| to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
|
||||
:let tlist = map(copy(mylist), ' & . "\t"')
|
||||
:let tlist = map(copy(mylist), ' v:val . "\t"')
|
||||
|
||||
< Returns {expr}, the |List| or |Dictionary| that was filtered.
|
||||
When an error is encountered while evaluating {string} no
|
||||
@@ -4321,7 +4348,7 @@ mode([expr]) Return a string that indicates the current mode.
|
||||
|
||||
mzeval({expr}) *mzeval()*
|
||||
Evaluate MzScheme expression {expr} and return its result
|
||||
convert to Vim data structures.
|
||||
converted to Vim data structures.
|
||||
Numbers and strings are returned as they are.
|
||||
Pairs (including lists and improper lists) and vectors are
|
||||
returned as Vim |Lists|.
|
||||
@@ -4426,6 +4453,7 @@ printf({fmt}, {expr1} ...) *printf()*
|
||||
|
||||
Often used items are:
|
||||
%s string
|
||||
%6S string right-aligned in 6 display cells
|
||||
%6s string right-aligned in 6 bytes
|
||||
%.9s string truncated to 9 bytes
|
||||
%c single byte
|
||||
@@ -4540,6 +4568,10 @@ printf({fmt}, {expr1} ...) *printf()*
|
||||
s The text of the String argument is used. If a
|
||||
precision is specified, no more bytes than the number
|
||||
specified are used.
|
||||
S The text of the String argument is used. If a
|
||||
precision is specified, no more display cells than the
|
||||
number specified are used. Without the |+multi_byte|
|
||||
feature works just like 's'.
|
||||
|
||||
*printf-f* *E807*
|
||||
f The Float argument is converted into a string of the
|
||||
@@ -4592,6 +4624,29 @@ pumvisible() *pumvisible()*
|
||||
This can be used to avoid some things that would remove the
|
||||
popup menu.
|
||||
|
||||
*E860* *E861*
|
||||
py3eval({expr}) *py3eval()*
|
||||
Evaluate Python expression {expr} and return its result
|
||||
converted to Vim data structures.
|
||||
Numbers and strings are returned as they are (strings are
|
||||
copied though, unicode strings are additionally converted to
|
||||
'encoding').
|
||||
Lists are represented as Vim |List| type.
|
||||
Dictionaries are represented as Vim |Dictionary| type with
|
||||
keys converted to strings.
|
||||
{only available when compiled with the |+python3| feature}
|
||||
|
||||
*E858* *E859*
|
||||
pyeval({expr}) *pyeval()*
|
||||
Evaluate Python expression {expr} and return its result
|
||||
converted to Vim data structures.
|
||||
Numbers and strings are returned as they are (strings are
|
||||
copied though).
|
||||
Lists are represented as Vim |List| type.
|
||||
Dictionaries are represented as Vim |Dictionary| type,
|
||||
non-string keys result in error.
|
||||
{only available when compiled with the |+python| feature}
|
||||
|
||||
*E726* *E727*
|
||||
range({expr} [, {max} [, {stride}]]) *range()*
|
||||
Returns a |List| with Numbers:
|
||||
@@ -4819,15 +4874,34 @@ round({expr}) *round()*
|
||||
echo round(-4.5)
|
||||
< -5.0
|
||||
{only available when compiled with the |+float| feature}
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
screencol() *screencol()*
|
||||
The result is a Number, which is the current screen column of
|
||||
the cursor. The leftmost column has number 1.
|
||||
This function is mainly used for testing.
|
||||
|
||||
Note: Always returns the current screen column, thus if used
|
||||
in a command (e.g. ":echo screencol()") it will return the
|
||||
column inside the command line, which is 1 when the command is
|
||||
executed. To get the cursor position in the file use one of
|
||||
the following mappings: >
|
||||
nnoremap <expr> GG ":echom ".screencol()."\n"
|
||||
nnoremap <silent> GG :echom screencol()<CR>
|
||||
<
|
||||
screenrow() *screenrow()*
|
||||
The result is a Number, which is the current screen row of the
|
||||
cursor. The top line has number one.
|
||||
This function is mainly used for testing.
|
||||
|
||||
Note: Same restrictions as with |screencol()|.
|
||||
|
||||
search({pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]) *search()*
|
||||
Search for regexp pattern {pattern}. The search starts at the
|
||||
cursor position (you can use |cursor()| to set it).
|
||||
|
||||
When a match has been found its line number is returned.
|
||||
If there is no match a 0 is returned and the cursor doesn't
|
||||
move. No error message is given.
|
||||
When a match has been found its line number is returned.
|
||||
|
||||
{flags} is a String, which can contain these character flags:
|
||||
'b' search backward instead of forward
|
||||
@@ -4856,7 +4930,7 @@ search({pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]) *search()*
|
||||
A zero value is equal to not giving the argument.
|
||||
|
||||
When the {timeout} argument is given the search stops when
|
||||
more than this many milli seconds have passed. Thus when
|
||||
more than this many milliseconds have passed. Thus when
|
||||
{timeout} is 500 the search stops after half a second.
|
||||
The value must not be negative. A zero value is like not
|
||||
giving the argument.
|
||||
@@ -5206,8 +5280,9 @@ setreg({regname}, {value} [,{options}])
|
||||
|
||||
If {options} contains no register settings, then the default
|
||||
is to use character mode unless {value} ends in a <NL>.
|
||||
Setting the '=' register is not possible.
|
||||
Returns zero for success, non-zero for failure.
|
||||
Setting the '=' register is not possible, but you can use >
|
||||
:let @= = var_expr
|
||||
< Returns zero for success, non-zero for failure.
|
||||
|
||||
Examples: >
|
||||
:call setreg(v:register, @*)
|
||||
@@ -5283,6 +5358,23 @@ shellescape({string} [, {special}]) *shellescape()*
|
||||
:call system("chmod +w -- " . shellescape(expand("%")))
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
shiftwidth() *shiftwidth()*
|
||||
Returns the effective value of 'shiftwidth'. This is the
|
||||
'shiftwidth' value unless it is zero, in which case it is the
|
||||
'tabstop' value. To be backwards compatible in indent
|
||||
plugins, use this: >
|
||||
if exists('*shiftwidth')
|
||||
func s:sw()
|
||||
return shiftwidth()
|
||||
endfunc
|
||||
else
|
||||
func s:sw()
|
||||
return &sw
|
||||
endfunc
|
||||
endif
|
||||
< And then use s:sw() instead of &sw.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
simplify({filename}) *simplify()*
|
||||
Simplify the file name as much as possible without changing
|
||||
the meaning. Shortcuts (on MS-Windows) or symbolic links (on
|
||||
@@ -5412,7 +5504,8 @@ split({expr} [, {pattern} [, {keepempty}]]) *split()*
|
||||
empty each white-separated sequence of characters becomes an
|
||||
item.
|
||||
Otherwise the string is split where {pattern} matches,
|
||||
removing the matched characters.
|
||||
removing the matched characters. 'ignorecase' is not used
|
||||
here, add \c to ignore case. |/\c|
|
||||
When the first or last item is empty it is omitted, unless the
|
||||
{keepempty} argument is given and it's non-zero.
|
||||
Other empty items are kept when {pattern} matches at least one
|
||||
@@ -5622,8 +5715,10 @@ substitute({expr}, {pat}, {sub}, {flags}) *substitute()*
|
||||
This works like the ":substitute" command (without any flags).
|
||||
But the matching with {pat} is always done like the 'magic'
|
||||
option is set and 'cpoptions' is empty (to make scripts
|
||||
portable). 'ignorecase' is still relevant. 'smartcase' is
|
||||
not used. See |string-match| for how {pat} is used.
|
||||
portable). 'ignorecase' is still relevant, use |/\c| or |/\C|
|
||||
if you want to ignore or match case and ignore 'ignorecase'.
|
||||
'smartcase' is not used. See |string-match| for how {pat} is
|
||||
used.
|
||||
|
||||
A "~" in {sub} is not replaced with the previous {sub}.
|
||||
Note that some codes in {sub} have a special meaning
|
||||
@@ -5946,6 +6041,8 @@ undofile({name}) *undofile()*
|
||||
the undo file exists.
|
||||
{name} is always expanded to the full path, since that is what
|
||||
is used internally.
|
||||
If {name} is empty undofile() returns an empty string, since a
|
||||
buffer without a file name will not write an undo file.
|
||||
Useful in combination with |:wundo| and |:rundo|.
|
||||
When compiled without the +persistent_undo option this always
|
||||
returns an empty string.
|
||||
@@ -6086,8 +6183,9 @@ winline() The result is a Number, which is the screen line of the cursor
|
||||
winnr([{arg}]) The result is a Number, which is the number of the current
|
||||
window. The top window has number 1.
|
||||
When the optional argument is "$", the number of the
|
||||
last window is returned (the window count).
|
||||
When the optional argument is "#", the number of the last
|
||||
last window is returned (the window count). >
|
||||
let window_count = winnr('$')
|
||||
< When the optional argument is "#", the number of the last
|
||||
accessed window is returned (where |CTRL-W_p| goes to).
|
||||
If there is no previous window or it is in another tab page 0
|
||||
is returned.
|
||||
@@ -6199,6 +6297,7 @@ balloon_multiline GUI supports multiline balloons.
|
||||
beos BeOS version of Vim.
|
||||
browse Compiled with |:browse| support, and browse() will
|
||||
work.
|
||||
browsefilter Compiled with support for |browsefilter|.
|
||||
builtin_terms Compiled with some builtin terminals.
|
||||
byte_offset Compiled with support for 'o' in 'statusline'
|
||||
cindent Compiled with 'cindent' support.
|
||||
@@ -6276,6 +6375,7 @@ mouse_gpm Compiled with support for gpm (Linux console mouse)
|
||||
mouse_netterm Compiled with support for netterm mouse.
|
||||
mouse_pterm Compiled with support for qnx pterm mouse.
|
||||
mouse_sysmouse Compiled with support for sysmouse (*BSD console mouse)
|
||||
mouse_sgr Compiled with support for sgr mouse.
|
||||
mouse_urxvt Compiled with support for urxvt mouse.
|
||||
mouse_xterm Compiled with support for xterm mouse.
|
||||
mouseshape Compiled with support for 'mouseshape'.
|
||||
@@ -6456,6 +6556,8 @@ See |:verbose-cmd| for more information.
|
||||
is excluded, ":{range}call" will call the function for
|
||||
each line in the range, with the cursor on the start
|
||||
of each line. See |function-range-example|.
|
||||
The cursor is still moved to the first line of the
|
||||
range, as is the case with all Ex commands.
|
||||
|
||||
When the [abort] argument is added, the function will
|
||||
abort as soon as an error is detected.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -54,3 +54,4 @@ Voir le menu Aide/Remerciements ou ":help credits" dans
|
||||
.SH TRADUCTION
|
||||
Cette page de manuel a <20>t<EFBFBD> traduite David Blanchet.
|
||||
<david.blanchet@free.fr> 2005-03-26.
|
||||
Mise <20> jour 2012-05-06, Dominique Pell<6C> <dominique.pelle@gmail.com>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -54,3 +54,4 @@ Voir le menu Aide/Remerciements ou ":help credits" dans
|
||||
.SH TRADUCTION
|
||||
Cette page de manuel a été traduite David Blanchet.
|
||||
<david.blanchet@free.fr> 2005-03-26.
|
||||
Mise à jour 2012-05-06, Dominique Pellé <dominique.pelle@gmail.com>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*gui_w32.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2011 Jul 23
|
||||
*gui_w32.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 04
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -489,4 +489,16 @@ to:
|
||||
And add gvim to the list of applications. This problem only appears to happen
|
||||
with the Intellimouse driver 2.2 and when "Universal Scrolling" is turned on.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
XPM support *w32-xpm-support*
|
||||
|
||||
Gvim can be build on MS-Windows with support for XPM files. |+xpm_w32|
|
||||
See the Make_mvc.mak file for instructions, search for XPM.
|
||||
|
||||
To try out if XPM support works do this: >
|
||||
:help
|
||||
:exe 'sign define vimxpm icon=' . $VIMRUNTIME . '\\vim16x16.xpm'
|
||||
:exe 'sign place 1 line=1 name=vimxpm file=' . expand('%:p')
|
||||
<
|
||||
|
||||
vim:tw=78:sw=4:ts=8:ft=help:norl:
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -93,7 +93,7 @@ Details
|
||||
This is also the keymap when 'keymap=hebrew' is set. The advantage of
|
||||
'keymap' is that it works properly when using UTF8, e.g. it inserts the
|
||||
correct characters; 'hkmap' does not. The 'keymap' keyboard can also
|
||||
insert niqud and te`amim. To see what those mappings are,look at the
|
||||
insert niqud and te`amim. To see what those mappings are, look at the
|
||||
keymap file 'hebrew.vim' etc.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*helphelp.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2010 Sep 14
|
||||
*helphelp.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Nov 28
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -194,11 +194,12 @@ command: >
|
||||
*E154* *E150* *E151* *E152* *E153* *E670*
|
||||
:helpt[ags] [++t] {dir}
|
||||
Generate the help tags file(s) for directory {dir}.
|
||||
All "*.txt" and "*.??x" files in the directory are
|
||||
scanned for a help tag definition in between stars.
|
||||
The "*.??x" files are for translated docs, they
|
||||
generate the "tags-??" file, see |help-translated|.
|
||||
The generated tags files are sorted.
|
||||
All "*.txt" and "*.??x" files in the directory and
|
||||
sub-directories are scanned for a help tag definition
|
||||
in between stars. The "*.??x" files are for
|
||||
translated docs, they generate the "tags-??" file, see
|
||||
|help-translated|. The generated tags files are
|
||||
sorted.
|
||||
When there are duplicates an error message is given.
|
||||
An existing tags file is silently overwritten.
|
||||
The optional "++t" argument forces adding the
|
||||
@@ -218,11 +219,12 @@ files. Vim will search for all help in "doc" directories in 'runtimepath'.
|
||||
This is only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang| feature.
|
||||
|
||||
At this moment translations are available for:
|
||||
Chinese - multiple authors
|
||||
French - translated by David Blanchet
|
||||
Italian - translated by Antonio Colombo
|
||||
Polish - translated by Mikolaj Machowski
|
||||
Russian - translated by Vassily Ragosin
|
||||
Chinese - multiple authors
|
||||
French - translated by David Blanchet
|
||||
Italian - translated by Antonio Colombo
|
||||
Japanese - multiple authors
|
||||
Polish - translated by Mikolaj Machowski
|
||||
Russian - translated by Vassily Ragosin
|
||||
See the Vim website to find them: http://www.vim.org/translations.php
|
||||
|
||||
A set of translated help files consists of these files:
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*if_lua.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Jan 16
|
||||
*if_lua.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Jun 29
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Luis Carvalho
|
||||
@@ -313,7 +313,7 @@ Examples:
|
||||
<
|
||||
|
||||
==============================================================================
|
||||
7. The luaeval function *lua-luaeval*
|
||||
7. The luaeval function *lua-luaeval* *lua-eval*
|
||||
|
||||
The (dual) equivalent of "vim.eval" for passing Lua values to Vim is
|
||||
"luaeval". "luaeval" takes an expression string and an optional argument and
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*if_perl.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2010 Jul 21
|
||||
*if_perl.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Oct 25
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Sven Verdoolaege
|
||||
@@ -44,15 +44,17 @@ The Perl patches for Vim were made by:
|
||||
Sven Verdoolaege <skimo@breughel.ufsia.ac.be>
|
||||
Matt Gerassimof
|
||||
|
||||
Perl for MS-Windows can be found at:
|
||||
http://www.perl.com/CPAN/ports/nt/Standard/x86/
|
||||
Perl for MS-Windows can be found at: http://www.perl.com/
|
||||
The ActiveState one should work.
|
||||
|
||||
==============================================================================
|
||||
3. Using the Perl interface *perl-using*
|
||||
|
||||
*:perl* *:pe*
|
||||
:pe[rl] {cmd} Execute Perl command {cmd}. The current package
|
||||
is "main".
|
||||
is "main". Simple example to test if `:perl` is
|
||||
working: >
|
||||
:perl VIM::Msg("Hello")
|
||||
|
||||
:pe[rl] << {endpattern}
|
||||
{script}
|
||||
@@ -173,7 +175,8 @@ VIM::Windows([{wn}...]) With no arguments, returns a list of all the windows
|
||||
VIM::DoCommand({cmd}) Executes Ex command {cmd}.
|
||||
|
||||
*perl-Eval*
|
||||
VIM::Eval({expr}) Evaluates {expr} and returns (success, val).
|
||||
VIM::Eval({expr}) Evaluates {expr} and returns (success, value) in list
|
||||
context or just value in scalar context.
|
||||
success=1 indicates that val contains the value of
|
||||
{expr}; success=0 indicates a failure to evaluate
|
||||
the expression. '@x' returns the contents of register
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*if_pyth.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Feb 04
|
||||
*if_pyth.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Sep 23
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Paul Moore
|
||||
@@ -6,13 +6,14 @@
|
||||
|
||||
The Python Interface to Vim *python* *Python*
|
||||
|
||||
1. Commands |python-commands|
|
||||
2. The vim module |python-vim|
|
||||
3. Buffer objects |python-buffer|
|
||||
4. Range objects |python-range|
|
||||
5. Window objects |python-window|
|
||||
6. Dynamic loading |python-dynamic|
|
||||
7. Python 3 |python3|
|
||||
1. Commands |python-commands|
|
||||
2. The vim module |python-vim|
|
||||
3. Buffer objects |python-buffer|
|
||||
4. Range objects |python-range|
|
||||
5. Window objects |python-window|
|
||||
6. pyeval(), py3eval() Vim functions |python-pyeval|
|
||||
7. Dynamic loading |python-dynamic|
|
||||
8. Python 3 |python3|
|
||||
|
||||
{Vi does not have any of these commands}
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -26,7 +27,9 @@ The Python 3 interface is available only when Vim was compiled with the
|
||||
|
||||
*:python* *:py* *E205* *E263* *E264*
|
||||
:[range]py[thon] {stmt}
|
||||
Execute Python statement {stmt}.
|
||||
Execute Python statement {stmt}. A simple check if
|
||||
the `:python` command is working: >
|
||||
:python print "Hello"
|
||||
|
||||
:[range]py[thon] << {endmarker}
|
||||
{script}
|
||||
@@ -150,6 +153,42 @@ vim.eval(str) *python-eval*
|
||||
[{'cmd': '/^eval_expr(arg, nextcmd)$/', 'static': 0, 'name':
|
||||
'eval_expr', 'kind': 'f', 'filename': './src/eval.c'}]
|
||||
|
||||
vim.bindeval(str) *python-bindeval*
|
||||
Like |python-eval|, but
|
||||
1. if expression evaluates to |List| or |Dictionary| it is returned as
|
||||
vimlist or vimdictionary python type that are connected to original
|
||||
list or dictionary. Thus modifications to these objects imply
|
||||
modifications of the original.
|
||||
|
||||
Additionally, vimlist and vimdictionary type have read-write
|
||||
`.locked` attribute that returns
|
||||
Value Meaning ~
|
||||
zero Variable is not locked
|
||||
vim.VAR_LOCKED Variable is locked, but can be unlocked
|
||||
vim.VAR_FIXED Variable is locked and can't be unlocked
|
||||
integer constants. If variable is not fixed, you can do
|
||||
`var.locked=True` to lock it and `var.locked=False` to unlock.
|
||||
There is no recursive locking like |:lockvar|! does. There is also
|
||||
no way to lock a specific key or check whether it is locked (in any
|
||||
case these locks are ignored by anything except |:let|: |extend()|
|
||||
does not care, neither does python interface).
|
||||
|
||||
Vimdictionary type also supports `.scope` attribute which is one of
|
||||
Value Meaning ~
|
||||
zero Dictionary is not a scope one
|
||||
vim.VAR_DEF_SCOPE Function-local or global scope dictionary
|
||||
vim.VAR_SCOPE Other scope dictionary
|
||||
|
||||
2. if expression evaluates to a function reference, then it returns
|
||||
callable vimfunction object. Use self keyword argument to assign
|
||||
|self| object for dictionary functions.
|
||||
|
||||
Note: this function has the same behavior as |lua-eval| (except that
|
||||
lua does not support running vim functions), |python-eval| is
|
||||
kept for backwards compatibility in order not to make scripts
|
||||
relying on outputs of vim.eval() being a copy of original or
|
||||
vim.eval("1") returning a string.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Error object of the "vim" module
|
||||
@@ -319,7 +358,13 @@ The height attribute is writable only if the screen is split horizontally.
|
||||
The width attribute is writable only if the screen is split vertically.
|
||||
|
||||
==============================================================================
|
||||
6. Dynamic loading *python-dynamic*
|
||||
6. pyeval() and py3eval() Vim functions *python-pyeval*
|
||||
|
||||
To facilitate bi-directional interface, you can use |pyeval()| and |py3eval()|
|
||||
functions to evaluate Python expressions and pass their values to VimL.
|
||||
|
||||
==============================================================================
|
||||
7. Dynamic loading *python-dynamic*
|
||||
|
||||
On MS-Windows the Python library can be loaded dynamically. The |:version|
|
||||
output then includes |+python/dyn|.
|
||||
@@ -336,13 +381,16 @@ Currently the name is "python24.dll". That is for Python 2.4. To know for
|
||||
sure edit "gvim.exe" and search for "python\d*.dll\c".
|
||||
|
||||
==============================================================================
|
||||
7. Python 3 *python3*
|
||||
8. Python 3 *python3*
|
||||
|
||||
*:py3* *:python3*
|
||||
The |:py3| and |:python3| commands work similar to |:python|.
|
||||
*:py3file*
|
||||
The |:py3| and |:python3| commands work similar to |:python|. A simple check
|
||||
if the `:py3` command is wrong: >
|
||||
:py3 print("Hello")
|
||||
< *:py3file*
|
||||
The |:py3file| command works similar to |:pyfile|.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Vim can be built in four ways (:version output):
|
||||
1. No Python support (-python, -python3)
|
||||
2. Python 2 support only (+python or +python/dyn, -python3)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*if_ruby.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2010 Oct 27
|
||||
*if_ruby.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 02
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Shugo Maeda
|
||||
@@ -25,7 +25,8 @@ downloading Ruby there.
|
||||
1. Commands *ruby-commands*
|
||||
|
||||
*:ruby* *:rub*
|
||||
:rub[y] {cmd} Execute Ruby command {cmd}.
|
||||
:rub[y] {cmd} Execute Ruby command {cmd}. A command to try it out: >
|
||||
:ruby print "Hello"
|
||||
|
||||
:rub[y] << {endpattern}
|
||||
{script}
|
||||
@@ -40,9 +41,6 @@ downloading Ruby there.
|
||||
wasn't compiled in. To avoid errors, see
|
||||
|script-here|.
|
||||
|
||||
Command to try it out: >
|
||||
:ruby print "Hello" # this is a comment
|
||||
|
||||
Example Vim script: >
|
||||
|
||||
function! RedGem()
|
||||
@@ -211,6 +209,8 @@ for sure edit "gvim.exe" and search for "ruby\d*.dll\c".
|
||||
|
||||
If you want to build Vim with Ruby 1.9.1, you need to edit the config.h file
|
||||
and comment-out the check for _MSC_VER.
|
||||
You may also need to rename the include directory name to match the version,
|
||||
strangely for Ruby 1.9.3 the directory is called 1.9.1.
|
||||
|
||||
==============================================================================
|
||||
vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl:
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*if_tcl.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2008 Aug 16
|
||||
*if_tcl.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 02
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Ingo Wilken
|
||||
@@ -27,7 +27,9 @@ comments, ideas etc to <Ingo.Wilken@informatik.uni-oldenburg.de>
|
||||
1. Commands *tcl-ex-commands* *E571* *E572*
|
||||
|
||||
*:tcl* *:tc*
|
||||
:tc[l] {cmd} Execute Tcl command {cmd}.
|
||||
:tc[l] {cmd} Execute Tcl command {cmd}. A simple check if `:tcl`
|
||||
is working: >
|
||||
:tcl puts "Hello"
|
||||
|
||||
:[range]tc[l] << {endmarker}
|
||||
{script}
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*indent.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2011 Sep 02
|
||||
*indent.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 30
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -540,7 +540,7 @@ The examples below assume a 'shiftwidth' of 4.
|
||||
*cino-star*
|
||||
*N Vim searches for unclosed comments at most N lines away. This
|
||||
limits the time needed to search for the start of a comment.
|
||||
If your /* */ comments stop indenting afer N lines this is the
|
||||
If your /* */ comments stop indenting after N lines this is the
|
||||
value you will want to change.
|
||||
(default 70 lines).
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*index.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2011 Aug 06
|
||||
*index.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Jul 25
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -719,6 +719,8 @@ tag char note action in Normal mode ~
|
||||
|gH| gH start Select line mode
|
||||
|gI| gI 2 like "I", but always start in column 1
|
||||
|gJ| gJ 2 join lines without inserting space
|
||||
|gN| gN 1,2 find the previous match with the last used
|
||||
search pattern and Visually select it
|
||||
|gP| ["x]gP 2 put the text [from register x] before the
|
||||
cursor N times, leave the cursor after it
|
||||
|gQ| gQ switch to "Ex" mode with Vim editing
|
||||
@@ -751,6 +753,8 @@ tag char note action in Normal mode ~
|
||||
lines down
|
||||
|gk| gk 1 like "k", but when 'wrap' on go N screen
|
||||
lines up
|
||||
|gn| gn 1,2 find the next match with the last used
|
||||
search pattern and Visually select it
|
||||
|gm| gm 1 go to character at middle of the screenline
|
||||
|go| go 1 cursor to byte N in the buffer
|
||||
|gp| ["x]gp 2 put the text [from register x] after the
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*insert.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Apr 05
|
||||
*insert.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Jul 10
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -383,8 +383,11 @@ will then always put the cursor on it). Or use CTRL-\ CTRL-O, but then
|
||||
beware of the cursor possibly being beyond the end of the line.
|
||||
|
||||
The CTRL-O command takes you to Normal mode. If you then use a command enter
|
||||
Insert mode again it doesn't nest. Thus when typing "a<C-O>a" and then <Esc>
|
||||
takes you back to Normal mode, you do not need to type <Esc> twice.
|
||||
Insert mode again it normally doesn't nest. Thus when typing "a<C-O>a" and
|
||||
then <Esc> takes you back to Normal mode, you do not need to type <Esc> twice.
|
||||
An exception is when not typing the command, e.g. when executing a mapping or
|
||||
sourcing a script. This makes mappings work that briefly switch to Insert
|
||||
mode.
|
||||
|
||||
The shifted cursor keys are not available on all terminals.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -488,7 +491,7 @@ option}
|
||||
*ins-smarttab*
|
||||
When the 'smarttab' option is on, a <Tab> inserts 'shiftwidth' positions at
|
||||
the beginning of a line and 'tabstop' positions in other places. This means
|
||||
that often spaces instead of a <Tab> character are inserted. When 'smarttab
|
||||
that often spaces instead of a <Tab> character are inserted. When 'smarttab'
|
||||
is off, a <Tab> always inserts 'tabstop' positions, and 'shiftwidth' is only
|
||||
used for ">>" and the like. {not in Vi}
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1014,9 +1017,13 @@ The function must return the column where the completion starts. It must be a
|
||||
number between zero and the cursor column "col('.')". This involves looking
|
||||
at the characters just before the cursor and including those characters that
|
||||
could be part of the completed item. The text between this column and the
|
||||
cursor column will be replaced with the matches. Return -1 if no completion
|
||||
can be done, the completion will be cancelled with an error message. Return
|
||||
-2 to cancel silently.
|
||||
cursor column will be replaced with the matches.
|
||||
|
||||
Special return values:
|
||||
-1 If no completion can be done, the completion will be cancelled with an
|
||||
error message.
|
||||
-2 To cancel silently and stay in completion mode.
|
||||
-3 To cancel silently and leave completion mode.
|
||||
|
||||
On the second invocation the arguments are:
|
||||
a:findstart 0
|
||||
@@ -1037,6 +1044,8 @@ that contains the List. The Dict can have these items:
|
||||
leading text is changed.
|
||||
Other items are ignored.
|
||||
|
||||
For acting upon end of completion, see the |CompleteDone| autocommand event.
|
||||
|
||||
For example, the function can contain this: >
|
||||
let matches = ... list of words ...
|
||||
return {'words': matches, 'refresh': 'always'}
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*intro.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2011 May 15
|
||||
*intro.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Sep 05
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -394,6 +394,8 @@ CTRL-{char} {char} typed as a control character; that is, typing {char}
|
||||
*quotecommandquote*
|
||||
"command" A reference to a command that you can type is enclosed in
|
||||
double quotes.
|
||||
`command` New style command, this distinguishes it from other
|
||||
quoted text and strings.
|
||||
|
||||
*key-notation* *key-codes* *keycodes*
|
||||
These names for keys are used in the documentation. They can also be used
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1219,6 +1219,7 @@ completion can be enabled:
|
||||
|
||||
-complete=augroup autocmd groups
|
||||
-complete=buffer buffer names
|
||||
-complete=behave :behave suboptions
|
||||
-complete=color color schemes
|
||||
-complete=command Ex command (and arguments)
|
||||
-complete=compiler compilers
|
||||
@@ -1233,6 +1234,7 @@ completion can be enabled:
|
||||
-complete=function function name
|
||||
-complete=help help subjects
|
||||
-complete=highlight highlight groups
|
||||
-complete=history :history suboptions
|
||||
-complete=locale locale names (as output of locale -a)
|
||||
-complete=mapping mapping name
|
||||
-complete=menu menus
|
||||
@@ -1242,6 +1244,7 @@ completion can be enabled:
|
||||
-complete=syntax syntax file names |'syntax'|
|
||||
-complete=tag tags
|
||||
-complete=tag_listfiles tags, file names are shown when CTRL-D is hit
|
||||
-complete=user user names
|
||||
-complete=var user variables
|
||||
-complete=custom,{func} custom completion, defined via {func}
|
||||
-complete=customlist,{func} custom completion, defined via {func}
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*mbyte.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Feb 29
|
||||
*mbyte.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Oct 06
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar et al.
|
||||
@@ -475,7 +475,7 @@ Useful utilities for converting the charset:
|
||||
|charset| converter. Supported |charset|: ISO-2022-CN, ISO-2022-JP,
|
||||
ISO-2022-KR, EUC-CN, EUC-JP, EUC-KR, EUC-TW, UTF-7, UTF-8, ISO-8859
|
||||
series, Shift_JIS, Big5 and HZ. Lv can be found at:
|
||||
http://www.ff.iij4u.or.jp/~nrt/freeware/lv4495.tar.gz
|
||||
http://www.ff.iij4u.or.jp/~nrt/lv/index.html
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
*mbyte-conversion*
|
||||
@@ -615,7 +615,7 @@ Each field means:
|
||||
charsets, such as JIS X 0208, if this field is 0, code points has
|
||||
the same value as GL, and GR if 1.
|
||||
|
||||
For example, in case of a 14 dots font corresponding to JIS X 0208, it is
|
||||
For example, in case of a 16 dots font corresponding to JIS X 0208, it is
|
||||
written like:
|
||||
-misc-fixed-medium-r-normal--16-110-100-100-c-160-jisx0208.1990-0
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1085,6 +1085,13 @@ Since the mapping is defined with |:lnoremap| the resulting quote will not be
|
||||
used for the start of another character.
|
||||
The "accents" keymap uses this. *keymap-accents*
|
||||
|
||||
The first column can also be in |<>| form:
|
||||
<C-c> Ctrl-C
|
||||
<A-c> Alt-c
|
||||
<A-C> Alt-C
|
||||
Note that the Alt mappings may not work, depending on your keyboard and
|
||||
terminal.
|
||||
|
||||
Although it's possible to have more than one character in the second column,
|
||||
this is unusual. But you can use various ways to specify the character: >
|
||||
A a literal character
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*motion.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2011 Jul 19
|
||||
*motion.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 04
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -57,7 +57,7 @@ or change text. The following operators are available:
|
||||
|>| > shift right
|
||||
|<| < shift left
|
||||
|zf| zf define a fold
|
||||
|g@| g@ call function set with the 'operatorfunc' option
|
||||
|g@| g@ call function set with the 'operatorfunc' option
|
||||
|
||||
If the motion includes a count and the operator also had a count before it,
|
||||
the two counts are multiplied. For example: "2d3w" deletes six words.
|
||||
@@ -326,6 +326,7 @@ gg Goto line [count], default first line, on the first
|
||||
non-blank character |linewise|. If 'startofline' not
|
||||
set, keep the same column.
|
||||
|
||||
*:[range]*
|
||||
:[range] Set the cursor on the last line number in [range].
|
||||
[range] can also be just one line number, e.g., ":1"
|
||||
or ":'m".
|
||||
@@ -513,6 +514,8 @@ always select less text than the "a" commands.
|
||||
These commands are {not in Vi}.
|
||||
These commands are not available when the |+textobjects| feature has been
|
||||
disabled at compile time.
|
||||
Also see `gn` and `gN`, operating on the last search pattern.
|
||||
|
||||
*v_aw* *aw*
|
||||
aw "a word", select [count] words (see |word|).
|
||||
Leading or trailing white space is included, but not
|
||||
@@ -689,6 +692,7 @@ movement commands are used.
|
||||
"daw" delete a word *daw*
|
||||
"diW" delete inner WORD (see |WORD|) *diW*
|
||||
"daW" delete a WORD (see |WORD|) *daW*
|
||||
"dgn" delete the next search pattern match *dgn*
|
||||
"dd" delete one line |dd|
|
||||
"dis" delete inner sentence *dis*
|
||||
"das" delete a sentence *das*
|
||||
@@ -750,6 +754,13 @@ m[ or m] Set the |'[| or |']| mark. Useful when an operator is
|
||||
to be simulated by multiple commands. (does not move
|
||||
the cursor, this is not a motion command).
|
||||
|
||||
*m<* *m>*
|
||||
m< or m> Set the |'<| or |'>| mark. Useful to change what the
|
||||
`gv` command selects. (does not move the cursor, this
|
||||
is not a motion command).
|
||||
Note that the Visual mode cannot be set, only the
|
||||
start and end position.
|
||||
|
||||
*:ma* *:mark* *E191*
|
||||
:[range]ma[rk] {a-zA-Z'}
|
||||
Set mark {a-zA-Z'} at last line number in [range],
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*options.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Mar 28
|
||||
*options.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Oct 21
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -744,7 +744,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
- Reset the 'rightleft' option.
|
||||
- Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
|
||||
Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
|
||||
option.
|
||||
option).
|
||||
Also see |arabic.txt|.
|
||||
|
||||
*'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
|
||||
@@ -756,7 +756,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
feature}
|
||||
When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
|
||||
corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
|
||||
take affect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
|
||||
take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
|
||||
one which encompasses:
|
||||
a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
|
||||
within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
|
||||
@@ -1047,6 +1047,11 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
|
||||
default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
|
||||
|
||||
WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write
|
||||
your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
|
||||
lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable
|
||||
backups if you don't care about losing the file.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use
|
||||
$HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: >
|
||||
:let backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*'
|
||||
@@ -1102,8 +1107,8 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
|
||||
or Sun Workshop).
|
||||
|
||||
The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
||||
|sandbox-option|.
|
||||
The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
|
||||
modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
|
||||
|
||||
It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
||||
evaluating 'balloonexpr' |textlock|.
|
||||
@@ -1447,6 +1452,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
This option is a list of comma separated names.
|
||||
These names are recognized:
|
||||
|
||||
*clipboard-unnamed*
|
||||
unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
|
||||
for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
|
||||
would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
|
||||
@@ -1456,6 +1462,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
|
||||
|gui-clipboard|.
|
||||
|
||||
*clipboard-unnamedplus*
|
||||
unnamedplus A variant of "unnamed" flag which uses the clipboard
|
||||
register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of register '*' for
|
||||
all operations except yank. Yank shall copy the text
|
||||
@@ -1465,6 +1472,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
Availability can be checked with: >
|
||||
if has('unnamedplus')
|
||||
<
|
||||
*clipboard-autoselect*
|
||||
autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
|
||||
then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
|
||||
area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
|
||||
@@ -1476,9 +1484,16 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
"autoselect" flag is used.
|
||||
Also applies to the modeless selection.
|
||||
|
||||
*clipboard-autoselectplus*
|
||||
autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of
|
||||
the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in
|
||||
'guioptions'.
|
||||
|
||||
*clipboard-autoselectml*
|
||||
autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
|
||||
only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
|
||||
|
||||
*clipboard-html*
|
||||
html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when
|
||||
pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it
|
||||
as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from
|
||||
@@ -1489,6 +1504,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
Only supported for GTK version 2 and later.
|
||||
Only available with the |+multi_byte| feature.
|
||||
|
||||
*clipboard-exclude*
|
||||
exclude:{pattern}
|
||||
Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
|
||||
the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
|
||||
@@ -2125,7 +2141,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
and the cursor is right in front of the searched
|
||||
character, the cursor won't move. When not included,
|
||||
the cursor would skip over it and jump to the
|
||||
following occurence.
|
||||
following occurrence.
|
||||
|
||||
POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
|
||||
when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
|
||||
@@ -3035,8 +3051,8 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
|
||||
for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|.
|
||||
|
||||
The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
||||
|sandbox-option|.
|
||||
The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
|
||||
modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
|
||||
This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
|
||||
on.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -3178,8 +3194,8 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
|
||||
fold. See |fold-foldtext|.
|
||||
|
||||
The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
||||
|sandbox-option|.
|
||||
The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
|
||||
modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
|
||||
|
||||
It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
||||
evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
|
||||
@@ -3224,8 +3240,8 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
format function will be used |C-indenting|.
|
||||
Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
|
||||
about including spaces and backslashes.
|
||||
The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
||||
|sandbox-option|.
|
||||
This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
||||
security reasons.
|
||||
|
||||
*'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
|
||||
'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
|
||||
@@ -3258,9 +3274,9 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using
|
||||
the internal format mechanism.
|
||||
|
||||
The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
||||
|sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working, since changing
|
||||
the buffer text is not allowed.
|
||||
The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
|
||||
modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working,
|
||||
since changing the buffer text is not allowed.
|
||||
|
||||
*'fsync'* *'fs'*
|
||||
'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
|
||||
@@ -3584,6 +3600,9 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
|
||||
by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
|
||||
The same applies to the modeless selection.
|
||||
*'go-P'*
|
||||
'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "*
|
||||
register.
|
||||
*'go-A'*
|
||||
'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
|
||||
applies to the modeless selection.
|
||||
@@ -4081,8 +4100,8 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
|
||||
Also used for |<cfile>|.
|
||||
|
||||
The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
||||
|sandbox-option|.
|
||||
The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
|
||||
modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
|
||||
|
||||
It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
||||
evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
|
||||
@@ -4146,8 +4165,8 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
See |indent-expression|.
|
||||
NOTE: This option is made empty when 'compatible' is set.
|
||||
|
||||
The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
||||
|sandbox-option|.
|
||||
The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
|
||||
modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
|
||||
|
||||
It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
||||
evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
|
||||
@@ -4576,24 +4595,31 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
{not in Vi}
|
||||
Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a
|
||||
comma separated list of string settings.
|
||||
*lcs-eol*
|
||||
eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
|
||||
omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
|
||||
line.
|
||||
*lcs-tab*
|
||||
tab:xy Two characters to be used to show a tab. The first
|
||||
char is used once. The second char is repeated to
|
||||
fill the space that the tab normally occupies.
|
||||
"tab:>-" will show a tab that takes four spaces as
|
||||
">---". When omitted, a tab is show as ^I.
|
||||
*lcs-trail*
|
||||
trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
|
||||
trailing spaces are blank.
|
||||
*lcs-extends*
|
||||
extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
|
||||
off and the line continues beyond the right of the
|
||||
screen.
|
||||
*lcs-precedes*
|
||||
precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap'
|
||||
is off and there is text preceding the character
|
||||
visible in the first column.
|
||||
*lcs-conceal*
|
||||
conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when
|
||||
'conceallevel' is set to 1.
|
||||
*lcs-nbsp*
|
||||
nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space (character
|
||||
0xA0, 160). Left blank when omitted.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -5114,6 +5140,8 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
invoked and what it should return.
|
||||
This option is usually set by a filetype plugin:
|
||||
|:filetype-plugin-on|
|
||||
This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
|
||||
security reasons.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
*'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'*
|
||||
@@ -6091,6 +6119,8 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
local to buffer
|
||||
Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
|
||||
|'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
|
||||
When zero the 'ts' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()|
|
||||
function to get the effective shiftwidth value.
|
||||
|
||||
*'shortmess'* *'shm'*
|
||||
'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "",
|
||||
@@ -6294,7 +6324,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
|
||||
case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
|
||||
'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
|
||||
":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc.. After
|
||||
":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After
|
||||
"*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
|
||||
recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
|
||||
NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
|
||||
@@ -6354,6 +6384,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
|
||||
commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
|
||||
When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
|
||||
When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used.
|
||||
'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set.
|
||||
See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
|
||||
spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
|
||||
@@ -6675,8 +6706,8 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
The variable "actual_curbuf" is set to the 'bufnr()' number of the
|
||||
real current buffer.
|
||||
|
||||
The 'statusline' option may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
|
||||
|sandbox-option|.
|
||||
The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from
|
||||
a modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
|
||||
|
||||
It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
|
||||
evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
|
||||
@@ -7119,8 +7150,8 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
the file should contain words with similar meaning, separated by
|
||||
non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). Maximum line
|
||||
length is 510 bytes.
|
||||
To obtain a file to be used here, check out the wordlist FAQ at
|
||||
http://www.hyphenologist.co.uk .
|
||||
To obtain a file to be used here, check out this ftp site:
|
||||
ftp://ftp.ox.ac.uk/pub/wordlists/ First get the README file.
|
||||
To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
|
||||
after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
|
||||
name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
|
||||
@@ -7397,6 +7428,10 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
|
||||
*urxvt-mouse*
|
||||
urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal.
|
||||
*sgr-mouse*
|
||||
sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled
|
||||
mouse reporting. Works with xterm version 277 or
|
||||
later.
|
||||
|
||||
The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
|
||||
|+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm|.
|
||||
@@ -7409,6 +7444,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
or "xterm2" already. The main use of this option is to set it to
|
||||
"xterm", when the terminal name doesn't start with "xterm", but it can
|
||||
handle xterm mouse codes.
|
||||
The "sgr" value will be set if the xterm version is 277 or later.
|
||||
The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
|
||||
95 or higher. This only works when compiled with the |+termresponse|
|
||||
feature and if |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the
|
||||
@@ -7460,7 +7496,7 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|.
|
||||
The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from
|
||||
before a reload to be saved for undo.
|
||||
WARNING: this is a very new feature. Use at your own risk!
|
||||
When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted.
|
||||
|
||||
*'undolevels'* *'ul'*
|
||||
'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS,
|
||||
@@ -7836,9 +7872,9 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
{not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
|
||||
feature}
|
||||
A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
|
||||
patterns is ignored when completing file or directory names, and
|
||||
influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and |globpath()| unless
|
||||
a flag is passed to disable this.
|
||||
patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or
|
||||
directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and
|
||||
|globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this.
|
||||
The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
|
||||
Also see 'suffixes'.
|
||||
Example: >
|
||||
@@ -8140,8 +8176,13 @@ A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
|
||||
{not in Vi}
|
||||
Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
|
||||
the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
|
||||
also on. Reset this option if your file system is almost full. See
|
||||
|backup-table| for another explanation.
|
||||
also on.
|
||||
WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write
|
||||
your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
|
||||
lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset
|
||||
this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write
|
||||
fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful).
|
||||
See |backup-table| for another explanation.
|
||||
When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
|
||||
NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
|
||||
set.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*os_win32.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2011 Aug 14
|
||||
*os_win32.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 May 18
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by George Reilly
|
||||
@@ -314,8 +314,8 @@ A. When using :! to run an external command, you can run it with "start": >
|
||||
not have to be closed before Vim.
|
||||
To avoid this special treatment, use ":! start".
|
||||
There are two optional arguments (see the next Q):
|
||||
/min the window will be minimized.
|
||||
/b" no console window will be opened
|
||||
/min the window will be minimized
|
||||
/b no console window will be opened
|
||||
You can use only one of these flags at a time. A second one will be
|
||||
treated as the start of the command.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*pattern.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2011 Nov 26
|
||||
*pattern.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 May 18
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -637,10 +637,10 @@ overview.
|
||||
*/\@!*
|
||||
\@! Matches with zero width if the preceding atom does NOT match at the
|
||||
current position. |/zero-width| {not in Vi}
|
||||
Like '(?!pattern)" in Perl.
|
||||
Like "(?!pattern)" in Perl.
|
||||
Example matches ~
|
||||
foo\(bar\)\@! any "foo" not followed by "bar"
|
||||
a.\{-}p\@! "a", "ap", "aap", "app", etc. not immediately
|
||||
a.\{-}p\@! "a", "ap", "app", "appp", etc. not immediately
|
||||
followed by a "p"
|
||||
if \(\(then\)\@!.\)*$ "if " not followed by "then"
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -648,7 +648,7 @@ overview.
|
||||
does not match. "a.*p\@!" will match from an "a" to the end of the
|
||||
line, because ".*" can match all characters in the line and the "p"
|
||||
doesn't match at the end of the line. "a.\{-}p\@!" will match any
|
||||
"a", "ap", "aap", etc. that isn't followed by a "p", because the "."
|
||||
"a", "ap", "app", etc. that isn't followed by a "p", because the "."
|
||||
can match a "p" and "p\@!" doesn't match after that.
|
||||
|
||||
You can't use "\@!" to look for a non-match before the matching
|
||||
@@ -667,7 +667,7 @@ overview.
|
||||
*/\@<=*
|
||||
\@<= Matches with zero width if the preceding atom matches just before what
|
||||
follows. |/zero-width| {not in Vi}
|
||||
Like '(?<=pattern)" in Perl, but Vim allows non-fixed-width patterns.
|
||||
Like "(?<=pattern)" in Perl, but Vim allows non-fixed-width patterns.
|
||||
Example matches ~
|
||||
\(an\_s\+\)\@<=file "file" after "an" and white space or an
|
||||
end-of-line
|
||||
@@ -691,7 +691,7 @@ overview.
|
||||
before what follows. Thus this matches if there is no position in the
|
||||
current or previous line where the atom matches such that it ends just
|
||||
before what follows. |/zero-width| {not in Vi}
|
||||
Like '(?<!pattern)" in Perl, but Vim allows non-fixed-width patterns.
|
||||
Like "(?<!pattern)" in Perl, but Vim allows non-fixed-width patterns.
|
||||
The match with the preceding atom is made to end just before the match
|
||||
with what follows, thus an atom that ends in ".*" will work.
|
||||
Warning: This can be slow (because many positions need to be checked
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*pi_gzip.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2002 Oct 29
|
||||
*pi_gzip.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Jul 19
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -25,6 +25,8 @@ with these extensions:
|
||||
*.Z compress (Lempel-Ziv)
|
||||
*.gz gzip
|
||||
*.bz2 bzip2
|
||||
*.lzma lzma
|
||||
*.xz xz
|
||||
|
||||
That's actually the only thing you need to know. There are no options.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*pi_netrw.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Apr 05
|
||||
*pi_netrw.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Oct 25
|
||||
|
||||
-----------------------------------------------------
|
||||
NETRW REFERENCE MANUAL by Charles E. Campbell, Jr.
|
||||
@@ -143,7 +143,7 @@ and has lines resembling >
|
||||
Windows' ftp doesn't support .netrc; however, one may have in one's .vimrc: >
|
||||
|
||||
let g:netrw_ftp_cmd= 'c:\Windows\System32\ftp -s:C:\Users\Myself\MACHINE'
|
||||
<
|
||||
<
|
||||
Netrw will substitute the host's machine name for MACHINE from the url it is
|
||||
attempting to open, and so one may specify >
|
||||
userid
|
||||
@@ -209,7 +209,7 @@ EXTERNAL APPLICATIONS AND PROTOCOLS *netrw-externapp* {{{2
|
||||
default, the option arguments for the http-handling commands are: >
|
||||
|
||||
elinks : "-source >"
|
||||
links : "-source >"
|
||||
links : "-dump >"
|
||||
curl : "-o"
|
||||
wget : "-q -O"
|
||||
fetch : "-o"
|
||||
@@ -1072,6 +1072,7 @@ QUICK REFERENCE: MAPS *netrw-browse-maps* {{{2
|
||||
v Enter the file/directory under the cursor in a new |netrw-v|
|
||||
browser window. A vertical split is used.
|
||||
x View file with an associated program |netrw-x|
|
||||
X Execute filename under cursor via |system()| |netrw-X|
|
||||
|
||||
% Open a new file in netrw's current directory |netrw-%|
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1589,6 +1590,15 @@ Related topics: |netrw-s| |netrw-S|
|
||||
Associated setting variables: |g:netrw_sort_sequence| |g:netrw_sort_options|
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
EXECUTING FILE UNDER CURSOR VIA SYSTEM() *netrw-X*
|
||||
|
||||
Pressing X while the cursor is atop an executable file will yield a prompt
|
||||
using the filename asking for any arguments. Upon pressing a [return], netrw
|
||||
will then call |system()| with that command and arguments. The result will
|
||||
be displayed by |:echomsg|, and so |:messages| will repeat display of the
|
||||
result. Ansi escape sequences will be stripped out.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FORCING TREATMENT AS A FILE OR DIRECTORY *netrw-gd* *netrw-gf* {{{2
|
||||
|
||||
Remote symbolic links (ie. those listed via ssh or ftp) are problematic
|
||||
@@ -1596,10 +1606,10 @@ in that it is difficult to tell whether they link to a file or to a
|
||||
directory.
|
||||
|
||||
To force treatment as a file: use >
|
||||
gd
|
||||
gf
|
||||
<
|
||||
To force treatment as a directory: use >
|
||||
gf
|
||||
gd
|
||||
<
|
||||
|
||||
GOING UP *netrw--* {{{2
|
||||
@@ -1957,7 +1967,7 @@ The "mT" mapping will apply the command in |g:netrw_ctags| (by default, it is
|
||||
netrw will use ssh (see |g:netrw_ssh_cmd|), and so ssh must be available for
|
||||
this to work on remote systems. For your local system, see |ctags| on how to
|
||||
get a version. I myself use hdrtags, currently available at
|
||||
http://mysite.verizon.net/astronaut/src/index.html , and have >
|
||||
http://www.drchip.org/astronaut/src/index.html , and have >
|
||||
|
||||
let g:netrw_ctags= "hdrtag"
|
||||
<
|
||||
@@ -2093,6 +2103,9 @@ your browsing preferences. (see also: |netrw-settings|)
|
||||
history.
|
||||
(related: |netrw-qb| |netrw-u| |netrw-U|)
|
||||
|
||||
*g:netrw_dynamic_maxfilenamelen* =32: enables dynamic determination of
|
||||
|g:netrw_maxfilenamelen|, which affects
|
||||
local file long listing.
|
||||
*g:netrw_errorlvl* =0: error levels greater than or equal to
|
||||
this are permitted to be displayed
|
||||
0: notes
|
||||
@@ -2843,13 +2856,13 @@ which is loaded automatically at startup (assuming :set nocp).
|
||||
|
||||
1. Get the <Decho.vim> script, available as:
|
||||
|
||||
http://mysite.verizon.net/astronaut/vim/index.html#DECHO
|
||||
http://www.drchip.org/astronaut/vim/index.html#DECHO
|
||||
or
|
||||
http://vim.sourceforge.net/scripts/script.php?script_id=120
|
||||
|
||||
It now comes as a "vimball"; if you're using vim 7.0 or earlier,
|
||||
you'll need to update vimball, too. See
|
||||
http://mysite.verizon.net/astronaut/vim/index.html#VIMBALL
|
||||
http://www.drchip.org/astronaut/vim/index.html#VIMBALL
|
||||
|
||||
2. Edit the <netrw.vim> file by typing: >
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -2882,57 +2895,77 @@ which is loaded automatically at startup (assuming :set nocp).
|
||||
==============================================================================
|
||||
12. History *netrw-history* {{{1
|
||||
|
||||
v145: Apr 05, 2012 * moved some command from a g:netrw_local_...
|
||||
format to g:netwr_local... format
|
||||
* included some NOTE level messages about
|
||||
commands that aren't executable
|
||||
* |g:netrw_errorlvl| (default: NOTE=0)
|
||||
option introduced
|
||||
v144: Mar 12, 2012 * when |CTRL-W_s| or |CTRL-W_v| are used,
|
||||
or their wincmd equivalents, on a netrw
|
||||
buffer, the netrw's w: variables were
|
||||
not copied over. Fixed.
|
||||
Mar 13, 2012 * nbcd_curpos_{bufnr('%')} was commented
|
||||
out, and was mistakenly used during
|
||||
RestorePosn. Unfortunately, I'm not
|
||||
sure why it was commented out, so this
|
||||
"fix" may re-introduce an earlier problem.
|
||||
Mar 21, 2012 * included s:rexposn internally to make
|
||||
:Rex return the cursor to the same pos'n
|
||||
upon restoration of netrw buffer
|
||||
Mar 27, 2012 * (sjbesse) s:NetrwGetFile() needs to remove
|
||||
"/" from the netrw buffer's usual |'isk'|
|
||||
in order to allow "filetype detect" to work
|
||||
properly for scripts.
|
||||
v143: Jun 01, 2011 * |g:netrw_winsize| will accept a negative
|
||||
number; the absolute value of it will then
|
||||
be used to specify lines/columns instead of
|
||||
a percentage.
|
||||
Jul 05, 2011 * the "d" map now supports mkdir via ftp
|
||||
See |netrw-d| and |g:netrw_remote_mkdir|
|
||||
Jul 11, 2011 * Changed Explore!, Sexplore!, and Vexplore
|
||||
to use a percentage of |winwidth()| instead
|
||||
of a percentage of |winheight()|.
|
||||
Jul 11, 2011 * included support for https://... I'm just
|
||||
beginning to test this, however.
|
||||
Aug 01, 2011 * changed RestoreOptions to also restore
|
||||
cursor position in netrw buffers.
|
||||
Aug 12, 2011 * added a note about "%" to the balloon
|
||||
Aug 30, 2011 * if |g:netrw_nobeval| exists, then balloon
|
||||
evaluation is suppressed.
|
||||
Aug 31, 2011 * (Benjamin R Haskell) provided a patch that
|
||||
implements non-standard port handling for
|
||||
files opened via the remote browser.
|
||||
Aug 31, 2011 * Fixed a **//pattern Explorer bug
|
||||
Sep 15, 2011 * (reported by Francesco Campana) netrw
|
||||
now permits the "@" to be part of the
|
||||
user id (if there's an @ that appears
|
||||
to the right).
|
||||
Nov 21, 2011 * New option: |g:netrw_ftp_options|
|
||||
Dec 07, 2011 * (James Sinclair) provided a fix handling
|
||||
attempts to use a uid and password when
|
||||
they weren't defined. This affected
|
||||
NetWrite (NetRead already had that fix).
|
||||
v146: Oct 20, 2012 * (David Kotchan) reported that under Windows,
|
||||
directories named with unusual characters
|
||||
such as "#" or "$" were not being listed
|
||||
properly.
|
||||
* (Kenny Lee) reported that the buffer list
|
||||
was being populated by netrw buffers.
|
||||
Netrw will now |:bwipe| netrw buffers
|
||||
upon editing a file if g:netrw_fastbrowse
|
||||
is zero and its not in tree listing style.
|
||||
v145: Apr 05, 2012 * moved some command from a g:netrw_local_...
|
||||
format to g:netwr_local... format
|
||||
* included some NOTE level messages about
|
||||
commands that aren't executable
|
||||
* |g:netrw_errorlvl| (default: NOTE=0)
|
||||
option introduced
|
||||
May 18, 2012 * (Ilya Dogolazky) a scenario where a
|
||||
|g:netrw_fastbrowse| of zero did not
|
||||
have a local directory refreshed fixed.
|
||||
Jul 10, 2012 * (Donatas) |netrw-gb| wasn't working due
|
||||
to an incorrectly used variable.
|
||||
Aug 09, 2012 * (Bart Baker) netrw was doubling
|
||||
of entries after a split.
|
||||
* (code by Takahiro Yoshihara) implemented
|
||||
|g:netrw_dynamic_maxfilenamelen|
|
||||
Aug 31, 2012 * (Andrew Wong) netrw refresh overwriting
|
||||
the yank buffer.
|
||||
v144: Mar 12, 2012 * when |CTRL-W_s| or |CTRL-W_v| are used,
|
||||
or their wincmd equivalents, on a netrw
|
||||
buffer, the netrw's w: variables were
|
||||
not copied over. Fixed.
|
||||
Mar 13, 2012 * nbcd_curpos_{bufnr('%')} was commented
|
||||
out, and was mistakenly used during
|
||||
RestorePosn. Unfortunately, I'm not
|
||||
sure why it was commented out, so this
|
||||
"fix" may re-introduce an earlier problem.
|
||||
Mar 21, 2012 * included s:rexposn internally to make
|
||||
:Rex return the cursor to the same pos'n
|
||||
upon restoration of netrw buffer
|
||||
Mar 27, 2012 * (sjbesse) s:NetrwGetFile() needs to remove
|
||||
"/" from the netrw buffer's usual |'isk'|
|
||||
in order to allow "filetype detect" to work
|
||||
properly for scripts.
|
||||
v143: Jun 01, 2011 * |g:netrw_winsize| will accept a negative
|
||||
number; the absolute value of it will then
|
||||
be used to specify lines/columns instead of
|
||||
a percentage.
|
||||
Jul 05, 2011 * the "d" map now supports mkdir via ftp
|
||||
See |netrw-d| and |g:netrw_remote_mkdir|
|
||||
Jul 11, 2011 * Changed Explore!, Sexplore!, and Vexplore
|
||||
to use a percentage of |winwidth()| instead
|
||||
of a percentage of |winheight()|.
|
||||
Jul 11, 2011 * included support for https://... I'm just
|
||||
beginning to test this, however.
|
||||
Aug 01, 2011 * changed RestoreOptions to also restore
|
||||
cursor position in netrw buffers.
|
||||
Aug 12, 2011 * added a note about "%" to the balloon
|
||||
Aug 30, 2011 * if |g:netrw_nobeval| exists, then balloon
|
||||
evaluation is suppressed.
|
||||
Aug 31, 2011 * (Benjamin R Haskell) provided a patch that
|
||||
implements non-standard port handling for
|
||||
files opened via the remote browser.
|
||||
Aug 31, 2011 * Fixed a **//pattern Explorer bug
|
||||
Sep 15, 2011 * (reported by Francesco Campana) netrw
|
||||
now permits the "@" to be part of the
|
||||
user id (if there's an @ that appears
|
||||
to the right).
|
||||
Nov 21, 2011 * New option: |g:netrw_ftp_options|
|
||||
Dec 07, 2011 * (James Sinclair) provided a fix handling
|
||||
attempts to use a uid and password when
|
||||
they weren't defined. This affected
|
||||
NetWrite (NetRead already had that fix).
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
==============================================================================
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -561,7 +561,9 @@ commands can be combined to create a NewGrep command: >
|
||||
*:vim* *:vimgrep* *E682* *E683*
|
||||
:vim[grep][!] /{pattern}/[g][j] {file} ...
|
||||
Search for {pattern} in the files {file} ... and set
|
||||
the error list to the matches.
|
||||
the error list to the matches. Files matching
|
||||
'wildignore' are ignored; files in 'suffixes' are
|
||||
searched last.
|
||||
Without the 'g' flag each line is added only once.
|
||||
With 'g' every match is added.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -913,8 +915,8 @@ Basic items
|
||||
%n error number (finds a number)
|
||||
%m error message (finds a string)
|
||||
%r matches the "rest" of a single-line file message %O/P/Q
|
||||
%p pointer line (finds a sequence of '-', '.' or ' ' and
|
||||
uses the length for the column number)
|
||||
%p pointer line (finds a sequence of '-', '.', ' ' or
|
||||
tabs and uses the length for the column number)
|
||||
%*{conv} any scanf non-assignable conversion
|
||||
%% the single '%' character
|
||||
%s search text (finds a string)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*sign.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Jan 04
|
||||
*sign.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Jul 10
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Gordon Prieur
|
||||
@@ -153,8 +153,14 @@ REMOVING SIGNS *:sign-unplace* *E159*
|
||||
Remove the previously placed sign {id} from file {fname}.
|
||||
See remark above about {fname} |:sign-fname|.
|
||||
|
||||
:sign unplace * file={fname}
|
||||
Remove all placed signs in file {fname}.
|
||||
|
||||
:sign unplace {id} buffer={nr}
|
||||
Same, but use buffer {nr}.
|
||||
Remove the previously placed sign {id} from buffer {nr}.
|
||||
|
||||
:sign unplace * buffer={nr}
|
||||
Remove all placed signs in buffer {nr}.
|
||||
|
||||
:sign unplace {id}
|
||||
Remove the previously placed sign {id} from all files it
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*syntax.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Apr 06
|
||||
*syntax.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Nov 28
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -380,194 +380,23 @@ settings, depending on which syntax is active. Example: >
|
||||
This is not a syntax file itself, but a script that converts the current
|
||||
window into HTML. Vim opens a new window in which it builds the HTML file.
|
||||
|
||||
After you save the resulting file, you can view it with any browser. The
|
||||
colors should be exactly the same as you see them in Vim.
|
||||
|
||||
You are not supposed to set the 'filetype' or 'syntax' option to "2html"!
|
||||
Source the script to convert the current file: >
|
||||
|
||||
:runtime! syntax/2html.vim
|
||||
<
|
||||
*:TOhtml*
|
||||
Or use the ":TOhtml" user command. It is defined in a standard plugin.
|
||||
":TOhtml" also works with a range and in a Visual area: >
|
||||
|
||||
:10,40TOhtml
|
||||
|
||||
Warning: This can be slow! The script must process every character of every
|
||||
line. Because it can take a long time, by default a progress bar is displayed
|
||||
in the statusline for each major step in the conversion process. If you don't
|
||||
like seeing this progress bar, you can disable it and get a very minor speed
|
||||
improvement with: >
|
||||
|
||||
let g:html_no_progress = 1
|
||||
|
||||
":TOhtml" has another special feature: if the window is in diff mode, it will
|
||||
generate HTML that shows all the related windows. This can be disabled by
|
||||
setting the g:html_diff_one_file variable: >
|
||||
|
||||
let g:html_diff_one_file = 1
|
||||
|
||||
After you save the resulting file, you can view it with any browser. The
|
||||
colors should be exactly the same as you see them in Vim.
|
||||
|
||||
To restrict the conversion to a range of lines, use a range with the |:TOhtml|
|
||||
command, or set "g:html_start_line" and "g:html_end_line" to the first and
|
||||
last line to be converted. Example, using the last set Visual area: >
|
||||
|
||||
:let g:html_start_line = line("'<")
|
||||
:let g:html_end_line = line("'>")
|
||||
|
||||
The lines are numbered according to 'number' option and the Number
|
||||
highlighting. You can force lines to be numbered in the HTML output by
|
||||
setting "html_number_lines" to non-zero value: >
|
||||
:let g:html_number_lines = 1
|
||||
Force to omit the line numbers by using a zero value: >
|
||||
:let g:html_number_lines = 0
|
||||
Go back to the default to use 'number' by deleting the variable: >
|
||||
:unlet g:html_number_lines
|
||||
|
||||
By default, valid HTML 4.01 using cascading style sheets (CSS1) is generated.
|
||||
If you need to generate markup for really old browsers or some other user
|
||||
agent that lacks basic CSS support, use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_use_css = 0
|
||||
|
||||
Concealed text is removed from the HTML and replaced with the appropriate
|
||||
character from |:syn-cchar| or 'listchars' depending on the current value of
|
||||
'conceallevel'. If you always want to display all text in your document,
|
||||
either set 'conceallevel' to zero before invoking 2html, or use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_ignore_conceal = 1
|
||||
|
||||
Similarly, closed folds are put in the HTML as they are displayed. If you
|
||||
don't want this, use the |zR| command before invoking 2html, or use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_ignore_folding = 1
|
||||
|
||||
You may want to generate HTML that includes all the data within the folds, and
|
||||
allow the user to view the folded data similar to how they would in Vim. To
|
||||
generate this dynamic fold information, use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_dynamic_folds = 1
|
||||
|
||||
Using html_dynamic_folds will imply html_use_css, because it would be far too
|
||||
difficult to do it for old browsers. However, html_ignore_folding overrides
|
||||
html_dynamic_folds.
|
||||
|
||||
Using html_dynamic_folds will default to generating a foldcolumn in the html
|
||||
similar to Vim's foldcolumn, that will use javascript to open and close the
|
||||
folds in the HTML document. The width of this foldcolumn starts at the current
|
||||
setting of |'foldcolumn'| but grows to fit the greatest foldlevel in your
|
||||
document. If you do not want to show a foldcolumn at all, use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_no_foldcolumn = 1
|
||||
|
||||
Using this option, there will be no foldcolumn available to open the folds in
|
||||
the HTML. For this reason, another option is provided: html_hover_unfold.
|
||||
Enabling this option will use CSS 2.0 to allow a user to open a fold by
|
||||
hovering the mouse pointer over it. Note that old browsers (notably Internet
|
||||
Explorer 6) will not support this feature. Browser-specific markup for IE6 is
|
||||
included to fall back to the normal CSS1 code so that the folds show up
|
||||
correctly for this browser, but they will not be openable without a
|
||||
foldcolumn. Note that using html_hover_unfold will allow modern browsers with
|
||||
disabled javascript to view closed folds. To use this option, use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_hover_unfold = 1
|
||||
|
||||
Setting html_no_foldcolumn with html_dynamic_folds will automatically set
|
||||
html_hover_unfold, because otherwise the folds wouldn't be dynamic.
|
||||
|
||||
By default "<pre>" and "</pre>" are used around the text. When 'wrap' is set
|
||||
in the window being converted, the CSS 2.0 "white-space:pre-wrap" value is
|
||||
used to wrap the text. You can explicitly enable the wrapping with: >
|
||||
:let g:html_pre_wrap = 1
|
||||
or disable with >
|
||||
:let g:html_pre_wrap = 0
|
||||
This generates HTML that looks very close to the Vim window, but unfortunately
|
||||
there can be minor differences such as the lack of a 'showbreak' option in in
|
||||
the HTML, or where line breaks can occur.
|
||||
|
||||
Another way to obtain text wrapping in the HTML, at the risk of making some
|
||||
things look even more different, is to use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_no_pre = 1
|
||||
This will use <br> at the end of each line and use " " for repeated
|
||||
spaces. Doing it this way is more compatible with old browsers, but modern
|
||||
browsers support the "white-space" method.
|
||||
|
||||
If you do stick with the default "<pre>" tags, <Tab> characters in the text
|
||||
are included in the generated output if they will have no effect on the
|
||||
appearance of the text and it looks like they are in the document
|
||||
intentionally. This allows for the HTML output to be copied and pasted from a
|
||||
browser without losing the actual whitespace used in the document.
|
||||
|
||||
Specifically, <Tab> characters will be included if the 'tabstop' option is set
|
||||
to the default of 8, 'expandtab' is not set, and if neither the foldcolumn nor
|
||||
the line numbers are included in the HTML output (see options above). When any
|
||||
of these conditions are not met, any <Tab> characters in the text are expanded
|
||||
to the appropriate number of spaces in the HTML output.
|
||||
|
||||
When "<pre>" is included, you can force |:TOhtml| to keep the tabs even if the
|
||||
other conditions are not met with: >
|
||||
:let g:html_expand_tabs = 0
|
||||
Note that this can easily break text alignment and indentation in the HTML.
|
||||
|
||||
Force tabs to be expanded even when they would be kept using: >
|
||||
:let g:html_expand_tabs = 1
|
||||
|
||||
For diff mode on a single file (with g:html_diff_one_file) a sequence of more
|
||||
than 3 filler lines is displayed as three lines with the middle line
|
||||
mentioning the total number of inserted lines. If you prefer to see all the
|
||||
inserted lines as with the side-by-side diff, use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_whole_filler = 1
|
||||
And to go back to displaying up to three lines again: >
|
||||
:unlet g:html_whole_filler
|
||||
|
||||
For most buffers, TOhtml uses the current value of 'fileencoding' if set, or
|
||||
'encoding' if not, to determine the charset and 'fileencoding' of the HTML
|
||||
file. 'encoding' is always used for certain 'buftype' values. In general, this
|
||||
works for the encodings mentioned specifically by name in |encoding-names|,
|
||||
but TOhtml will only automatically use those encodings which are widely
|
||||
supported. However, you can override this to support specific encodings that
|
||||
may not be automatically detected by default.
|
||||
|
||||
To overrule all automatic charset detection, set g:html_use_encoding to the
|
||||
name of the charset to be used. TOhtml will try to determine the appropriate
|
||||
'fileencoding' setting from the charset, but you may need to set it manually
|
||||
if TOhtml cannot determine the encoding. It is recommended to set this
|
||||
variable to something widely supported, like UTF-8, for anything you will be
|
||||
hosting on a webserver: >
|
||||
:let g:html_use_encoding = "UTF-8"
|
||||
You can also use this option to omit the line that specifies the charset
|
||||
entirely, by setting g:html_use_encoding to an empty string: >
|
||||
:let g:html_use_encoding = ""
|
||||
To go back to the automatic mechanism, delete the g:html_use_encoding
|
||||
variable: >
|
||||
:unlet g:html_use_encoding
|
||||
|
||||
If you specify a charset with g:html_use_encoding for which TOhtml cannot
|
||||
automatically detect the corresponding 'fileencoding' setting, you can use
|
||||
g:html_encoding_override to allow TOhtml to detect the correct encoding.
|
||||
This is a dictionary of charset-encoding pairs that will replace existing
|
||||
pairs automatically detected by TOhtml, or supplement with new pairs. For
|
||||
example, to allow TOhtml to detect the HTML charset "windows-1252" properly as
|
||||
the encoding "8bit-cp1252", use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_encoding_override = {'windows-1252': '8bit-cp1252'}
|
||||
<
|
||||
The g:html_charset_override is similar, it allows TOhtml to detect the HTML
|
||||
charset for any 'fileencoding' or 'encoding' which is not detected
|
||||
automatically. You can also use it to override specific existing
|
||||
encoding-charset pairs. For example, TOhtml will by default use UTF-8 for all
|
||||
Unicode/UCS encodings. To use UTF-16 and UTF-32 instead, use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_charset_override = {'ucs-4': 'UTF-32', 'utf-16': 'UTF-16'}
|
||||
|
||||
Note that documents encoded in either UTF-32 or UTF-16 have known
|
||||
compatibility problems with at least one major browser.
|
||||
|
||||
*convert-to-XML* *convert-to-XHTML*
|
||||
If you do not like plain HTML, an alternative is to have the script generate
|
||||
XHTML (XML compliant HTML). To do this set the "html_use_xhtml" variable: >
|
||||
:let g:html_use_xhtml = 1
|
||||
|
||||
Any of the on/off options listed above can be enabled or disabled by setting
|
||||
them explicitly to the desired value, or restored to their default by removing
|
||||
the variable using |:unlet|.
|
||||
Many variables affect the output of 2html.vim; see below. Any of the on/off
|
||||
options listed below can be enabled or disabled by setting them explicitly to
|
||||
the desired value, or restored to their default by removing the variable using
|
||||
|:unlet|.
|
||||
|
||||
Remarks:
|
||||
- Some truly ancient browsers may not show the background colors.
|
||||
- From most browsers you can also print the file (in color)!
|
||||
- This version of TOhtml may work with older versions of Vim, but some
|
||||
- The latest TOhtml may actually work with older versions of Vim, but some
|
||||
features such as conceal support will not function, and the colors may be
|
||||
incorrect for an old Vim without GUI support compiled in.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -575,6 +404,311 @@ Here is an example how to run the script over all .c and .h files from a
|
||||
Unix shell: >
|
||||
for f in *.[ch]; do gvim -f +"syn on" +"run! syntax/2html.vim" +"wq" +"q" $f; done
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_start_line* *g:html_end_line*
|
||||
To restrict the conversion to a range of lines, use a range with the |:TOhtml|
|
||||
command below, or set "g:html_start_line" and "g:html_end_line" to the first
|
||||
and last line to be converted. Example, using the last set Visual area: >
|
||||
|
||||
:let g:html_start_line = line("'<")
|
||||
:let g:html_end_line = line("'>")
|
||||
:runtime! syntax/2html.vim
|
||||
<
|
||||
*:TOhtml*
|
||||
:[range]TOhtml The ":TOhtml" command is defined in a standard plugin.
|
||||
This command will source |2html.vim| for you. When a
|
||||
range is given, set |g:html_start_line| and
|
||||
|g:html_end_line| to the start and end of the range,
|
||||
respectively. Default range is the entire buffer.
|
||||
|
||||
If the current window is part of a |diff|, unless
|
||||
|g:html_diff_one_file| is set, :TOhtml will convert
|
||||
all windows which are part of the diff in the current
|
||||
tab and place them side-by-side in a <table> element
|
||||
in the generated HTML.
|
||||
|
||||
Examples: >
|
||||
|
||||
:10,40TOhtml " convert lines 10-40 to html
|
||||
:'<,'>TOhtml " convert current/last visual selection
|
||||
:TOhtml " convert entire buffer
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_diff_one_file*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, all windows involved in a |diff| in the current tab page are converted
|
||||
to HTML and placed side-by-side in a <table> element.
|
||||
When 1, only the current buffer is converted.
|
||||
Example: >
|
||||
|
||||
let g:html_diff_one_file = 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_whole_filler*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, if |g:html_diff_one_file| is 1, a sequence of more than 3 filler lines
|
||||
is displayed as three lines with the middle line mentioning the total number
|
||||
of inserted lines.
|
||||
When 1, always display all inserted lines as if |g:html_diff_one_file| were
|
||||
not set.
|
||||
>
|
||||
:let g:html_whole_filler = 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
*TOhtml-performance* *g:html_no_progress*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, display a progress bar in the statusline for each major step in the
|
||||
2html.vim conversion process.
|
||||
When 1, do not display the progress bar. This offers a minor speed improvement
|
||||
but you won't have any idea how much longer the conversion might take; for big
|
||||
files it can take a long time!
|
||||
Example: >
|
||||
|
||||
let g:html_no_progress = 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
You can obtain better performance improvements by also instructing Vim to not
|
||||
run interactively, so that too much time is not taken to redraw as the script
|
||||
moves through the buffer, switches windows, and the like: >
|
||||
|
||||
vim -E -s -c "let g:html_no_progress=1" -c "syntax on" -c "set ft=c" -c "runtime syntax/2html.vim" -cwqa myfile.c
|
||||
<
|
||||
Note that the -s flag prevents loading your .vimrc and any plugins, so you
|
||||
need to explicitly source/enable anything that will affect the HTML
|
||||
conversion. See |-E| and |-s-ex| for details. It is probably best to create a
|
||||
script to replace all the -c commands and use it with the -u flag instead of
|
||||
specifying each command separately.
|
||||
|
||||
*g:html_number_lines*
|
||||
Default: current 'number' setting.
|
||||
When 0, buffer text is displayed in the generated HTML without line numbering.
|
||||
When 1, a column of line numbers is added to the generated HTML with the same
|
||||
highlighting as the line number column in Vim (|hl-LineNr|).
|
||||
Force line numbers even if 'number' is not set: >
|
||||
:let g:html_number_lines = 1
|
||||
Force to omit the line numbers: >
|
||||
:let g:html_number_lines = 0
|
||||
Go back to the default to use 'number' by deleting the variable: >
|
||||
:unlet g:html_number_lines
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_use_css*
|
||||
Default: 1.
|
||||
When 1, generate valid HTML 4.01 markup with CSS1 styling, supported in all
|
||||
modern browsers and most old browsers.
|
||||
When 0, generate <font> tags and similar outdated markup. This is not
|
||||
recommended but it may work better in really old browsers, email clients,
|
||||
forum posts, and similar situations where basic CSS support is unavailable.
|
||||
Example: >
|
||||
:let g:html_use_css = 0
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_ignore_conceal*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, concealed text is removed from the HTML and replaced with a character
|
||||
from |:syn-cchar| or 'listchars' as appropriate, depending on the current
|
||||
value of 'conceallevel'.
|
||||
When 1, include all text from the buffer in the generated HTML, even if it is
|
||||
|conceal|ed.
|
||||
|
||||
Either of the following commands will ensure that all text in the buffer is
|
||||
included in the generated HTML (unless it is folded): >
|
||||
:let g:html_ignore_conceal = 1
|
||||
:setl conceallevel=0
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_ignore_folding*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, text in a closed fold is replaced by the text shown for the fold in
|
||||
Vim (|fold-foldtext|). See |g:html_dynamic_folds| if you also want to allow
|
||||
the user to expand the fold as in Vim to see the text inside.
|
||||
When 1, include all text from the buffer in the generated HTML; whether the
|
||||
text is in a fold has no impact at all. |g:html_dynamic_folds| has no effect.
|
||||
|
||||
Either of these commands will ensure that all text in the buffer is included
|
||||
in the generated HTML (unless it is concealed): >
|
||||
zR
|
||||
:let g:html_ignore_folding = 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_dynamic_folds*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, text in a closed fold is not included at all in the generated HTML.
|
||||
When 1, generate javascript to open a fold and show the text within, just like
|
||||
in Vim.
|
||||
|
||||
Setting this variable to 1 causes 2html.vim to always use CSS for styling,
|
||||
regardless of what |g:html_use_css| is set to.
|
||||
|
||||
This variable is ignored when |g:html_ignore_folding| is set.
|
||||
>
|
||||
:let g:html_dynamic_folds = 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_no_foldcolumn*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, if |g:html_dynamic_folds| is 1, generate a column of text similar to
|
||||
Vim's foldcolumn (|fold-foldcolumn|) the user can click on to toggle folds
|
||||
open or closed. The minimum width of the generated text column is the current
|
||||
'foldcolumn' setting.
|
||||
When 1, do not generate this column; instead, hovering the mouse cursor over
|
||||
folded text will open the fold as if |g:html_hover_unfold| were set.
|
||||
>
|
||||
:let g:html_no_foldcolumn = 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
*TOhtml-uncopyable-text* *g:html_prevent_copy*
|
||||
Default: empty string.
|
||||
This option prevents certain regions of the generated HTML from being copied,
|
||||
when you select all text in document rendered in a browser and copy it. Useful
|
||||
for allowing users to copy-paste only the source text even if a fold column or
|
||||
line numbers are shown in the generated content. Specify regions to be
|
||||
affected in this way as follows:
|
||||
f: fold column
|
||||
n: line numbers (also within fold text)
|
||||
t: fold text
|
||||
d: diff filler
|
||||
|
||||
Example, to make the fold column and line numbers uncopyable: >
|
||||
:let g:html_prevent_copy = "fn"
|
||||
<
|
||||
This feature is currently implemented by inserting read-only <input> elements
|
||||
into the markup to contain the uncopyable areas. This does not work well in
|
||||
all cases. When pasting to some applications which understand HTML, the
|
||||
<input> elements also get pasted. But plain-text paste destinations should
|
||||
always work.
|
||||
|
||||
*g:html_no_invalid*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, if |g:html_prevent_copy| is non-empty, an invalid attribute is
|
||||
intentionally inserted into the <input> element for the uncopyable areas. This
|
||||
increases the number of applications you can paste to without also pasting the
|
||||
<input> elements. Specifically, Microsoft Word will not paste the <input>
|
||||
elements if they contain this invalid attribute.
|
||||
When 1, no invalid markup is ever intentionally inserted, and the generated
|
||||
page should validate. However, be careful pasting into Microsoft Word when
|
||||
|g:html_prevent_copy| is non-empty; it can be hard to get rid of the <input>
|
||||
elements which get pasted.
|
||||
|
||||
*g:html_hover_unfold*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, the only way to open a fold generated by 2html.vim with
|
||||
|g:html_dynamic_folds| set, is to click on the generated fold column.
|
||||
When 1, use CSS 2.0 to allow the user to open a fold by moving the mouse
|
||||
cursor over the displayed fold text. This is useful to allow users with
|
||||
disabled javascript to view the folded text.
|
||||
|
||||
Note that old browsers (notably Internet Explorer 6) will not support this
|
||||
feature. Browser-specific markup for IE6 is included to fall back to the
|
||||
normal CSS1 styling so that the folds show up correctly for this browser, but
|
||||
they will not be openable without a foldcolumn.
|
||||
>
|
||||
:let g:html_hover_unfold = 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
*TOhtml-wrap-text* *g:html_pre_wrap*
|
||||
Default: current 'wrap' setting.
|
||||
When 0, if |g:html_no_pre| is 0 or unset, the text in the generated HTML does
|
||||
not wrap at the edge of the browser window.
|
||||
When 1, if |g:html_use_css| is 1, the CSS 2.0 "white-space:pre-wrap" value is
|
||||
used, causing the text to wrap at whitespace at the edge of the browser
|
||||
window.
|
||||
Explicitly enable text wrapping: >
|
||||
:let g:html_pre_wrap = 1
|
||||
Explicitly disable wrapping: >
|
||||
:let g:html_pre_wrap = 0
|
||||
Go back to default, determine wrapping from 'wrap' setting: >
|
||||
:unlet g:html_pre_wrap
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_no_pre*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, buffer text in the generated HTML is surrounded by <pre>...</pre>
|
||||
tags. Series of whitespace is shown as in Vim without special markup, and tab
|
||||
characters can be included literally (see |g:html_expand_tabs|).
|
||||
When 1 (not recommended), the <pre> tags are omitted, and a plain <div> is
|
||||
used instead. Whitespace is replaced by a series of character
|
||||
references, and <br> is used to end each line. This is another way to allow
|
||||
text in the generated HTML is wrap (see |g:html_pre_wrap|) which also works in
|
||||
old browsers, but may cause noticeable differences between Vim's display and
|
||||
the rendered page generated by 2html.vim.
|
||||
>
|
||||
:let g:html_no_pre = 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_expand_tabs*
|
||||
Default: 1 if 'tabstop' is 8, 'expandtab' is 0, and no fold column or line
|
||||
numbers occur in the generated HTML;
|
||||
0 otherwise.
|
||||
When 0, <Tab> characters in the buffer text are replaced with an appropriate
|
||||
number of space characters, or references if |g:html_no_pre| is 1.
|
||||
When 1, if |g:html_no_pre| is 0 or unset, <Tab> characters in the buffer text
|
||||
are included as-is in the generated HTML. This is useful for when you want to
|
||||
allow copy and paste from a browser without losing the actual whitespace in
|
||||
the source document. Note that this can easily break text alignment and
|
||||
indentation in the HTML, unless set by default.
|
||||
|
||||
Force |2html.vim| to keep <Tab> characters: >
|
||||
:let g:html_expand_tabs = 0
|
||||
<
|
||||
Force tabs to be expanded: >
|
||||
:let g:html_expand_tabs = 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
*TOhtml-encoding-detect* *TOhtml-encoding*
|
||||
It is highly recommended to set your desired encoding with
|
||||
|g:html_use_encoding| for any content which will be placed on a web server.
|
||||
|
||||
If you do not specify an encoding, |2html.vim| uses the preferred IANA name
|
||||
for the current value of 'fileencoding' if set, or 'encoding' if not.
|
||||
'encoding' is always used for certain 'buftype' values. 'fileencoding' will be
|
||||
set to match the chosen document encoding.
|
||||
|
||||
Automatic detection works for the encodings mentioned specifically by name in
|
||||
|encoding-names|, but TOhtml will only automatically use those encodings with
|
||||
wide browser support. However, you can override this to support specific
|
||||
encodings that may not be automatically detected by default (see options
|
||||
below). See http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets for the IANA names.
|
||||
|
||||
Note, by default all Unicode encodings are converted to UTF-8 with no BOM in
|
||||
the generated HTML, as recommended by W3C:
|
||||
|
||||
http://www.w3.org/International/questions/qa-choosing-encodings
|
||||
http://www.w3.org/International/questions/qa-byte-order-mark
|
||||
|
||||
*g:html_use_encoding*
|
||||
Default: none, uses IANA name for current 'fileencoding' as above.
|
||||
To overrule all automatic charset detection, set g:html_use_encoding to the
|
||||
name of the charset to be used. It is recommended to set this variable to
|
||||
something widely supported, like UTF-8, for anything you will be hosting on a
|
||||
webserver: >
|
||||
:let g:html_use_encoding = "UTF-8"
|
||||
You can also use this option to omit the line that specifies the charset
|
||||
entirely, by setting g:html_use_encoding to an empty string (NOT recommended): >
|
||||
:let g:html_use_encoding = ""
|
||||
To go back to the automatic mechanism, delete the |g:html_use_encoding|
|
||||
variable: >
|
||||
:unlet g:html_use_encoding
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_encoding_override*
|
||||
Default: none, autoload/tohtml.vim contains default conversions for encodings
|
||||
mentioned by name at |encoding-names|.
|
||||
This option allows |2html.vim| to detect the correct 'fileencoding' when you
|
||||
specify an encoding with |g:html_use_encoding| which is not in the default
|
||||
list of conversions.
|
||||
|
||||
This is a dictionary of charset-encoding pairs that will replace existing
|
||||
pairs automatically detected by TOhtml, or supplement with new pairs.
|
||||
|
||||
Detect the HTML charset "windows-1252" as the encoding "8bit-cp1252": >
|
||||
:let g:html_encoding_override = {'windows-1252': '8bit-cp1252'}
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:html_charset_override*
|
||||
Default: none, autoload/tohtml.vim contains default conversions for encodings
|
||||
mentioned by name at |encoding-names| and which have wide
|
||||
browser support.
|
||||
This option allows |2html.vim| to detect the HTML charset for any
|
||||
'fileencoding' or 'encoding' which is not detected automatically. You can also
|
||||
use it to override specific existing encoding-charset pairs. For example,
|
||||
TOhtml will by default use UTF-8 for all Unicode/UCS encodings. To use UTF-16
|
||||
and UTF-32 instead, use: >
|
||||
:let g:html_charset_override = {'ucs-4': 'UTF-32', 'utf-16': 'UTF-16'}
|
||||
|
||||
Note that documents encoded in either UTF-32 or UTF-16 have known
|
||||
compatibility problems with some major browsers.
|
||||
|
||||
*convert-to-XML* *convert-to-XHTML* *g:html_use_xhtml*
|
||||
Default: 0.
|
||||
When 0, generate standard HTML 4.01 (strict when possible).
|
||||
When 1, generate XHTML 1.0 instead (XML compliant HTML).
|
||||
>
|
||||
:let g:html_use_xhtml = 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
|
||||
ABEL *abel.vim* *ft-abel-syntax*
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -650,7 +784,11 @@ The most flexible is to add a line in your assembly file containing: >
|
||||
asmsyntax=nasm
|
||||
Replace "nasm" with the name of the real assembly syntax. This line must be
|
||||
one of the first five lines in the file. No non-white text must be
|
||||
immediately before or after this text.
|
||||
immediately before or after this text. Note that specifying asmsyntax=foo is
|
||||
equivalent to setting ft=foo in a |modeline|, and that in case of a conflict
|
||||
between the two settings the one from the modeline will take precedence (in
|
||||
particular, if you have ft=asm in the modeline, you will get the GNU syntax
|
||||
highlighting regardless of what is specified as asmsyntax).
|
||||
|
||||
The syntax type can always be overruled for a specific buffer by setting the
|
||||
b:asmsyntax variable: >
|
||||
@@ -952,6 +1090,10 @@ Simpler is setting the filetype to "docbkxml" or "docbksgml": >
|
||||
or: >
|
||||
:set filetype=docbkxml
|
||||
|
||||
You can specify the DocBook version: >
|
||||
:let docbk_ver = 3
|
||||
When not set 4 is used.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
DOSBATCH *dosbatch.vim* *ft-dosbatch-syntax*
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -2351,6 +2493,12 @@ This will add highlighting for the commands that BASH (version 2.05a and
|
||||
later, and part earlier) adds.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
RESTRUCTURED TEXT *rst.vim* *ft-rst-syntax*
|
||||
|
||||
You may set what syntax definitions should be used for code blocks via
|
||||
let rst_syntax_code_list = ['vim', 'lisp', ...]
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
REXX *rexx.vim* *ft-rexx-syntax*
|
||||
|
||||
If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which are fixed
|
||||
@@ -2721,7 +2869,14 @@ Some folks like to include things like source code in comments and so would
|
||||
prefer that spell checking be disabled in comments in LaTeX files. To do
|
||||
this, put the following in your <.vimrc>: >
|
||||
let g:tex_comment_nospell= 1
|
||||
<
|
||||
The comment lines >
|
||||
% nospell{
|
||||
...
|
||||
% nospell}
|
||||
will suppress spell checking between them. These comment lines spelling
|
||||
control are known to be fragile; for example, don't include any of the section
|
||||
commands (\part, \chapter, \section, \paragraph, etc) inside nospell blocks
|
||||
or interleave environments (such as math) across nospell blocks.
|
||||
*tex-verb*
|
||||
Tex: Want Spell Checking in Verbatim Zones?~
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -2828,6 +2983,7 @@ You may selectively use conceal mode by setting g:tex_conceal in your
|
||||
following sets of characters: >
|
||||
|
||||
a = accents/ligatures
|
||||
b = bold and italic
|
||||
d = delimiters
|
||||
m = math symbols
|
||||
g = Greek
|
||||
@@ -2901,7 +3057,7 @@ Some folding is now supported with syntax/vim.vim: >
|
||||
g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'P' : fold python script
|
||||
g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'r' : fold ruby script
|
||||
g:vimsyn_folding =~ 't' : fold tcl script
|
||||
|
||||
<
|
||||
*g:vimsyn_noerror*
|
||||
Not all error highlighting that syntax/vim.vim does may be correct; VimL is a
|
||||
difficult language to highlight correctly. A way to suppress error
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*tabpage.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2010 Jul 31
|
||||
*tabpage.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 08
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -113,7 +113,7 @@ something else.
|
||||
this is a "safe" command.
|
||||
|
||||
:tabc[lose][!] {count}
|
||||
Close tab page {count}. Fails in the same way as ':tabclose"
|
||||
Close tab page {count}. Fails in the same way as `:tabclose`
|
||||
above.
|
||||
|
||||
*:tabo* *:tabonly*
|
||||
@@ -173,10 +173,20 @@ Other commands:
|
||||
REORDERING TAB PAGES:
|
||||
|
||||
:tabm[ove] [N] *:tabm* *:tabmove*
|
||||
:[N]tabm[ove]
|
||||
Move the current tab page to after tab page N. Use zero to
|
||||
make the current tab page the first one. Without N the tab
|
||||
page is made the last one.
|
||||
|
||||
:tabm[ove] +[N]
|
||||
:tabm[ove] -[N]
|
||||
Move the current tab page N places to the right (with +) or to
|
||||
the left (with -).
|
||||
|
||||
Note that although it is possible to move a tab behind the N-th one by using
|
||||
:Ntabmove, it is impossible to move it by N places by using :+Ntabmove. For
|
||||
clarification what +N means in this context see |[range]|.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
LOOPING OVER TAB PAGES:
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -281,6 +281,7 @@ $VIMRUNTIME starting.txt /*$VIMRUNTIME*
|
||||
'go-F' options.txt /*'go-F'*
|
||||
'go-L' options.txt /*'go-L'*
|
||||
'go-M' options.txt /*'go-M'*
|
||||
'go-P' options.txt /*'go-P'*
|
||||
'go-R' options.txt /*'go-R'*
|
||||
'go-T' options.txt /*'go-T'*
|
||||
'go-a' options.txt /*'go-a'*
|
||||
@@ -1185,6 +1186,7 @@ $VIMRUNTIME starting.txt /*$VIMRUNTIME*
|
||||
+mouse_gpm various.txt /*+mouse_gpm*
|
||||
+mouse_netterm various.txt /*+mouse_netterm*
|
||||
+mouse_pterm various.txt /*+mouse_pterm*
|
||||
+mouse_sgr various.txt /*+mouse_sgr*
|
||||
+mouse_sysmouse various.txt /*+mouse_sysmouse*
|
||||
+mouse_urxvt various.txt /*+mouse_urxvt*
|
||||
+mouse_xterm various.txt /*+mouse_xterm*
|
||||
@@ -1835,6 +1837,7 @@ $VIMRUNTIME starting.txt /*$VIMRUNTIME*
|
||||
:X editing.txt /*:X*
|
||||
:XMLent insert.txt /*:XMLent*
|
||||
:XMLns insert.txt /*:XMLns*
|
||||
:[range] motion.txt /*:[range]*
|
||||
:\bar cmdline.txt /*:\\bar*
|
||||
:_! cmdline.txt /*:_!*
|
||||
:_# cmdline.txt /*:_#*
|
||||
@@ -2617,6 +2620,7 @@ $VIMRUNTIME starting.txt /*$VIMRUNTIME*
|
||||
:resize windows.txt /*:resize*
|
||||
:ret change.txt /*:ret*
|
||||
:retab change.txt /*:retab*
|
||||
:retab! change.txt /*:retab!*
|
||||
:retu eval.txt /*:retu*
|
||||
:return eval.txt /*:return*
|
||||
:rew editing.txt /*:rew*
|
||||
@@ -3407,6 +3411,7 @@ CmdwinLeave autocmd.txt /*CmdwinLeave*
|
||||
ColorScheme autocmd.txt /*ColorScheme*
|
||||
Command-line cmdline.txt /*Command-line*
|
||||
Command-line-mode cmdline.txt /*Command-line-mode*
|
||||
CompleteDone autocmd.txt /*CompleteDone*
|
||||
Contents quickref.txt /*Contents*
|
||||
Cscope if_cscop.txt /*Cscope*
|
||||
CursorHold autocmd.txt /*CursorHold*
|
||||
@@ -4241,7 +4246,11 @@ E852 gui_x11.txt /*E852*
|
||||
E853 eval.txt /*E853*
|
||||
E854 options.txt /*E854*
|
||||
E855 autocmd.txt /*E855*
|
||||
E858 eval.txt /*E858*
|
||||
E859 eval.txt /*E859*
|
||||
E86 windows.txt /*E86*
|
||||
E860 eval.txt /*E860*
|
||||
E861 eval.txt /*E861*
|
||||
E87 windows.txt /*E87*
|
||||
E88 windows.txt /*E88*
|
||||
E89 message.txt /*E89*
|
||||
@@ -4424,6 +4433,7 @@ QuickFixCmdPost autocmd.txt /*QuickFixCmdPost*
|
||||
QuickFixCmdPost-example quickfix.txt /*QuickFixCmdPost-example*
|
||||
QuickFixCmdPre autocmd.txt /*QuickFixCmdPre*
|
||||
Quickfix quickfix.txt /*Quickfix*
|
||||
QuitPre autocmd.txt /*QuitPre*
|
||||
R change.txt /*R*
|
||||
RISC-OS os_risc.txt /*RISC-OS*
|
||||
RISCOS os_risc.txt /*RISCOS*
|
||||
@@ -4455,6 +4465,11 @@ Syntax autocmd.txt /*Syntax*
|
||||
T motion.txt /*T*
|
||||
TCL if_tcl.txt /*TCL*
|
||||
TERM starting.txt /*TERM*
|
||||
TOhtml-encoding syntax.txt /*TOhtml-encoding*
|
||||
TOhtml-encoding-detect syntax.txt /*TOhtml-encoding-detect*
|
||||
TOhtml-performance syntax.txt /*TOhtml-performance*
|
||||
TOhtml-uncopyable-text syntax.txt /*TOhtml-uncopyable-text*
|
||||
TOhtml-wrap-text syntax.txt /*TOhtml-wrap-text*
|
||||
TSQL ft_sql.txt /*TSQL*
|
||||
TTpro-telnet syntax.txt /*TTpro-telnet*
|
||||
Tab intro.txt /*Tab*
|
||||
@@ -4745,6 +4760,7 @@ autocmds-kept version5.txt /*autocmds-kept*
|
||||
autocommand autocmd.txt /*autocommand*
|
||||
autocommand-events autocmd.txt /*autocommand-events*
|
||||
autocommand-pattern autocmd.txt /*autocommand-pattern*
|
||||
autoformat change.txt /*autoformat*
|
||||
autoload eval.txt /*autoload*
|
||||
autoload-functions eval.txt /*autoload-functions*
|
||||
avoid-hit-enter version5.txt /*avoid-hit-enter*
|
||||
@@ -5009,6 +5025,13 @@ clearmatches() eval.txt /*clearmatches()*
|
||||
client-server remote.txt /*client-server*
|
||||
clientserver remote.txt /*clientserver*
|
||||
clipboard gui.txt /*clipboard*
|
||||
clipboard-autoselect options.txt /*clipboard-autoselect*
|
||||
clipboard-autoselectml options.txt /*clipboard-autoselectml*
|
||||
clipboard-autoselectplus options.txt /*clipboard-autoselectplus*
|
||||
clipboard-exclude options.txt /*clipboard-exclude*
|
||||
clipboard-html options.txt /*clipboard-html*
|
||||
clipboard-unnamed options.txt /*clipboard-unnamed*
|
||||
clipboard-unnamedplus options.txt /*clipboard-unnamedplus*
|
||||
cmdarg-variable eval.txt /*cmdarg-variable*
|
||||
cmdbang-variable eval.txt /*cmdbang-variable*
|
||||
cmdline-arguments vi_diff.txt /*cmdline-arguments*
|
||||
@@ -5269,6 +5292,7 @@ develop-spell develop.txt /*develop-spell*
|
||||
develop-spell-suggestions develop.txt /*develop-spell-suggestions*
|
||||
develop.txt develop.txt /*develop.txt*
|
||||
development develop.txt /*development*
|
||||
dgn motion.txt /*dgn*
|
||||
dh change.txt /*dh*
|
||||
diB motion.txt /*diB*
|
||||
diW motion.txt /*diW*
|
||||
@@ -5704,6 +5728,7 @@ ft-quake-syntax syntax.txt /*ft-quake-syntax*
|
||||
ft-r-indent indent.txt /*ft-r-indent*
|
||||
ft-readline-syntax syntax.txt /*ft-readline-syntax*
|
||||
ft-rexx-syntax syntax.txt /*ft-rexx-syntax*
|
||||
ft-rst-syntax syntax.txt /*ft-rst-syntax*
|
||||
ft-ruby-omni insert.txt /*ft-ruby-omni*
|
||||
ft-ruby-syntax syntax.txt /*ft-ruby-syntax*
|
||||
ft-scheme-syntax syntax.txt /*ft-scheme-syntax*
|
||||
@@ -5812,6 +5837,27 @@ g:gnat.Project_File ft_ada.txt /*g:gnat.Project_File*
|
||||
g:gnat.Set_Project_File() ft_ada.txt /*g:gnat.Set_Project_File()*
|
||||
g:gnat.Tags() ft_ada.txt /*g:gnat.Tags()*
|
||||
g:gnat.Tags_Command ft_ada.txt /*g:gnat.Tags_Command*
|
||||
g:html_charset_override syntax.txt /*g:html_charset_override*
|
||||
g:html_diff_one_file syntax.txt /*g:html_diff_one_file*
|
||||
g:html_dynamic_folds syntax.txt /*g:html_dynamic_folds*
|
||||
g:html_encoding_override syntax.txt /*g:html_encoding_override*
|
||||
g:html_end_line syntax.txt /*g:html_end_line*
|
||||
g:html_expand_tabs syntax.txt /*g:html_expand_tabs*
|
||||
g:html_hover_unfold syntax.txt /*g:html_hover_unfold*
|
||||
g:html_ignore_conceal syntax.txt /*g:html_ignore_conceal*
|
||||
g:html_ignore_folding syntax.txt /*g:html_ignore_folding*
|
||||
g:html_no_foldcolumn syntax.txt /*g:html_no_foldcolumn*
|
||||
g:html_no_invalid syntax.txt /*g:html_no_invalid*
|
||||
g:html_no_pre syntax.txt /*g:html_no_pre*
|
||||
g:html_no_progress syntax.txt /*g:html_no_progress*
|
||||
g:html_number_lines syntax.txt /*g:html_number_lines*
|
||||
g:html_pre_wrap syntax.txt /*g:html_pre_wrap*
|
||||
g:html_prevent_copy syntax.txt /*g:html_prevent_copy*
|
||||
g:html_start_line syntax.txt /*g:html_start_line*
|
||||
g:html_use_css syntax.txt /*g:html_use_css*
|
||||
g:html_use_encoding syntax.txt /*g:html_use_encoding*
|
||||
g:html_use_xhtml syntax.txt /*g:html_use_xhtml*
|
||||
g:html_whole_filler syntax.txt /*g:html_whole_filler*
|
||||
g:netrw_alto pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_alto*
|
||||
g:netrw_altv pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_altv*
|
||||
g:netrw_banner pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_banner*
|
||||
@@ -5827,6 +5873,7 @@ g:netrw_cygwin pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_cygwin*
|
||||
g:netrw_dav_cmd pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_dav_cmd*
|
||||
g:netrw_decompress pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_decompress*
|
||||
g:netrw_dirhistmax pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_dirhistmax*
|
||||
g:netrw_dynamic_maxfilenamelen pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_dynamic_maxfilenamelen*
|
||||
g:netrw_errorlvl pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_errorlvl*
|
||||
g:netrw_fastbrowse pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_fastbrowse*
|
||||
g:netrw_fetch_cmd pi_netrw.txt /*g:netrw_fetch_cmd*
|
||||
@@ -5933,6 +5980,7 @@ gF editing.txt /*gF*
|
||||
gH visual.txt /*gH*
|
||||
gI insert.txt /*gI*
|
||||
gJ change.txt /*gJ*
|
||||
gN visual.txt /*gN*
|
||||
gP change.txt /*gP*
|
||||
gQ intro.txt /*gQ*
|
||||
gR change.txt /*gR*
|
||||
@@ -6017,6 +6065,7 @@ glvs-options pi_getscript.txt /*glvs-options*
|
||||
glvs-plugins pi_getscript.txt /*glvs-plugins*
|
||||
glvs-usage pi_getscript.txt /*glvs-usage*
|
||||
gm motion.txt /*gm*
|
||||
gn visual.txt /*gn*
|
||||
gnat#Insert_Tags_Header() ft_ada.txt /*gnat#Insert_Tags_Header()*
|
||||
gnat#New() ft_ada.txt /*gnat#New()*
|
||||
gnat-xref ft_ada.txt /*gnat-xref*
|
||||
@@ -6511,6 +6560,13 @@ last-pattern pattern.txt /*last-pattern*
|
||||
last-position-jump eval.txt /*last-position-jump*
|
||||
last_buffer_nr() eval.txt /*last_buffer_nr()*
|
||||
lc_time-variable eval.txt /*lc_time-variable*
|
||||
lcs-conceal options.txt /*lcs-conceal*
|
||||
lcs-eol options.txt /*lcs-eol*
|
||||
lcs-extends options.txt /*lcs-extends*
|
||||
lcs-nbsp options.txt /*lcs-nbsp*
|
||||
lcs-precedes options.txt /*lcs-precedes*
|
||||
lcs-tab options.txt /*lcs-tab*
|
||||
lcs-trail options.txt /*lcs-trail*
|
||||
left-right-motions motion.txt /*left-right-motions*
|
||||
len() eval.txt /*len()*
|
||||
less various.txt /*less*
|
||||
@@ -6562,13 +6618,17 @@ lua if_lua.txt /*lua*
|
||||
lua-buffer if_lua.txt /*lua-buffer*
|
||||
lua-commands if_lua.txt /*lua-commands*
|
||||
lua-dict if_lua.txt /*lua-dict*
|
||||
lua-eval if_lua.txt /*lua-eval*
|
||||
lua-list if_lua.txt /*lua-list*
|
||||
lua-luaeval if_lua.txt /*lua-luaeval*
|
||||
lua-vim if_lua.txt /*lua-vim*
|
||||
lua-window if_lua.txt /*lua-window*
|
||||
lua.vim syntax.txt /*lua.vim*
|
||||
luaeval() eval.txt /*luaeval()*
|
||||
m motion.txt /*m*
|
||||
m' motion.txt /*m'*
|
||||
m< motion.txt /*m<*
|
||||
m> motion.txt /*m>*
|
||||
m[ motion.txt /*m[*
|
||||
m] motion.txt /*m]*
|
||||
m` motion.txt /*m`*
|
||||
@@ -6782,6 +6842,7 @@ netrw-R pi_netrw.txt /*netrw-R*
|
||||
netrw-S pi_netrw.txt /*netrw-S*
|
||||
netrw-T pi_netrw.txt /*netrw-T*
|
||||
netrw-U pi_netrw.txt /*netrw-U*
|
||||
netrw-X pi_netrw.txt /*netrw-X*
|
||||
netrw-a pi_netrw.txt /*netrw-a*
|
||||
netrw-activate pi_netrw.txt /*netrw-activate*
|
||||
netrw-bookmark pi_netrw.txt /*netrw-bookmark*
|
||||
@@ -7228,7 +7289,10 @@ pterm-mouse options.txt /*pterm-mouse*
|
||||
pumvisible() eval.txt /*pumvisible()*
|
||||
put change.txt /*put*
|
||||
put-Visual-mode change.txt /*put-Visual-mode*
|
||||
py3eval() eval.txt /*py3eval()*
|
||||
pyeval() eval.txt /*pyeval()*
|
||||
python if_pyth.txt /*python*
|
||||
python-bindeval if_pyth.txt /*python-bindeval*
|
||||
python-buffer if_pyth.txt /*python-buffer*
|
||||
python-buffers if_pyth.txt /*python-buffers*
|
||||
python-command if_pyth.txt /*python-command*
|
||||
@@ -7240,6 +7304,7 @@ python-eval if_pyth.txt /*python-eval*
|
||||
python-examples if_pyth.txt /*python-examples*
|
||||
python-input if_pyth.txt /*python-input*
|
||||
python-output if_pyth.txt /*python-output*
|
||||
python-pyeval if_pyth.txt /*python-pyeval*
|
||||
python-range if_pyth.txt /*python-range*
|
||||
python-vim if_pyth.txt /*python-vim*
|
||||
python-window if_pyth.txt /*python-window*
|
||||
@@ -7364,6 +7429,7 @@ rileft.txt rileft.txt /*rileft.txt*
|
||||
riscos os_risc.txt /*riscos*
|
||||
rot13 change.txt /*rot13*
|
||||
round() eval.txt /*round()*
|
||||
rst.vim syntax.txt /*rst.vim*
|
||||
rsync pi_netrw.txt /*rsync*
|
||||
ruby if_ruby.txt /*ruby*
|
||||
ruby-buffer if_ruby.txt /*ruby-buffer*
|
||||
@@ -7415,6 +7481,8 @@ save-file editing.txt /*save-file*
|
||||
save-settings starting.txt /*save-settings*
|
||||
scheme.vim syntax.txt /*scheme.vim*
|
||||
scp pi_netrw.txt /*scp*
|
||||
screencol() eval.txt /*screencol()*
|
||||
screenrow() eval.txt /*screenrow()*
|
||||
script usr_41.txt /*script*
|
||||
script-here if_perl.txt /*script-here*
|
||||
script-local map.txt /*script-local*
|
||||
@@ -7479,6 +7547,7 @@ setuid change.txt /*setuid*
|
||||
setwinvar() eval.txt /*setwinvar()*
|
||||
sftp pi_netrw.txt /*sftp*
|
||||
sgml.vim syntax.txt /*sgml.vim*
|
||||
sgr-mouse options.txt /*sgr-mouse*
|
||||
sh-awk syntax.txt /*sh-awk*
|
||||
sh-embed syntax.txt /*sh-embed*
|
||||
sh.vim syntax.txt /*sh.vim*
|
||||
@@ -7487,6 +7556,7 @@ shell_error-variable eval.txt /*shell_error-variable*
|
||||
shellescape() eval.txt /*shellescape()*
|
||||
shift intro.txt /*shift*
|
||||
shift-left-right change.txt /*shift-left-right*
|
||||
shiftwidth() eval.txt /*shiftwidth()*
|
||||
short-name-changed version4.txt /*short-name-changed*
|
||||
showing-menus gui.txt /*showing-menus*
|
||||
sign-commands sign.txt /*sign-commands*
|
||||
@@ -8265,11 +8335,13 @@ v_d change.txt /*v_d*
|
||||
v_g? change.txt /*v_g?*
|
||||
v_gF editing.txt /*v_gF*
|
||||
v_gJ change.txt /*v_gJ*
|
||||
v_gN visual.txt /*v_gN*
|
||||
v_gV visual.txt /*v_gV*
|
||||
v_g] tagsrch.txt /*v_g]*
|
||||
v_g_CTRL-G editing.txt /*v_g_CTRL-G*
|
||||
v_g_CTRL-] tagsrch.txt /*v_g_CTRL-]*
|
||||
v_gf editing.txt /*v_gf*
|
||||
v_gn visual.txt /*v_gn*
|
||||
v_gq change.txt /*v_gq*
|
||||
v_gv visual.txt /*v_gv*
|
||||
v_gw change.txt /*v_gw*
|
||||
@@ -8432,6 +8504,7 @@ vt100-cursor-keys term.txt /*vt100-cursor-keys*
|
||||
vt100-function-keys term.txt /*vt100-function-keys*
|
||||
w motion.txt /*w*
|
||||
w32-clientserver remote.txt /*w32-clientserver*
|
||||
w32-xpm-support gui_w32.txt /*w32-xpm-support*
|
||||
w:current_syntax syntax.txt /*w:current_syntax*
|
||||
w:quickfix_title quickfix.txt /*w:quickfix_title*
|
||||
w:var eval.txt /*w:var*
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*todo.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Apr 13
|
||||
*todo.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Dec 05
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -34,94 +34,219 @@ not be repeated below, unless there is extra information.
|
||||
*known-bugs*
|
||||
-------------------- Known bugs and current work -----------------------
|
||||
|
||||
Go through list of maintainers that didn't respond. (Thilo Six, Mar 19)
|
||||
On external command get the message:
|
||||
SIGCHLD handler called (some thread has SIGCHLD unblocked)
|
||||
From MzScheme
|
||||
|
||||
Go through more coverity reports.
|
||||
|
||||
Discussion about canonicalization of Hebrew. (Ron Aaron, 2011 April 10)
|
||||
|
||||
Stack trace of crash: http://vpaste.net/GBt9S
|
||||
(Alexandre Provencio)
|
||||
|
||||
":help!" gives error, should use current language. (thinkca, 2012 Apr 1)
|
||||
|
||||
Once syntax and other runtime files have been fixed: add "set cp" to
|
||||
check.vim. Use a function to run both with 'cp' and 'nocp'.
|
||||
Checking runtime scripts: Thilo Six, 2012 Jun 6.
|
||||
|
||||
GTK: problem with 'L' in 'guioptions' changing the window width.
|
||||
(Aaron Cornelius, 2012 Feb 6)
|
||||
|
||||
Javascript file where indent gets stuck on: GalaxyMaster, 2012 May 3.
|
||||
|
||||
The CompleteDone autocommand needs some info passed to it:
|
||||
- The word that was selected (empty if abandoned complete)
|
||||
- Type of completion: tag, omnifunc, user func.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for matchit.vim. (Mike Morearty, 2012 Nov 28)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to fix that the QuitPre autocommand clears the quitmore flag. (Techlive
|
||||
Zheng, 2012 Nov 28)
|
||||
|
||||
":gundo" command: global undo. Undoes changes spread over multiple files in
|
||||
the order they were made. Also ":gredo". Both with a count. Useful when
|
||||
tests fail after making changes and you forgot in which files.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to make updating tabline faster. (Arseny Kapoulkine, 2012 Oct 3)
|
||||
Also remove the "rc" variable.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to make "- register not always used. (Christian Brabandt, 2012 Nov 28)
|
||||
|
||||
Crash with vimdiff. (Don Cruickshank, 2012 Sep 23)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to support subdirectories for help files. (Charles Campbell, 2012 Nov
|
||||
21)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for mzscheme. (Sergey Khorev, 2012 Nov 19)
|
||||
What about ignoring SEGV?
|
||||
|
||||
Win32: use 'guifontwide' for IME composition. (Taro Muraoka, 2012 Sep 30)
|
||||
Update Oct 2.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to fix :s command with confirm and typing "a". (Christian Brabandt, 2012
|
||||
Oct 28)
|
||||
|
||||
/[^\n] does match at a line break. Expected to do the same as /.
|
||||
Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2012 Dec 1.
|
||||
Test files in archive in another message.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to make multibyte input work on Win32 console when codepage differs from
|
||||
'encoding'. (Ken Takata, 2012 Sep 29)
|
||||
|
||||
It's possible to defined an input() function that overrides the built-in one.
|
||||
(ZyX, 2012 Sep 28)
|
||||
|
||||
Win32: When a directory name contains an exclamation mark, completion doesn't
|
||||
complete the contents of the directory. No escaping for the "!"? (Jan
|
||||
Stocker, 2012 Jan 5)
|
||||
|
||||
Problem parsing expression with function(). (Andy Wokula, 2012 Nov 22)
|
||||
Patch by Christian Brabandt, Nov 22. Tests in another patch, Nov 23.
|
||||
|
||||
Problem caused by patch 7.3.638: window->open does not update window
|
||||
correctly. Issue 91.
|
||||
|
||||
Do allow real tags above the !_TAG entries. Undo older patch. Issue 90.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to support 'u' in interactive substitute. (Christian Brabandt, 2012 Sep
|
||||
28) With tests: Oct 9.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for IME handling, adds 'imactivatefunc' and 'imstatusfunc' option.
|
||||
(Yukihiro Nakadaira, 2012 Aug 16)
|
||||
Patch to improve IME handling. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto, 2012 Jul 18)
|
||||
|
||||
Issue 54: document behavior of -complete, also expands arg.
|
||||
|
||||
New syntax files for apt. (quidame, 2012 Sep 21)
|
||||
|
||||
'ff' is wrong for one-line file without EOL. (Issue 77)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for if_lua. (Luis Carvalho, 2012 Aug 26, update Aug 29, another Aug 30,
|
||||
then Sep 1, reminder Oct 14)
|
||||
|
||||
Issue 72: 'autochdir' causes problems for :vimgrep.
|
||||
|
||||
Undo problem: line not removed as expected when using setline() from Insert
|
||||
mode. (Israel Chauca, 2010 May 13, more in second msg)
|
||||
Break undo when CTRL-R = changes the text? Or save more lines?
|
||||
Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2012 Nov 16.
|
||||
|
||||
In the ATTENTION message about an existing swap file, mention the name of the
|
||||
process that is running. It might actually be some other program, e.g. after
|
||||
a reboot.
|
||||
|
||||
MS-Windows: Crash opening very long file name starting with "\\".
|
||||
(Christian Brock, 2012 Jun 29)
|
||||
|
||||
It's probably a good idea to make a negative value for 'sts' use the value of
|
||||
'sw'. Patch by So8res, Oct 3 2012
|
||||
|
||||
Syntax update problem in one buffer opened in two windows, bottom window is
|
||||
not correctly updated. (Paul Harris, 2012 Feb 27)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to add assignments in cscope. (Uli Meis, Estabrooks, 2012 Sep 1)
|
||||
Alternate patch by Gary Johnson, Sep 4.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to add getsid(). (Tyru, 2011 Oct 2) Do we want this? Update Oct 4.
|
||||
Or use expand('<sid>')?
|
||||
|
||||
Win32: When the taskbar is at the top of the screen creating the tabbar causes
|
||||
the window to move unnecessarily. (William E. Skeith III, 2012 Jan 12)
|
||||
Patch: 2012 Jan 13 Needs more work (2012 Feb 2)
|
||||
Patch for :tabcloseleft, after closing a tab go to left tab. (William Bowers,
|
||||
2012 Aug 4)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch with suggestions for starting.txt. (Tony Mechelynck, 2012 Oct 24)
|
||||
But use Gnome instead of GTK?
|
||||
|
||||
Should be possible to enable/disable matchparen per window or buffer.
|
||||
Add a check for b:no_match_paren in Highlight_matching_Pair() (Marcin
|
||||
Szamotulski, 2012 Nov 8)
|
||||
|
||||
Crash in autocmd that unloads buffers in a BufUnload event. (Andrew Pimlott,
|
||||
2012 Aug 11) Disallow :new when BufUnload is being handled?
|
||||
|
||||
MS-Windows ACL support doesn't work well. Patch from Ken Takata, 2012 Aug 29.
|
||||
Update Aug 31.
|
||||
|
||||
MS-Windows resizing problems:
|
||||
- Windows window on screen positioning: Patch by Yukihiro Nakadaira, 2012 Jun
|
||||
20. Uses getWindowRect() instead of GetWindowPlacement()
|
||||
- Win32: When the taskbar is at the top of the screen creating the tabbar
|
||||
causes the window to move unnecessarily. (William E. Skeith III, 2012 Jan
|
||||
12) Patch: 2012 Jan 13 Needs more work (2012 Feb 2)
|
||||
|
||||
'iminsert' global value set when using ":setlocal iminsert"? (Wu, 2012 Jun 23)
|
||||
|
||||
Help for b:undo_indent'. (Thilo Six, 2012 May 28)
|
||||
Also question if examples are correct.
|
||||
|
||||
It should be possible to make globpath() return a list instead of a string,
|
||||
like with glob(). (Greg Novack, 2012 Nov 2)
|
||||
|
||||
The input map for CTRL-O in mswin.vim causes problems after CTRL-X CTRL-O.
|
||||
Suggestion for another map. (Philip Mat, 2012 Jun 18)
|
||||
But use "gi" instead of "a". Or use CTRL-\ CTRL-O.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to support user name completion on MS-Windows. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto, 2012
|
||||
Aug 16)
|
||||
|
||||
Have an option for spell checking to not mark any Chinese, Japanese or other
|
||||
double-width characters as error. Or perhaps all characters above 256.
|
||||
(Bill Sun) Helps a lot for mixed Asian and latin text.
|
||||
|
||||
When there are no command line arguments ":next" and ":argu" give E163, which
|
||||
is confusing. Should say "the argument list is empty".
|
||||
|
||||
URXVT:
|
||||
- will get stuck if byte sequence does not containe expected semicolon.
|
||||
- will get stuck if byte sequence does not contain the expected semicolon.
|
||||
- Use urxvt mouse support also in xterm. Explanations:
|
||||
http://www.midnight-commander.org/ticket/2662
|
||||
|
||||
MS-Windows: test 17 fails. Analysis by Michael Soyka, 2012 Nov 5.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to add tests for if_xcmdsrv.c., Jul 8, need some more work. (Brian Burns)
|
||||
New tests Jul 13. Update Jul 17. Discussion Jul 18.
|
||||
|
||||
When running Vim in silent ex mode, an existing swapfile causes Vim to wait
|
||||
for a user action without a prompt. (Maarten Billemont, 2012 Feb 3)
|
||||
Do give the prompt? Quit with an error?
|
||||
|
||||
When exiting with unsaved changes, selecting an existing file in the file
|
||||
dialog, there is no dialog to ask whether the existing file should be
|
||||
overwritten. (Felipe G. Nievinski, 2011 Dec 22)
|
||||
|
||||
Docs fix for v:register. (Ingo Karkat, 2011 Sep 26, 27)
|
||||
v:register doesn't work exactly as expected. (David Fishburn, 2011 Sep 20)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for: vimgrep fails when 'autochdir' is set. (Ben Fritz, 2012 Feb 4)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for: (Christian Brabandt, 2011 Aug 22)
|
||||
- Make it possible to enter "r<C-E>" and "r<C-Y>" (get character from line
|
||||
below/above).
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for: (Christian Brabandt, 2011 Aug 24, updated patch)
|
||||
8 ":sign unplace * file={filename}" should work. Also: ":sign unplace *
|
||||
buffer={bufnr}". So one can remove all signs for one file/buffer.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to add "onselected" callback for completion. (Taro Muraoka, 2011 Sep 24)
|
||||
Another for CompleteFuncOk. (Florian Klein, 2012 Jan 31)
|
||||
Name it "CompleteFuncDone".
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for Make_mvc.mak and Make_ming.mak for Ruby support. (Yasuhiro
|
||||
Matsumoto, 2012 Jan 30)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to add completion for :history command. (Dominique Pelle, 2012 Feb 26)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for 'backupcopy' default behavior for symlinks on Windows. (David Pope,
|
||||
2012 Mar 21, update Mar 31)
|
||||
With fix for memory leak: Ken Takata, 2012 Aug 24
|
||||
Another update Sep 24.
|
||||
|
||||
Use a count before "v" and "V" to select that many characters or lines?
|
||||
(Kikyous)
|
||||
Patch to list user digraphs. (Christian Brabandt, 2012 Apr 14)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for input method status. (Hirohito Higashi, 2012 Apr 18)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to print the result of a :python command. (Maxim Philippov
|
||||
<philippovmi@gmail.com>, 2012 Aug 16) Update Aug 17.
|
||||
|
||||
Problem with winfixheight and resizing. (Yukihiro Nakadaira, 2011 Sep 17)
|
||||
Patch Sep 18.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for IME problems. Remove hacking code for old IM. (Yukihiro Nakadaira,
|
||||
2012 Jul 20)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for has('unnamedplus') docs. (Tony Mechelynck, 2011 Sep 27)
|
||||
And one for gui_x11.txt.
|
||||
|
||||
- Patch for 'breakindent' option: repeat indent for wrapped line. (Vaclav
|
||||
Smilauer, 2004 Sep 13, fix Oct 31, update 2007 May 30)
|
||||
Version for latest MacVim: Tobia Conforto, 2009 Nov 23
|
||||
More recent version: https://retracile.net/wiki/VimBreakIndent
|
||||
Posted to vim-dev by Taylor Hedberg, 2011 Nov 25
|
||||
|
||||
Problem with starting Visual block mode with :norm when 'virtualedit' is set.
|
||||
(David glts, 2012 Jun 5)
|
||||
|
||||
":cd" doesn't work when current directory path contains "**".
|
||||
finddir() has the same problem. (Yukihiro Nakadaira, 2012 Jan 10)
|
||||
Requires a rewrite of the file_file_in_path code.
|
||||
|
||||
Problem with l: dictionary being locked in a function. (ZyX, 2011 Jul 21)
|
||||
|
||||
Should use has("browsefilter") in ftplugins. Requires patch 7.3.593.
|
||||
|
||||
Issue 48: foldopen error can't be caught by try/catch
|
||||
|
||||
"dg_" deletes including the last character, "d:normal! g_" doesn't.
|
||||
(Nomen Nescio, 2012 Jun 27)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to sort functions starting with '<' after others. Omit dict functions,
|
||||
they can't be called. (Yasuhiro Matsumoto, 2011 Oct 11)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -130,6 +255,9 @@ Patch to pass list to or(), and() and xor(). (Yasuhiro Matsumoto, 2012 Feb 8)
|
||||
Patch to improve "it" and "at" text object matching. (Christian Brabandt, 2011
|
||||
Nov 20)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to improve GUI find/replace dialog. (Christian Brabandt, 2012 May 26)
|
||||
Update Jun 2.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to add ":py3do". (Lilydjwg, 2012 Apr 7)
|
||||
|
||||
`[ moves to character after insert, instead of the last inserted character.
|
||||
@@ -143,9 +271,6 @@ Updated syntax file for ssh_config, maintainer doesn't respond.
|
||||
BufWinLeave triggers too late when quitting last window in a tab page. (Lech
|
||||
Lorens, 2012 Feb 21)
|
||||
|
||||
"fC" doesn't position the cursor correctly when there are concealed
|
||||
characters. Patch by Christian Brabandt, 2011 Oct 11)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch for 'transparency' option. (Sergiu Dotenco, 2011 Sep 17)
|
||||
Only for MS-Windows. No documentation. Do we want this?
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -154,17 +279,16 @@ Patch to support cursor shape in Cygwin console. (Ben bgold, 2011 Dec 27)
|
||||
Patch to support UTF-8 for Hangul. (Shawn Y.H. Kim, 2011 May 1)
|
||||
Needs more work. Pinged 2012 Jan 4.
|
||||
|
||||
Issue 64: when 'incsearch' is on can't paste LF on command line.
|
||||
|
||||
On MS-Windows a temp dir with a & init causes system() to fail. (Ben Fritz,
|
||||
2012 Jun 19)
|
||||
|
||||
'cursorline' is displayed too short when there are concealed characters and
|
||||
'list' is set. (Dennis Preiser)
|
||||
Patch 7.3.116 was the wrong solution.
|
||||
Christian Brabandt has another incomplete patch. (2011 Jul 13)
|
||||
|
||||
'cursorline' is drawn incorrectly in diff mode. Patch by Christian Brabandt,
|
||||
2012 Apr 2.
|
||||
|
||||
'cursorline' works on a text line only. Add 'cursorscreenline' for
|
||||
highlighting the screen line. (Christian Brabandt, 2012 Mar 31)
|
||||
|
||||
With concealed text mouse click doesn't put the cursor in the right position.
|
||||
(Herb Sitz) Fix by Christian Brabandt, 2011 Jun 16. Doesn't work properly,
|
||||
need to make the change in where RET_WIN_BUF_CHARTABSIZE() is called.
|
||||
@@ -173,6 +297,12 @@ Syntax region with 'concealends' and a 'cchar' value, 'conceallevel' set to 2,
|
||||
only one of the two ends gets the cchar displayed. (Brett Stahlman, 2010 Aug
|
||||
21, Ben Fritz, 2010 Sep 14)
|
||||
|
||||
'cursorline' is drawn incorrectly in diff mode. Patch by Christian Brabandt,
|
||||
2012 Apr 2.
|
||||
|
||||
'cursorline' works on a text line only. Add 'cursorscreenline' for
|
||||
highlighting the screen line. (Christian Brabandt, 2012 Mar 31)
|
||||
|
||||
Win32: Does building a 64 bit version with VC9 give warnings for int
|
||||
conversions? (Mike Williams)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -195,6 +325,9 @@ Oct 26)
|
||||
|
||||
Bug in repeating Visual "u". (Lawrence Kesteloot, 2010 Dec 20)
|
||||
|
||||
Using "p" in Visual mode while specifying the small delete register "-
|
||||
overwrites the register before it is put. (Marcin Szamotulski, 2012 Nov 23)
|
||||
|
||||
With "unamedplus" in 'clipboard' pasting in Visual mode causes error for empty
|
||||
register. (Michael Seiwald, 2011 Jun 28) I can't reproduce it.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -218,9 +351,6 @@ Christoph Ebersbach, 2011 Jul 3)
|
||||
|
||||
Windows keys not set properly on Windows 7? (cncyber, 2010 Aug 26)
|
||||
|
||||
This line hangs Vim, because of syntax HL:
|
||||
call append(line, "INFO ....12....18....24....30....36....42....48....54....60....66....72....78%$")
|
||||
|
||||
When using a Vim server, a # in the path causes an error message.
|
||||
(Jeff Lanzarotta, 2011 Feb 17)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -245,6 +375,10 @@ Vim using lots of memory when joining lines. (John Little, 2010 Dec 3)
|
||||
|
||||
Changes to manpage plugin. (Elias Toivanen, 2011 Jul 25)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to make "z=" work when 'spell' is off. Does this have nasty side
|
||||
effects? (Christian Brabandt, 2012 Aug 5)
|
||||
Would also need to do this for spellbadword() and spellsuggest().
|
||||
|
||||
On 64 bit MS-Windows "long" is only 32 bits, but we sometimes need to store a
|
||||
64 bits value. Change all number options to use nropt_T and define it to the
|
||||
right type.
|
||||
@@ -269,9 +403,6 @@ mapping, how to restore the script ID?
|
||||
Bug in try/catch: return with invalid compare throws error that isn't caught.
|
||||
(ZyX, 2011 Jan 26)
|
||||
|
||||
Highlighting stops working after changing it many times. Script to reproduce
|
||||
it: Pablo Contreras, 2010 Oct 12 Windows XP and 7. Font is never freed?
|
||||
|
||||
When setting a local option value from the global value, add a script ID that
|
||||
indicates this, so that ":verbose set" can give a hint. Check with options in
|
||||
the help file.
|
||||
@@ -350,7 +481,7 @@ Searching mixed with Visual mode doesn't redraw properly. (James Vega, 2010 Nov
|
||||
|
||||
New esperanto spell file can't be processed. (Dominique Pelle, 2011 Jan 30)
|
||||
- move compflags to separate growarray?
|
||||
- instead of a regexp use a hashtable. Expand '?', '*", '+'. What would be
|
||||
- instead of a regexp use a hashtable. Expand '?', '*', '+'. What would be
|
||||
the maximum repeat for * and +?
|
||||
|
||||
"L'Italie" noted as a spell error at start of the sentence. (Dominique Pelle,
|
||||
@@ -362,6 +493,7 @@ When putting text in the cut buffer (when exiting) and conversion doesn't work
|
||||
properly, Prepend "ENC==={value of 'enc'}:" to the text and don't convert?
|
||||
Then it should at least work from Vim to Vim and in other applications it's
|
||||
clear why it doesn't work.
|
||||
Experimental patch by Christian Brabandt, 2012 Apr 19.
|
||||
|
||||
Editing a file with a ^M with 'ff' set to "mac", opening a help file, then the
|
||||
^M is displayed as ^J sometimes. Getting 'ff' value from wrong window/buffer?
|
||||
@@ -497,12 +629,17 @@ Add local time at start of --startuptime output.
|
||||
Requires configure check for localtime().
|
||||
Use format year-month-day hr:min:sec.
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to add "combine" to :syntax, combines highlight attributes. (Nate
|
||||
Soares, 2012 Dec 3)
|
||||
|
||||
Patch to make ":hi link" also take arguments. (Nate Soares, 2012 Dec 4)
|
||||
|
||||
Shell not recognized properly if it ends in "csh -f". (James Vega, 2009 Nov 3)
|
||||
Find tail? Might have a / in argument. Find space? Might have space in
|
||||
path.
|
||||
|
||||
Test 51 fails when language set to German. (Marco, 2011 Jan 9)
|
||||
Dominique can't reproduc it.
|
||||
Dominique can't reproduce it.
|
||||
|
||||
'ambiwidth' should be global-local.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -535,10 +672,6 @@ Problem with stop directory in findfile(). (Adam Simpkins, 2009 Aug 26)
|
||||
Using ']' as the end of a range in a pattern requires double escaping:
|
||||
/[@-\\]] (Andy Wokula, 2011 Jun 28)
|
||||
|
||||
Undo problem: line not removed as expected when using setline() from Insert
|
||||
mode. (Israel Chauca, 2010 May 13, more in second msg)
|
||||
Break undo when CTRL-R = changes the text? Or save more lines?
|
||||
|
||||
Slow combination of folding and PHP syntax highlighting. Script to reproduce
|
||||
it. Caused by "syntax sync fromstart" in combination with patch 7.2.274.
|
||||
(Christian Brabandt, 2010 May 27)
|
||||
@@ -557,9 +690,6 @@ When a:base in 'completefunc' starts with a number it's passed as a number,
|
||||
not a string. (Sean Ma) Need to add flag to call_func_retlist() to force a
|
||||
string value.
|
||||
|
||||
":e ~br<Tab>" does not complete to ":e /home/bram/". Would need to use
|
||||
getpwent() to find all the matches.
|
||||
|
||||
Invalid read error in Farsi mode. (Dominique Pelle, 2009 Aug 2)
|
||||
|
||||
For running gvim on an USB stick: avoid the OLE registration. Use a command
|
||||
@@ -644,10 +774,6 @@ Now that colnr_T is int instead of unsigned, more type casts can be removed.
|
||||
'delcombine' does not work for the command line. (Tony Mechelynck, 2009 Jul
|
||||
20)
|
||||
|
||||
Unwanted file name escaping: ":echo input('file:' , '', 'file')"
|
||||
And use file name completion on a file with spaces. (Frederic Hardy, 2009 Mar
|
||||
23)
|
||||
|
||||
Don't load macmap.vim on startup, turn it into a plugin. (Ron Aaron,
|
||||
2009 Apr 7) Reminder Apr 14.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -687,10 +813,6 @@ Support a 'systemencoding' option (for Unix). It specifies the encoding of
|
||||
file names. (Kikuchan, 2010 Oct 5). Useful on a latin1 or double-byte Asian
|
||||
system when 'encoding' is "utf-8".
|
||||
|
||||
Win32: A --remote command that has a directory name starting with a ( doesn't
|
||||
work, the backslash is removed, assuming that it escapes the (. (Valery
|
||||
Kondakoff, 2009 May 13)
|
||||
|
||||
Win32 GUI: Changing manifest helps for dpi changes (Joe Castro, 2009 Mar 27)
|
||||
|
||||
Win32 GUI: last message from startup doesn't show up when there is an echoerr
|
||||
@@ -708,7 +830,7 @@ very high. (Yegappan Lakshmanan, 2010 Jul 22, Michael Peeters, 2010 Jul 22)
|
||||
Directory wrong in session file, caused by ":lcd" in BufEnter autocommand.
|
||||
(Felix Kater, 2009 Mar 3)
|
||||
|
||||
Session file generates error upon loading, cause bu --remote-silent-tab.
|
||||
Session file generates error upon loading, cause by --remote-silent-tab.
|
||||
(7tommm (ytommm) 2010 Nov 24)
|
||||
|
||||
Using ~ works OK on 'a' with composing char, but not on 0x0418 with composing
|
||||
@@ -829,8 +951,6 @@ error message? Or is this easy to implement? (Nathan Stratton Treadway, 2008
|
||||
Aug 20) This is in ucs2bytes(), search for 0xBF. Using the ++bad argument is
|
||||
at the other match for 0xBF.
|
||||
|
||||
Fix for matchparen HL doesn't work. beep.
|
||||
|
||||
When adding "-complete=file" to a user command this also changes how the
|
||||
argument is processed for <f-args>. (Ivan Tishchenko, 2008 Aug 19)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -876,6 +996,15 @@ escaping characters where the backslash is not removed later. Asked Chris for
|
||||
an alternate solution, also for src/ex_getln.c.
|
||||
This also fails when the file or directory name contains "%". (Thoml, 2008
|
||||
July 7)
|
||||
Using --remote-silent while the current directory has a # in the name does not
|
||||
work, the # needs to be escaped. (Tramblay Bruno, 2012 Sep 15)
|
||||
|
||||
When using remote-silent the -R flag is not passed on. (Axel Bender, 2012 May
|
||||
31)
|
||||
|
||||
Win32: A --remote command that has a directory name starting with a ( doesn't
|
||||
work, the backslash is removed, assuming that it escapes the (. (Valery
|
||||
Kondakoff, 2009 May 13)
|
||||
|
||||
Problem with 'langmap' being used on the rhs of a mapping. (Nikolai Weibull,
|
||||
2008 May 14)
|
||||
@@ -1094,6 +1223,7 @@ Latest version: 2011 May 18
|
||||
8 Windows install with NSIS: make it possible to do a silent install, see
|
||||
http://nsis.sourceforge.net/Docs/Chapter4.html#4.12
|
||||
Version from Guopeng Wen that does this (2010 Dec 27)
|
||||
Alternative: MSI installer: https://github.com/petrkle/vim-msi/
|
||||
|
||||
Windows installer should install 32-bit version of right-click handler also on
|
||||
64-bit systems. (Brian Cunningham, 2011 Dec 28)
|
||||
@@ -1157,10 +1287,6 @@ pointer in long and seek offset in 64 bit var.
|
||||
|
||||
Win32: patch for fullscreen mode. (Liushaolin, 2008 April 17)
|
||||
|
||||
Win32: When there is 4 Gbyte of memory mch_avail_mem() doesn't work properly.
|
||||
Unfinished patch by Jelle Geerts, 2008 Aug 24.
|
||||
Let mch_avail_mem() return Kbyte instead?
|
||||
|
||||
Win32: When 'shell' is bash shellescape() doesn't always do the right thing.
|
||||
Depends on 'shellslash', 'shellquote' and 'shellxquote', but shellescape()
|
||||
only takes 'shellslash' into account.
|
||||
@@ -1470,6 +1596,9 @@ Win32, NTFS: When editing a specific infostream directly and 'backupcopy' is
|
||||
name is something like "c:\path\foo.txt:bar", includes a colon. (Alex
|
||||
Jakushev, 2008 Feb 1)
|
||||
|
||||
printf() uses the field width in bytes. Can it be made character width,
|
||||
perhaps with a modifier? What does Posix say?
|
||||
|
||||
Small problem displaying diff filler line when opening windows with a script.
|
||||
(David Luyer, 2007 Mar 1 ~/Mail/oldmail/mool/in.15872 )
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1602,11 +1731,6 @@ Awaiting updated patches:
|
||||
7 Completion of network shares, patch by Yasuhiro Matsumoto.
|
||||
Update 2004 Sep 6.
|
||||
How does this work? Missing comments.
|
||||
- Patch for 'breakindent' option: repeat indent for wrapped line. (Vaclav
|
||||
Smilauer, 2004 Sep 13, fix Oct 31, update 2007 May 30)
|
||||
Version for latest MacVim: Tobia Conforto, 2009 Nov 23
|
||||
More recent version: https://retracile.net/wiki/VimBreakIndent
|
||||
Posted to vim-dev by Taylor Hedberg, 2011 Nov 25
|
||||
8 Add a few more command names to the menus. Patch from Jiri Brezina
|
||||
(28 feb 2002). Will mess the translations...
|
||||
7 ATTENTION dialog choices are more logical when "Delete it' appears
|
||||
@@ -2624,8 +2748,6 @@ Tab pages:
|
||||
font, etc.)
|
||||
8 Make GUI menu in tab pages line configurable. Like the popup menu.
|
||||
8 balloons for the tab page labels that are shortened to show the full path.
|
||||
8 :tabmove +N move tab page N pages forward
|
||||
8 :tabmove -N move tab page N pages backward
|
||||
7 :tabdup duplicate the tab with all its windows.
|
||||
7 Option to put tab line at the left or right? Need an option to specify
|
||||
its width. It's like a separate window with ":tabs" output.
|
||||
@@ -2927,6 +3049,8 @@ Syntax highlighting:
|
||||
this isn't reset. Add a special keyword definition for the syntax rules?
|
||||
When this is done, use vim.vim syntax highlighting for help file examples,
|
||||
but without ":" in 'iskeyword' for syntax.
|
||||
Also need a separate 'iskeyword' for the command line, e.g., in a help
|
||||
window ":e /asdf/asdf/" CTRL-W works different.
|
||||
8 Add specific syntax item to match with parens/braces that don't have a
|
||||
"%" match. :syntax nomatch cMatchError (,{,[,),},] [contained]
|
||||
8 Highlight the text between two matching parens (e.g., with a grey
|
||||
@@ -3927,7 +4051,6 @@ Insert mode:
|
||||
- Add option to 'cindent' to set indent for comments outside of {}?
|
||||
- Make a command to line up a comment after a code line with a previous
|
||||
comment after a code line. Can 'cindent' do this automatically?
|
||||
7 Add 'j' flag to 'formatoptions': Remove comment leader when joining lines.
|
||||
- When 'cindent'ing a '}', showmatch is done before fixing the indent. It
|
||||
looks better when the indent is fixed before the showmatch. (Webb)
|
||||
- Add option to make indenting work in comments too (for commented-out
|
||||
@@ -4884,6 +5007,7 @@ Various improvements:
|
||||
- Make it possible for the 'showbreak' to be displayed at the end of the
|
||||
line. Use a comma to separate the part at the end and the start of the
|
||||
line? Highlight the linebreak characters, add flag in 'highlight'.
|
||||
Make 'showbreak' local to a window.
|
||||
- Some string options should be expanded if they have wildcards, e.g.
|
||||
'dictionary' when it is "*.h".
|
||||
- Use a specific type for number and boolean options, making it possible to
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*uganda.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2010 Aug 07
|
||||
*uganda.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Dec 02
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -238,6 +238,7 @@ Canada: Contact Kibaale Children's Fund (KCF) in Surrey, Canada. They
|
||||
Holland: Transfer to the account of "Stichting ICCF Holland" in Lisse.
|
||||
This will allow for tax deduction if you live in Holland.
|
||||
Postbank, nr. 4548774
|
||||
IBAN: NL95 INGB 0004 5487 74
|
||||
|
||||
Germany: It is possible to make donations that allow for a tax return.
|
||||
Check the ICCF web site for the latest information:
|
||||
@@ -266,7 +267,7 @@ Credit Card: You can use PayPal to send money with a Credit card. This is
|
||||
Others: Transfer to one of these accounts if possible:
|
||||
Postbank, account 4548774
|
||||
Swift code: INGB NL 2A
|
||||
IBAN: NL47 PSTB 0004 5487 74
|
||||
IBAN: NL95 INGB 0004 5487 74
|
||||
under the name "stichting ICCF Holland", Lisse
|
||||
If that doesn't work:
|
||||
Rabobank Lisse, account 3765.05.117
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*usr_05.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2009 Jun 04
|
||||
*usr_05.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Nov 20
|
||||
|
||||
VIM USER MANUAL - by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -49,8 +49,7 @@ For MS-DOS and MS-Windows you can use one of these:
|
||||
|
||||
The vimrc file can contain all the commands that you type after a colon. The
|
||||
most simple ones are for setting options. For example, if you want Vim to
|
||||
always start with the 'incsearch' option on, add this line you your vimrc
|
||||
file: >
|
||||
always start with the 'incsearch' option on, add this line your vimrc file: >
|
||||
|
||||
set incsearch
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*usr_21.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2008 Nov 09
|
||||
*usr_21.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Nov 02
|
||||
|
||||
VIM USER MANUAL - by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -282,7 +282,7 @@ example, use: >
|
||||
SESSION HERE, SESSION THERE
|
||||
|
||||
The obvious way to use sessions is when working on different projects.
|
||||
Suppose you store you session files in the directory "~/.vim". You are
|
||||
Suppose you store your session files in the directory "~/.vim". You are
|
||||
currently working on the "secret" project and have to switch to the "boring"
|
||||
project: >
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -295,7 +295,7 @@ is saved, using ":mksession!". This overwrites the previous session. The
|
||||
next time you load the secret session you can continue where you were at this
|
||||
point. And finally you load the new "boring" session.
|
||||
|
||||
If you open help windows, split and close various window, and generally mess
|
||||
If you open help windows, split and close various windows, and generally mess
|
||||
up the window layout, you can go back to the last saved session: >
|
||||
|
||||
:source ~/.vim/boring.vim
|
||||
@@ -423,10 +423,10 @@ and nine numbered 1 to 9.
|
||||
A VIEW WITH A NAME
|
||||
|
||||
The second basic way to use views is by storing the view in a file with a name
|
||||
you chose. This view can be loaded while editing another file. Vim will then
|
||||
switch to editing the file specified in the view. Thus you can use this to
|
||||
quickly switch to editing another file, with all its options set as you saved
|
||||
them.
|
||||
you choose. This view can be loaded while editing another file. Vim will
|
||||
then switch to editing the file specified in the view. Thus you can use this
|
||||
to quickly switch to editing another file, with all its options set as you
|
||||
saved them.
|
||||
For example, to save the view of the current file: >
|
||||
|
||||
:mkview ~/.vim/main.vim
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*usr_22.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2010 Feb 21
|
||||
*usr_22.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Nov 15
|
||||
|
||||
VIM USER MANUAL - by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -326,9 +326,9 @@ shorter to type: >
|
||||
|
||||
The output could look like this:
|
||||
|
||||
1 #h "help.txt" line 62 ~
|
||||
2 %a+ "usr_21.txt" line 1 ~
|
||||
3 "usr_toc.txt" line 1 ~
|
||||
1 #h "help.txt" line 62 ~
|
||||
2 %a + "usr_21.txt" line 1 ~
|
||||
3 "usr_toc.txt" line 1 ~
|
||||
|
||||
The first column contains the buffer number. You can use this to edit the
|
||||
buffer without having to type the name, see below.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*usr_41.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Mar 16
|
||||
*usr_41.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Oct 13
|
||||
|
||||
VIM USER MANUAL - by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1581,7 +1581,7 @@ Here the comment part will be ignored. However, Vim will try to unmap
|
||||
|
||||
RESTORING THE VIEW
|
||||
|
||||
Sometimes you want to make a change and go back to where cursor was.
|
||||
Sometimes you want to make a change and go back to where the cursor was.
|
||||
Restoring the relative position would also be nice, so that the same line
|
||||
appears at the top of the window.
|
||||
This example yanks the current line, puts it above the first line in the
|
||||
@@ -1681,7 +1681,7 @@ in your plugin file!
|
||||
HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
You will probably add new corrections to the plugin and soon have several
|
||||
versions laying around. And when distributing this file, people will want to
|
||||
versions lying around. And when distributing this file, people will want to
|
||||
know who wrote this wonderful plugin and where they can send remarks.
|
||||
Therefore, put a header at the top of your plugin: >
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*various.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Jan 15
|
||||
*various.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Dec 05
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -353,74 +353,75 @@ N *+mouseshape* |'mouseshape'|
|
||||
B *+mouse_dec* Unix only: Dec terminal mouse handling |dec-mouse|
|
||||
N *+mouse_gpm* Unix only: Linux console mouse handling |gpm-mouse|
|
||||
B *+mouse_netterm* Unix only: netterm mouse handling |netterm-mouse|
|
||||
N *+mouse_pterm* QNX only: pterm mouse handling |qnx-terminal|
|
||||
N *+mouse_pterm* QNX only: pterm mouse handling |qnx-terminal|
|
||||
N *+mouse_sysmouse* Unix only: *BSD console mouse handling |sysmouse|
|
||||
N *+mouse_urxvt* Unix only: urxvt mouse handling |urxvt-mouse|
|
||||
N *+mouse_xterm* Unix only: xterm mouse handling |xterm-mouse|
|
||||
B *+multi_byte* 16 and 32 bit characters |multibyte|
|
||||
B *+mouse_sgr* Unix only: sgr mouse handling |sgr-mouse|
|
||||
B *+mouse_urxvt* Unix only: urxvt mouse handling |urxvt-mouse|
|
||||
N *+mouse_xterm* Unix only: xterm mouse handling |xterm-mouse|
|
||||
B *+multi_byte* 16 and 32 bit characters |multibyte|
|
||||
*+multi_byte_ime* Win32 input method for multibyte chars |multibyte-ime|
|
||||
N *+multi_lang* non-English language support |multi-lang|
|
||||
N *+multi_lang* non-English language support |multi-lang|
|
||||
m *+mzscheme* Mzscheme interface |mzscheme|
|
||||
m *+mzscheme/dyn* Mzscheme interface |mzscheme-dynamic| |/dyn|
|
||||
m *+netbeans_intg* |netbeans|
|
||||
m *+ole* Win32 GUI only: |ole-interface|
|
||||
N *+path_extra* Up/downwards search in 'path' and 'tags'
|
||||
m *+ole* Win32 GUI only: |ole-interface|
|
||||
N *+path_extra* Up/downwards search in 'path' and 'tags'
|
||||
m *+perl* Perl interface |perl|
|
||||
m *+perl/dyn* Perl interface |perl-dynamic| |/dyn|
|
||||
N *+persistent_undo* Persistent undo |undo-persistence|
|
||||
*+postscript* |:hardcopy| writes a PostScript file
|
||||
*+postscript* |:hardcopy| writes a PostScript file
|
||||
N *+printer* |:hardcopy| command
|
||||
H *+profile* |:profile| command
|
||||
m *+python* Python 2 interface |python|
|
||||
m *+python/dyn* Python 2 interface |python-dynamic| |/dyn|
|
||||
m *+python/dyn* Python 2 interface |python-dynamic| |/dyn|
|
||||
m *+python3* Python 3 interface |python|
|
||||
m *+python3/dyn* Python 3 interface |python-dynamic| |/dyn|
|
||||
m *+python3/dyn* Python 3 interface |python-dynamic| |/dyn|
|
||||
N *+quickfix* |:make| and |quickfix| commands
|
||||
N *+reltime* |reltime()| function, 'hlsearch'/'incsearch' timeout,
|
||||
'redrawtime' option
|
||||
B *+rightleft* Right to left typing |'rightleft'|
|
||||
m *+ruby* Ruby interface |ruby|
|
||||
m *+ruby/dyn* Ruby interface |ruby-dynamic| |/dyn|
|
||||
N *+scrollbind* |'scrollbind'|
|
||||
N *+scrollbind* |'scrollbind'|
|
||||
B *+signs* |:sign|
|
||||
N *+smartindent* |'smartindent'|
|
||||
N *+smartindent* |'smartindent'|
|
||||
m *+sniff* SniFF interface |sniff|
|
||||
N *+startuptime* |--startuptime| argument
|
||||
N *+statusline* Options 'statusline', 'rulerformat' and special
|
||||
N *+startuptime* |--startuptime| argument
|
||||
N *+statusline* Options 'statusline', 'rulerformat' and special
|
||||
formats of 'titlestring' and 'iconstring'
|
||||
m *+sun_workshop* |workshop|
|
||||
N *+syntax* Syntax highlighting |syntax|
|
||||
*+system()* Unix only: opposite of |+fork|
|
||||
N *+tag_binary* binary searching in tags file |tag-binary-search|
|
||||
N *+tag_binary* binary searching in tags file |tag-binary-search|
|
||||
N *+tag_old_static* old method for static tags |tag-old-static|
|
||||
m *+tag_any_white* any white space allowed in tags file |tag-any-white|
|
||||
m *+tcl* Tcl interface |tcl|
|
||||
m *+tcl* Tcl interface |tcl|
|
||||
m *+tcl/dyn* Tcl interface |tcl-dynamic| |/dyn|
|
||||
*+terminfo* uses |terminfo| instead of termcap
|
||||
N *+termresponse* support for |t_RV| and |v:termresponse|
|
||||
N *+textobjects* |text-objects| selection
|
||||
N *+textobjects* |text-objects| selection
|
||||
*+tgetent* non-Unix only: able to use external termcap
|
||||
N *+title* Setting the window 'title' and 'icon'
|
||||
N *+toolbar* |gui-toolbar|
|
||||
N *+user_commands* User-defined commands. |user-commands|
|
||||
N *+viminfo* |'viminfo'|
|
||||
N *+vertsplit* Vertically split windows |:vsplit|
|
||||
N *+virtualedit* |'virtualedit'|
|
||||
N *+virtualedit* |'virtualedit'|
|
||||
S *+visual* Visual mode |Visual-mode|
|
||||
N *+visualextra* extra Visual mode commands |blockwise-operators|
|
||||
N *+visualextra* extra Visual mode commands |blockwise-operators|
|
||||
N *+vreplace* |gR| and |gr|
|
||||
N *+wildignore* |'wildignore'|
|
||||
N *+wildignore* |'wildignore'|
|
||||
N *+wildmenu* |'wildmenu'|
|
||||
S *+windows* more than one window
|
||||
m *+writebackup* |'writebackup'| is default on
|
||||
m *+xim* X input method |xim|
|
||||
m *+writebackup* |'writebackup'| is default on
|
||||
m *+xim* X input method |xim|
|
||||
*+xfontset* X fontset support |xfontset|
|
||||
m *+xpm_w32* Win32 GUI only: pixmap support |:sign-define|
|
||||
m *+xpm_w32* Win32 GUI only: pixmap support |w32-xpm-support|
|
||||
*+xsmp* XSMP (X session management) support
|
||||
*+xsmp_interact* interactive XSMP (X session management) support
|
||||
N *+xterm_clipboard* Unix only: xterm clipboard handling
|
||||
m *+xterm_save* save and restore xterm screen |xterm-screens|
|
||||
N *+X11* Unix only: can restore window title |X11|
|
||||
m *+xterm_save* save and restore xterm screen |xterm-screens|
|
||||
N *+X11* Unix only: can restore window title |X11|
|
||||
|
||||
*/dyn* *E370* *E448*
|
||||
To some of the features "/dyn" is added when the
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*version5.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2008 Dec 17
|
||||
*version5.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 08
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -6,7 +6,7 @@
|
||||
Welcome to Vim Version 5.0!
|
||||
|
||||
This document lists the differences between Vim 4.x and Vim 5.0.
|
||||
Although 5.0 is mentioned here, this is also for version 5.1, 5.2, etc..
|
||||
Although 5.0 is mentioned here, this is also for version 5.1, 5.2, etc.
|
||||
See |vi_diff.txt| for an overview of differences between Vi and Vim 5.0.
|
||||
See |version4.txt| for differences between Vim 3.0 and Vim 4.0.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -3888,7 +3888,7 @@ character is typed. Helps to close a /* */ comment in C. (Webb)
|
||||
When expand() has a second argument which is non-zero, don't use 'suffixes'
|
||||
and 'wildignore', return all matches.
|
||||
|
||||
'O' flag in 'cpoptions: When not included, Vim will not overwrite a file, if
|
||||
'O' flag in 'cpoptions' When not included, Vim will not overwrite a file, if
|
||||
it didn't exist when editing started but it does exist when the buffer is
|
||||
written to the file. The file must have been created outside of Vim, possibly
|
||||
without the user knowing it. When this is detected after a shell command,
|
||||
@@ -4499,7 +4499,7 @@ Could not get all windows back when using a smaller terminal screen. Didn't
|
||||
restore all windows when "winsize" was not in 'sessionoptions'. (Webb)
|
||||
|
||||
Command line completion for ":buffer" depended on 'ignorecase' for Unix, but
|
||||
not for DOS et al.. Now don't use 'ignorecase', but let it depend on whether
|
||||
not for DOS et al. Now don't use 'ignorecase', but let it depend on whether
|
||||
file names are case sensitive or not (like when expanding file names).
|
||||
|
||||
Win32 GUI: (Negri)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -2452,7 +2452,7 @@ differently.
|
||||
|
||||
":n *.c" ":cd .." ":n" didn't use the original directory of the file. Vi only
|
||||
does it for the current file (looks like a bug). Now remember the buffer used
|
||||
for the entry in the argument list and use it's name (adjusted when doing
|
||||
for the entry in the argument list and use its name (adjusted when doing
|
||||
":cd"), unless it's deleted.
|
||||
|
||||
When inserting a special key as its name ("<F8>" as four characters) after
|
||||
@@ -3675,7 +3675,7 @@ When double clicking on the first character of a word while 'selection' is
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
Patch 6.0.001
|
||||
Problem: Loading the sh.vim syntax file causes error messages . (Corinna
|
||||
Problem: Loading the sh.vim syntax file causes error messages. (Corinna
|
||||
Vinschen)
|
||||
Solution: Add an "if". (Charles Campbell)
|
||||
Files: runtime/syntax/sh.vim
|
||||
@@ -9091,7 +9091,7 @@ Files: src/Make_w16.mak, src/testdir/Make_dos.mak
|
||||
Patch 6.1.402
|
||||
Problem: When evaluating a function name with curly braces, an error
|
||||
is not handled consistently.
|
||||
Solution: Accept the result of an curly braces expression when an
|
||||
Solution: Accept the result of a curly braces expression when an
|
||||
error was encountered. Skip evaluating an expression in curly
|
||||
braces when skipping. (Servatius Brandt)
|
||||
Files: src/eval.c
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*version7.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2010 Nov 03
|
||||
*version7.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 08
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -3587,7 +3587,7 @@ Files: src/eval.c, src/getchar.c, src/globals.h, src/main.c
|
||||
|
||||
Patch 7.0.085
|
||||
Problem: When doing "make test" the viminfo file is modified.
|
||||
Solution: Use another viminfo file after setting 'compatible.
|
||||
Solution: Use another viminfo file after setting 'compatible'.
|
||||
Files: src/testdir/test56.in
|
||||
|
||||
Patch 7.0.086
|
||||
@@ -7314,8 +7314,6 @@ Command line completion for :lmap and :lunmap.
|
||||
|
||||
Support syntax and filetype completion for user commands. (Christian Brabandt)
|
||||
|
||||
Add completion for ":ownsyntax" and improve completion for ":filetype".
|
||||
|
||||
Avoid use of the GTK main_loop() so that the GtkFileChooser can be used.
|
||||
(James Vega)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -9072,7 +9070,7 @@ Patch 7.2.280
|
||||
Problem: A redraw in a custom statusline with %! may cause a crash.
|
||||
(Yukihiro Nakadaira)
|
||||
Solution: Make a copy of 'statusline'. Also fix typo in function name
|
||||
redraw_custum_statusline. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
|
||||
redraw_custom_statusline. (partly by Dominique Pelle)
|
||||
Files: src/screen.c
|
||||
|
||||
Patch 7.2.281
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*vi_diff.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2011 Aug 29
|
||||
*vi_diff.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 08
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -192,7 +192,7 @@ Syntax highlighting. |:syntax|
|
||||
|
||||
Spell checking. |spell|
|
||||
When the 'spell' option is set Vim will highlight spelling mistakes.
|
||||
About 40 languages are currently supported, selected with the
|
||||
About 50 languages are currently supported, selected with the
|
||||
'spelllang' option. In source code only comments and strings are
|
||||
checked for spelling.
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -653,7 +653,7 @@ You can backspace, CTRL-U and CTRL-W over line breaks if the 'backspace' (bs)
|
||||
option includes "eol". You can backspace over the start of insert if the
|
||||
'backspace' option includes "start".
|
||||
|
||||
When the 'paste' option is set, a few option are reset and mapping in insert
|
||||
When the 'paste' option is set, a few options are reset and mapping in insert
|
||||
mode and abbreviation are disabled. This allows for pasting text in windowing
|
||||
systems without unexpected results. When the 'paste' option is reset, the old
|
||||
option values are restored.
|
||||
|
||||
478
runtime/doc/vim-de.1
Normal file
478
runtime/doc/vim-de.1
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,478 @@
|
||||
.\"*******************************************************************
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" This file was generated with po4a. Translate the source file.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\"*******************************************************************
|
||||
.\" Translated by bw1 (2008) and Florian Rehnisch <fm-r@gmx.de> (2012)
|
||||
.\" Kudos to the folks on vim-dev and debian-l10n-german
|
||||
.TH VIM 1 "2006 Apr 11"
|
||||
.SH BEZEICHNUNG
|
||||
vim \- Vi IMproved, ein Text\-Editor f<>r Programmierer
|
||||
.SH <EFBFBD>BERSICHT
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBvim\fP [Optionen] [Datei ...]
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBvim\fP [Optionen] \-
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBvim\fP [Optionen] \-t Tag
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBvim\fP [Optionen] \-q [Fehlerdatei]
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBex\fP
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBview\fP
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBgvim\fP \fBgview\fP \fBevim\fP \fBeview\fP
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBrvim\fP \fBrview\fP \fBrgvim\fP \fBrgview\fP
|
||||
.SH BESCHREIBUNG
|
||||
\fBVim\fP ist ein Text\-Editor, der aufw<66>rtskompatibel zu Vi ist. Er kann
|
||||
verwendet werden, um alle Arten von Klartext zu bearbeiten. Er ist besonders
|
||||
n<EFBFBD>tzlich, um Programme zu bearbeiten.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Vim hat einige Erweiterungen gegen<65>ber Vi, z.B.: R<>ckg<6B>ngigmachen in
|
||||
mehreren Schritten, mehrere Fenster und Puffer, Syntax\-Hervorhebung,
|
||||
Bearbeiten der Befehlszeile, Dateinamenerg<72>nzung, eingebaute Hilfe, visuelle
|
||||
Auswahl, usw. ... Siehe <20>:help vi_diff.txt<78> f<>r eine <20>bersicht der
|
||||
Unterschiede zwischen \fBVim\fP und Vi.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Im laufenden \fBVim\fP kann mit dem Befehl <20>:help<6C> viel Hilfe durch das
|
||||
eingebaute Hilfesystem erlangt werden. Siehe den Abschnitt EINGEBAUTE HILFE
|
||||
weiter unten.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Meistens wird \fBVim\fP zum Editieren einer einzigen Datei mit dem folgende
|
||||
Befehl gestartet:
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
vim Datei
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Allgemeiner betrachtet, wird \fBVim\fP folgenderma<6D>en gestartet:
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
vim [Optionen] [Dateiliste]
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Bei einer fehlenden Dateiliste startet der Editor mit einem leeren
|
||||
Puffer. Andernfalls werden nach den folgenden vier M<>glichkeiten eine oder
|
||||
mehrere Dateien bearbeitet:
|
||||
.TP 12
|
||||
Datei ...
|
||||
Eine Liste von Dateinamen. Die erste Datei wird in den Puffer geladen und
|
||||
zur aktuellen. Der Cursor wird auf der ersten Zeile des Puffers
|
||||
platziert. Zu den anderen Dateien kann mit dem Befehl <20>:next<78> gelangt
|
||||
werden. Falls einer der Dateinamen mit einem Bindestrich beginnt, stellen
|
||||
Sie der Dateiliste <20>\-\-<EFBFBD> voran.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-
|
||||
Die zu bearbeitende Datei wird von der Standardeingabe gelesen. Befehle
|
||||
werden von der Standardfehlerausgabe gelesen, die ein Text\-Terminal sein
|
||||
sollte.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-t {Tag}
|
||||
Die zu editierende Datei und die anf<6E>ngliche Cursor\-Position h<>ngen von
|
||||
einem <20>Tag<61> ab, einer Art Sprungmarke. {Tag} wird in der Tag\-Datei
|
||||
nachgeschlagen, die zugeh<65>rige Datei wird zur aktuellen und der zugeh<65>rige
|
||||
Befehl wird ausgef<65>hrt. Dies wird meistens f<>r Programme in der Sprache <20>C<EFBFBD>
|
||||
benutzt, wobei {Tag} ein Funktionsname sein k<>nnte. Die Wirkung dieses
|
||||
Befehls ist, dass die Datei, die die Funktion enth<74>lt, als aktuelle im
|
||||
Editor ge<67>ffnet und angezeigt wird und der Cursor auf dem Beginn der
|
||||
Funktion positioniert wird. Siehe <20>:help tag\-commands<EFBFBD>.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-q [Fehlerdatei]
|
||||
Startet im QuickFix\-Modus. Die Datei [Fehlerdatei] wird gelesen und der
|
||||
erste Fehler wird angezeigt. Falls [Fehlerdatei] ausgelassen wird, wird der
|
||||
Dateiname aus der Option 'errorfile' verwendet (bei AmigaOS ist dies
|
||||
vorgabem<EFBFBD><EFBFBD>ig <20>AztecC.Err<72>, sowie "errors.err<72> bei anderen). Weitere Fehler
|
||||
k<EFBFBD>nnen mit dem <20>:cn<63>\-Befehl angesprungen werden. Siehe ":help quickfix<69>.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
\fBVim\fP reagiert unterschiedlich auf den Namen, der verwendet wird, um Vim zu
|
||||
starten (die ausf<73>hrbare Datei kann dieselbe sein).
|
||||
.TP 10
|
||||
vim
|
||||
der <20>normale<6C> Weg, alles ist standardm<64><6D>ig
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
ex
|
||||
Startet im Ex\-Modus. Mit dem Befehl <20>:vi<76> gelangt man in den normalen
|
||||
Modus. Funktioniert auch mit dem Argument <20>\-e<EFBFBD>.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
view
|
||||
Startet im Nur\-Lesen\-Modus. Die Datei wird vor dem <20>berschreiben
|
||||
gesch<EFBFBD>tzt. Dasselbe wird mit dem Parameter <20>\-R<EFBFBD> erreicht.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
gvim gview
|
||||
Die grafische Version: <20>ffnet ein neues Fenster. Dasselbe wird mit dem
|
||||
Parameter <20>\-g<EFBFBD> erreicht.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
evim eview
|
||||
Die grafische Version im einfachen Modus: <20>ffnet ein neues Fenster. Dasselbe
|
||||
wird mit dem Parameter <20>\-y<EFBFBD> erreicht.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
rvim rview rgvim rgview
|
||||
Wie die obigen, aber mit Beschr<68>nkungen: Es ist nicht m<>glich, Shell\-Befehle
|
||||
aufzurufen oder mit Unterbrechung in eine Shell zur<75>ckzuspringen. Dasselbe
|
||||
wird mit dem Parameter <20>\-Z<EFBFBD> erreicht.
|
||||
.SH OPTIONEN
|
||||
Die Optionen k<>nnen in beliebiger Reihenfolge vor oder nach den Dateinamen
|
||||
angegeben werden. Optionen ohne Parameter k<>nnen hinter einem einzigen
|
||||
Bindestrich gruppiert werden.
|
||||
.TP 12
|
||||
+[Nummer]
|
||||
In der ersten Datei wird der Cursor auf die Zeile [Nummer] gesetzt. Falls
|
||||
[Nummer] nicht angegeben wird, wird der Cursor in die letzte Zeile der Datei
|
||||
gesetzt.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
+/{Suchmuster}
|
||||
In der ersten Datei wird der Cursor auf das erste Auftreten von {Suchmuster}
|
||||
gesetzt. Siehe <20>:help search\-pattern<EFBFBD>.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
+{Befehl}
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-c {Befehl}
|
||||
{Befehl} wird nach dem Lesen der ersten Datei ausgef<65>hrt. Als {Befehl} wird
|
||||
ein Ex\-Befehl erwartet. Sind in {Befehl} Leerzeichen vorhanden, muss alles
|
||||
in Anf<6E>hrungszeichen gesetzt werden (h<>ngt von der verwendeten Shell
|
||||
ab). Beispiel: vim "+set si" main.c
|
||||
.br
|
||||
Anmerkung: Sie k<>nnen bis zu 10 <20>+<2B>\- oder "\-c<EFBFBD>\-Befehle verwenden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-S {Datei}
|
||||
{Datei} wird nach dem Lesen der ersten Datei ausgef<65>hrt. Dies entspricht <20>\-c
|
||||
"source {Datei}"<22>. {Datei} darf nicht mit einem Bindestrich (\-)
|
||||
anfangen. Wenn kein Dateiname angegeben wird, wird <20>Session.vim<69> verwendet
|
||||
(Funktioniert nur, wenn <20>\-S<EFBFBD> als letzter Parameter steht).
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-cmd {Befehl}
|
||||
Wie <20>\-c<EFBFBD>, aber dieser Befehl wird vor allen VimRC\-Dateien ausgef<65>hrt. Sie
|
||||
k<EFBFBD>nnen unabh<62>ngig von den <20>\-c<EFBFBD>\-Befehlen bis zu 10 dieser Befehle verwenden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-A
|
||||
Falls \fBVim\fP mit Unterst<73>tzung f<>r das Schreiben von rechts nach links und
|
||||
arabischer Tastaturbelegung compiliert wurde (ARABIC), startet dieser
|
||||
Parameter den Modus f<>rs Arabische (:set arabic). Anderenfalls beendet sich
|
||||
\fBVim\fP mit einer Fehlermeldung.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
b
|
||||
Bin<EFBFBD>rer Modus: Es werden einige Variablen gesetzt, sodass es m<>glich ist,
|
||||
eine bin<69>re oder ausf<73>hrbare Datei zu bearbeiten.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-C
|
||||
Kompatibel: Setzt die Option 'compatible'. Das macht \fBVim\fP im Verhalten
|
||||
sehr <20>hnlich zu Vi, selbst wenn eine VimRC\-Datei existiert.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-d
|
||||
Startet im diff\-Modus. Es sollten zwei, drei oder vier Dateinamen als
|
||||
Parameter <20>bergeben werden. \fBVim\fP <20>ffnet sie alle und zeigt die
|
||||
Unterschiede an. Arbeitet wie vimdiff(1).
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-d {Ger<65>t}
|
||||
<EFBFBD>ffnet das {Ger<65>t}, um es als Terminal zu nutzen. Nur f<>r AmigaOS. Beispiel:
|
||||
"\-d con:20/30/600/150".
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
D
|
||||
Debug\-Modus: \fBVim\fP geht in den Debug\-Modus, wenn der erste Befehl in einem
|
||||
Skript ausgef<65>hrt wird.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-e
|
||||
Startet \fBVim\fP im Ex\-Modus, als w<>rde als ausf<73>hrbare Datei <20>ex<65> aufgerufen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-E
|
||||
Startet \fBVim\fP im erweiterten Ex\-Modus, als w<>rde die ausf<73>hrbare Datei als
|
||||
<EFBFBD>exim<EFBFBD> aufgerufen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-f
|
||||
Vordergrund: Bei der GUI\-Version erzeugt \fBVim\fP keinen neuen Prozess und
|
||||
l<EFBFBD>st sich nicht von der Shell, in der er aufgerufen wurde. Bei AmigaOS wird
|
||||
kein neues Fenster ge<67>ffnet. Dieser Parameter wird benutzt, damit das
|
||||
aufrufende Programm auf das Beenden des Bearbeitungssitzung wartet (z.B.:
|
||||
mail). Bei AmigaOS funktionieren die Befehle <20>:sh<73> und ":!<21> nicht.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-nofork
|
||||
Vordergrund: Bei der GUI\-Version erzeugt \fBVim\fP keinen neuen Prozess und
|
||||
l<EFBFBD>st sich nicht von der Shell, in der er aufgerufen wurde.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-F
|
||||
Wenn \fBVim\fP mit FKMAP\-Unterst<EFBFBD>tzung f<>r das Schreiben von rechts nach links
|
||||
und Farsi\-Tastatur\-Belegung kompiliert wurde, startet Vim im Farsi\-Modus,
|
||||
d.h. die Optionen 'fkmap' und 'rightleft' werden gesetzt. Andernfalls bricht
|
||||
\fBVim\fP mit einer Fehlermeldung ab.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-g
|
||||
Falls \fBVim\fP mit GUI\-Unterst<EFBFBD>tzung kompiliert wurde, wird die GUI
|
||||
aktiviert. Falls keine GUI\-Unterst<EFBFBD>tzung einkompiliert wurde, wird mit einer
|
||||
Fehlermeldung abgebrochen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-h
|
||||
Gibt eine kleine Hilfe f<>r die Befehlszeilenparameter aus. Danach beendet
|
||||
sich \fBVim.\fP
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-H
|
||||
Hebr<EFBFBD>isch\-Modus, falls \fBVim\fP mit RIGHTLEFT\-Unterst<EFBFBD>tzung f<>r das Schreiben
|
||||
von rechts nach links und hebr<62>ischer Tastaturbelegung kompiliert wurde,
|
||||
werden die Optionen 'hkmap' und 'rightleft' gesetzt. Andernfalls beendet
|
||||
sich \fBVim\fP mit einer Fehlermeldung.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-i {VimInfo}
|
||||
Wenn eine VimInfo\-Datei verwendet wird: Verwendet statt <20>~/.viminfo<66> die
|
||||
angegebene Datei. Es ist auch m<>glich die Verwendung einer VimInfo\-Datei
|
||||
durch Angabe des Dateinamen <20>NONE<4E> zu verhindern,
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-L
|
||||
dasselbe wie <20>\-r<EFBFBD>
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-l
|
||||
Lisp\-Modus. Aktiviert die Optionen 'lisp' und 'showmatch'.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-m
|
||||
Deaktiviert das Ver<65>ndern von Dateien, indem die Option 'write' gel<65>scht
|
||||
wird. Der Puffer kann ver<65>ndert werden, nur das Schreiben einer Datei ist
|
||||
nicht m<>glich.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-M
|
||||
Keine Ver<65>nderungen erlaubt: Die Optionen 'modifiable' und 'write' werden
|
||||
gel<EFBFBD>scht, so dass <20>nderungen nicht erlaubt sind und Dateien nicht
|
||||
geschrieben werden k<>nnen. Man beachte, dass diese Optionen ('modifiable',
|
||||
\&'write') dennnoch nachtr<74>glich zum Erlauben von <20>nderungen gesetzt werden
|
||||
k<EFBFBD>nnen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-N
|
||||
Nicht\-kompatibler Modus: L<>scht die Option 'compatible'. Dies veranlasst
|
||||
\fBVim\fP, sich ein wenig besser, aber weniger Vi\-kompatibel zu verhalten,
|
||||
selbst wenn es keine VimRC\-Datei gibt.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-n
|
||||
Verwendet keine Auslagerungsdatei: Eine Wiederherstellung nach einem Absturz
|
||||
ist nicht m<>glich. Auf einem langsamen Medium (Diskette) kann diese
|
||||
Einstellung n<>tzlich sein. Kann auch mit <20>set uc=0<> erreicht werden; kann
|
||||
mit <20>set uc=200<30> aufgehoben werden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-nb
|
||||
\fBVim\fP fungiert als Server f<>r NetBeans. Details siehe Dokumentation.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-o[N]
|
||||
<EFBFBD>ffnet [N] Fenster <20>bereinander. Wenn keine Zahl angegeben wird, <20>ffne ein
|
||||
Fenster pro Datei.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-O[N]
|
||||
<EFBFBD>ffnet [N] Fenster nebeneinander. Wenn keine Zahl angegeben wird, <20>ffne ein
|
||||
Fenster pro Datei.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-p[N]
|
||||
<EFBFBD>ffnet [N] Reiterseiten. Wenn keine Zahl angegeben wird, <20>ffne eine
|
||||
Reiterseite pro Datei.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-R
|
||||
Nur\-Lesen\-Modus: Die Option 'readonly' wird gesetzt. Der Puffer kann noch
|
||||
bearbeitet werden, aber es wird verhindert, eine Datei aus Versehen zu
|
||||
<EFBFBD>berschreiben. Wenn Sie wirklich eine Datei <20>berschreiben wollen, f<>gen Sie
|
||||
dem Ex\-Befehl ein Ausrufezeichen hinzu (wie in <20>:w!<21>). Die Option "\-R<EFBFBD>
|
||||
bedingt die Option <20>\-n<EFBFBD> (siehe oben). Die Option 'readonly' kann durch ":set
|
||||
noro<EFBFBD> gel<65>scht werden. Siehe <20>:help 'readonly'<27>.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-r
|
||||
Listet die Auslagerungsdateien und gibt Informationen zu ihrer
|
||||
Verwendbarkeit zur Wiederherstellung.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-r {Datei}
|
||||
Wiederherstellungsmodus: Die Auslagerungsdatei wird zur Wiederherstellung
|
||||
verwendet und hat denselben Dateinamen wie die Text\-Datei + <20>.swp<77>. Siehe
|
||||
":help recovery<72>.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-s
|
||||
Der stille Modus: Nur wenn die ausf<73>hrbare Datei als <20>ex<65> aufgerufen wird
|
||||
oder vor <20>\-s<EFBFBD> die Option "\-e<EFBFBD> gegeben wird.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-s {Eingabeskript}
|
||||
Die Datei {Eingabeskript} wird gelesen und ausgef<65>hrt, als w<>rden Sie die
|
||||
Zeichen in ihr tippen. Dasselbe kann mit dem Befehl <20>:source!
|
||||
{Eingabeskript}<7D> erreicht werden. Wird das Ende der Datei vor dem Beenden
|
||||
des Editors erreicht, werden weitere Zeichen von der Tastatur gelesen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-T {Terminal}
|
||||
Setzt den Namen des benutzten Terminals. Nur erforderlich, wenn die
|
||||
Automatik nicht funktioniert. Sollte ein \fBVim\fP bekanntes Terminal sein:
|
||||
(builtin) oder in einer termcap\- oder terminfo\-Datei definiert.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-u {VimRC}
|
||||
Verwendet zur Initialisierung die Befehle in der Datei {VimRC}. Alle anderen
|
||||
Initialisierungen werden <20>bersprungen. Benutzen Sie dies, um eine besondere
|
||||
Art von Dateien zu bearbeiten. Dies kann auch benutzt werden, um alle
|
||||
Initialisierungen zu <20>berspringen, indem der Name <20>NONE<4E> angegeben wird. F<>r
|
||||
weitere Einzelheiten siehe <20>:help initialisation<6F> innerhalb von Vim.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-U {GvimRC}
|
||||
Benutzt die Befehle in der Datei {GvimRC} f<>r die Initialisierung der
|
||||
grafischen Oberfl<66>che. Alle anderen Initialisierungen werden
|
||||
<EFBFBD>bersprungen. Dies kann ebenfalls benutzt werden, um alle
|
||||
GUI\-Initialisierungen zu <20>berspringen, indem der Name <20>NONE<4E> angegeben
|
||||
wird. Siehe <20>:help gui\-init<EFBFBD> innerhalb von Vim f<>r weitere Einzelheiten.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-V[N]
|
||||
Ausf<EFBFBD>hrlich (verbose): Gibt Meldungen dar<61>ber, welche Befehlsdateien
|
||||
eingelesen werden, und <20>ber das Lesen und Schreiben einer VimInfo\-Datei. Die
|
||||
optionale Zahl N ist der Wert f<>r 'verbose'. Vorgabe ist 10.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-v
|
||||
Startet \fBVim\fP im Vi\-Modus, so als w<>rde die ausf<73>hrbare Datei mit <20>vi<76>
|
||||
aufgerufen. Dies wirkt sich nur aus, wenn die ausf<73>hrbare Datei als <20>ex<65>
|
||||
aufgerufen wird.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-w {Ausgabeskript}
|
||||
Alle Zeichen, die eingetippt werden, werden in der Datei {Ausgabeskript}
|
||||
aufgezeichnet, solange bis Sie \fBVim\fP beenden. Dies ist n<>tzlich, falls Sie
|
||||
eine Skript\-Datei zum Benutzen mit <20>vim \-s<EFBFBD> oder ":source!<21> erzeugen
|
||||
wollen. Falls die Datei {Ausgabeskript} vorhanden ist, werden die Zeichen
|
||||
angeh<EFBFBD>ngt.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-W {Ausgabeskript}
|
||||
Wie \-w, aber eine bereits vorhandene Datei wird <20>berschrieben.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-x
|
||||
Benutzt beim Schreiben von Dateien eine Verschl<68>sselung. Fragt nach dem
|
||||
Schl<EFBFBD>ssel.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-X
|
||||
F<EFBFBD>hrt keine Verbindung zum X\-Server durch. Dadurch verk<72>rzt sich die
|
||||
Startzeit, aber der Fenstertitel und die Zwischenablage werden nicht
|
||||
verwendet.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-y
|
||||
Startet \fBVim\fP im einfachen Modus, als w<>rde die ausf<73>hrbare Datei mit
|
||||
<EFBFBD>evim<EFBFBD> oder <20>eview<65> aufgerufen. \fBVim\fP verh<72>lt sich dann wie ein Editor zum
|
||||
Klicken und Tippen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-Z
|
||||
Eingeschr<EFBFBD>nkter Modus: Funktioniert, als w<>rde der Name der ausf<73>hrbaren
|
||||
Datei mit <20>r<EFBFBD> beginnen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-
|
||||
Markiert das Ende der Optionen. Argumente, die folgen, werden als Dateinamen
|
||||
behandelt. Dies kann benutzt werden, um einen Dateinamen mit <20>\-<EFBFBD> am Anfang
|
||||
zu verwenden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-echo\-wid
|
||||
Nur GTK\-GUI: Schreibe die Fenster\-ID auf die Standardausgabe.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-help
|
||||
Gibt eine Hilfe\-Nachricht aus und beendet, wie <20>\-h<EFBFBD>.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-literal
|
||||
Nimmt die Dateinamen so wie sie sind und vervollst<73>ndigt sie nicht nach
|
||||
Metazeichen (*,?). Dies wirkt sich nicht unter Unix aus, wo die Shell die
|
||||
Metazeichen expandiert.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-noplugin
|
||||
Lade keine Plugins. Impliziert durch <20>\-u NONE<4E>.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote
|
||||
Verbindet mit einem Vim\-Server und l<>sst ihn die in den restlichen
|
||||
Argumenten angegeben Dateien editieren. Wenn kein Server gefunden wird,
|
||||
f<EFBFBD>hrt dies zu einer Warnmeldung und die Dateien werden im gegenw<6E>rtigen Vim
|
||||
zum Bearbeiten ge<67>ffnet.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote\-expr {Ausdruck}
|
||||
Verbindet mit einem Vim\-Server, f<>hrt {Ausdruck} aus und zeigt das Ergebnis
|
||||
auf der Standardausgabe an.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote\-send {Zeichen}
|
||||
Verbindet mit einem Vim\-Server und sendet ihm {Zeichen}.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote\-silent
|
||||
Wie <20>\-\-remote<EFBFBD>, aber ohne Warnung, wenn kein Server gefunden wird.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote\-wait
|
||||
Wie <20>\-\-remote<EFBFBD>, aber Vim beendet sich nicht, bis die Dateien bearbeitet
|
||||
wurden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote\-wait\-silent
|
||||
Wie <20>\-\-remote\-wait<EFBFBD>, aber ohne Warnung, wenn kein Server gefunden wird.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-serverlist
|
||||
Listet die Namen aller gefundenen Vim\-Server auf.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-servername {Name}
|
||||
Benutzt {Name} als Server\-Namen. Wird f<>r den gegenw<6E>rtigen Vim benutzt,
|
||||
au<EFBFBD>er es wird mit dem Argument <20>\-\-remote<EFBFBD> benutzt, dann ist es der Name des
|
||||
zu kontaktierenden Servers.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-socketid {id}
|
||||
Nur GTK\-GUI: Benutzt den GtkPlug\-Mechanismus, um GVim in einem anderen
|
||||
Fenster laufen zu lassen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-version
|
||||
Versionsinformation anzeigen und beenden
|
||||
.SH "EINGEBAUTE HILFE"
|
||||
Tippen Sie in \fBVim\fP <20>:help<6C>, um zu beginnen. Geben Sie ":help begriff<66> ein,
|
||||
um Hilfe <20>ber ein bestimmtes Thema zu bekommen. Zum Beispiel <20>:help ZZ<5A> f<>r
|
||||
Hilfe <20>ber den Befehl <20>ZZ<5A>. Benutzen Sie <Tab> und CTRL\-D, um
|
||||
Begriffe zu vervollst<73>ndigen (<28>:help cmdline\-completion<EFBFBD>). Tags sind
|
||||
vorhanden, um von einem Ort zum anderen zu springen (eine Art
|
||||
Hypertext\-Verkn<EFBFBD>pfungen, siehe <20>:help<6C>). Auf diese Weise k<>nnen alle
|
||||
Dokumentations\-Dateien aufgerufen werden, zum Beispiel <20>:help syntax.txt<78>.
|
||||
.SH DATEIEN
|
||||
.TP 15
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/doc/*.txt
|
||||
Dokumentations\-Dateien f<>r \fBVim\fP. Verwenden Sie <20>:help doc\-file\-list<EFBFBD>, um
|
||||
die gesamte Liste zu bekommen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/doc/tags
|
||||
Die <20>Tag<61>\-Datei, die verwendet wird, um Informationen in der Dokumentation
|
||||
zu finden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/syntax/syntax.vim
|
||||
Die systemweite Einrichtung der Syntaxhervorhebung.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/syntax/*.vim
|
||||
Syntaxdateien f<>r die verschiedenen Sprachen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/vimrc
|
||||
Systemweite Einstellungsdatei f<>r \fBVim\fP
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
~/.vimrc
|
||||
Pers<EFBFBD>nliche Einstellungsdatei f<>r \fBVim\fP
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/gvimrc
|
||||
Systemweite Einstellungsdatei f<>r GVim
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
~/.gvimrc
|
||||
Pers<EFBFBD>nliche Einstellungsdatei f<>r GVim
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/optwin.vim
|
||||
Das Script, das von dem Befehl <20>:options<6E> verwendet wird, eine sch<63>ne
|
||||
M<EFBFBD>glichkeit, um Optionen zu betrachten und zu setzen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/menu.vim
|
||||
Systemweite Einstellungsdatei f<>r das Men<65> von GVim
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/bugreport.vim
|
||||
Das Script zum Generieren eines Fehlerberichts. Siehe <20>:help bugs<67>.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/filetype.vim
|
||||
Mit diesem Script erkennt Vim den Typ einer Datei anhand ihres
|
||||
Dateinamens. Siehe <20>:help 'filetype'<27>.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/scripts.vim
|
||||
Mit diesem Script erkennt Vim den Typ einer Datei anhand ihres
|
||||
Inhaltes. Siehe <20>:help 'filetype'<27>.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/print/*.ps
|
||||
Diese Dateien werden zum Drucken von PostScript verwendet.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
F<EFBFBD>r die neuesten Informationen lesen Sie die Vim\-Homepage:
|
||||
.br
|
||||
<URL:http://www.vim.org/>
|
||||
.SH "SIEHE AUCH"
|
||||
vimtutor(1)
|
||||
.SH AUTOR
|
||||
\fBVim\fP wurde gr<67><72>tenteils von Bram Moolenaar erstellt, mit viel Hilfe von
|
||||
anderen Leuten. Siehe <20>:help credits<74> in \fBVim.\fP
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBVim\fP basiert auf Stevie, der von Tim Thompson, Tony Andrews und
|
||||
G.R. (Fred) Walter geschrieben wurde. Es ist jedoch kaum etwas vom
|
||||
urspr<EFBFBD>nglichen Code <20>brig geblieben.
|
||||
.SH FEHLER
|
||||
Die sind m<>glich. Siehe <20>:help todo<64> f<>r eine Liste bekannter Probleme.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Beachten Sie, dass gewisse Dinge, die manche Leute als Fehler betrachten
|
||||
m<EFBFBD>gen, in Wirklichkeit durch zu getreue Nachbildung des Vi\-Verhaltens
|
||||
verursacht werden. Und falls Sie denken, dass andere Dinge Fehler sind,
|
||||
<EFBFBD>weil Vi es anders tut<75>, sollten Sie einen genaueren Blick auf die Datei
|
||||
vi_diff.txt werfen (oder in Vim <20>:help vi_diff.txt<78> tippen). Sehen Sie sich
|
||||
auch die Optionen 'compatible' und 'cpoptions' an.
|
||||
478
runtime/doc/vim-de.UTF-8.1
Normal file
478
runtime/doc/vim-de.UTF-8.1
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,478 @@
|
||||
.\"*******************************************************************
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\" This file was generated with po4a. Translate the source file.
|
||||
.\"
|
||||
.\"*******************************************************************
|
||||
.\" Translated by bw1 (2008) and Florian Rehnisch <fm-r@gmx.de> (2012)
|
||||
.\" Kudos to the folks on vim-dev and debian-l10n-german
|
||||
.TH VIM 1 "2006 Apr 11"
|
||||
.SH BEZEICHNUNG
|
||||
vim \- Vi IMproved, ein Text\-Editor für Programmierer
|
||||
.SH ÜBERSICHT
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBvim\fP [Optionen] [Datei …]
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBvim\fP [Optionen] \-
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBvim\fP [Optionen] \-t Tag
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBvim\fP [Optionen] \-q [Fehlerdatei]
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBex\fP
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBview\fP
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBgvim\fP \fBgview\fP \fBevim\fP \fBeview\fP
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBrvim\fP \fBrview\fP \fBrgvim\fP \fBrgview\fP
|
||||
.SH BESCHREIBUNG
|
||||
\fBVim\fP ist ein Text\-Editor, der aufwärtskompatibel zu Vi ist. Er kann
|
||||
verwendet werden, um alle Arten von Klartext zu bearbeiten. Er ist besonders
|
||||
nützlich, um Programme zu bearbeiten.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Vim hat einige Erweiterungen gegenüber Vi, z.B.: Rückgängigmachen in
|
||||
mehreren Schritten, mehrere Fenster und Puffer, Syntax\-Hervorhebung,
|
||||
Bearbeiten der Befehlszeile, Dateinamenergänzung, eingebaute Hilfe, visuelle
|
||||
Auswahl, usw. … Siehe »:help vi_diff.txt« für eine Übersicht der
|
||||
Unterschiede zwischen \fBVim\fP und Vi.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Im laufenden \fBVim\fP kann mit dem Befehl »:help« viel Hilfe durch das
|
||||
eingebaute Hilfesystem erlangt werden. Siehe den Abschnitt EINGEBAUTE HILFE
|
||||
weiter unten.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Meistens wird \fBVim\fP zum Editieren einer einzigen Datei mit dem folgende
|
||||
Befehl gestartet:
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
vim Datei
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Allgemeiner betrachtet, wird \fBVim\fP folgendermaßen gestartet:
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
vim [Optionen] [Dateiliste]
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Bei einer fehlenden Dateiliste startet der Editor mit einem leeren
|
||||
Puffer. Andernfalls werden nach den folgenden vier Möglichkeiten eine oder
|
||||
mehrere Dateien bearbeitet:
|
||||
.TP 12
|
||||
Datei …
|
||||
Eine Liste von Dateinamen. Die erste Datei wird in den Puffer geladen und
|
||||
zur aktuellen. Der Cursor wird auf der ersten Zeile des Puffers
|
||||
platziert. Zu den anderen Dateien kann mit dem Befehl »:next« gelangt
|
||||
werden. Falls einer der Dateinamen mit einem Bindestrich beginnt, stellen
|
||||
Sie der Dateiliste »\-\-« voran.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-
|
||||
Die zu bearbeitende Datei wird von der Standardeingabe gelesen. Befehle
|
||||
werden von der Standardfehlerausgabe gelesen, die ein Text\-Terminal sein
|
||||
sollte.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-t {Tag}
|
||||
Die zu editierende Datei und die anfängliche Cursor\-Position hängen von
|
||||
einem »Tag« ab, einer Art Sprungmarke. {Tag} wird in der Tag\-Datei
|
||||
nachgeschlagen, die zugehörige Datei wird zur aktuellen und der zugehörige
|
||||
Befehl wird ausgeführt. Dies wird meistens für Programme in der Sprache »C«
|
||||
benutzt, wobei {Tag} ein Funktionsname sein könnte. Die Wirkung dieses
|
||||
Befehls ist, dass die Datei, die die Funktion enthält, als aktuelle im
|
||||
Editor geöffnet und angezeigt wird und der Cursor auf dem Beginn der
|
||||
Funktion positioniert wird. Siehe »:help tag\-commands«.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-q [Fehlerdatei]
|
||||
Startet im QuickFix\-Modus. Die Datei [Fehlerdatei] wird gelesen und der
|
||||
erste Fehler wird angezeigt. Falls [Fehlerdatei] ausgelassen wird, wird der
|
||||
Dateiname aus der Option 'errorfile' verwendet (bei AmigaOS ist dies
|
||||
vorgabemäßig »AztecC.Err«, sowie „errors.err« bei anderen). Weitere Fehler
|
||||
können mit dem »:cn«\-Befehl angesprungen werden. Siehe „:help quickfix«.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
\fBVim\fP reagiert unterschiedlich auf den Namen, der verwendet wird, um Vim zu
|
||||
starten (die ausführbare Datei kann dieselbe sein).
|
||||
.TP 10
|
||||
vim
|
||||
der »normale« Weg, alles ist standardmäßig
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
ex
|
||||
Startet im Ex\-Modus. Mit dem Befehl »:vi« gelangt man in den normalen
|
||||
Modus. Funktioniert auch mit dem Argument »\-e«.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
view
|
||||
Startet im Nur\-Lesen\-Modus. Die Datei wird vor dem Überschreiben
|
||||
geschützt. Dasselbe wird mit dem Parameter »\-R« erreicht.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
gvim gview
|
||||
Die grafische Version: Öffnet ein neues Fenster. Dasselbe wird mit dem
|
||||
Parameter »\-g« erreicht.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
evim eview
|
||||
Die grafische Version im einfachen Modus: Öffnet ein neues Fenster. Dasselbe
|
||||
wird mit dem Parameter »\-y« erreicht.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
rvim rview rgvim rgview
|
||||
Wie die obigen, aber mit Beschränkungen: Es ist nicht möglich, Shell\-Befehle
|
||||
aufzurufen oder mit Unterbrechung in eine Shell zurückzuspringen. Dasselbe
|
||||
wird mit dem Parameter »\-Z« erreicht.
|
||||
.SH OPTIONEN
|
||||
Die Optionen können in beliebiger Reihenfolge vor oder nach den Dateinamen
|
||||
angegeben werden. Optionen ohne Parameter können hinter einem einzigen
|
||||
Bindestrich gruppiert werden.
|
||||
.TP 12
|
||||
+[Nummer]
|
||||
In der ersten Datei wird der Cursor auf die Zeile [Nummer] gesetzt. Falls
|
||||
[Nummer] nicht angegeben wird, wird der Cursor in die letzte Zeile der Datei
|
||||
gesetzt.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
+/{Suchmuster}
|
||||
In der ersten Datei wird der Cursor auf das erste Auftreten von {Suchmuster}
|
||||
gesetzt. Siehe »:help search\-pattern«.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
+{Befehl}
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-c {Befehl}
|
||||
{Befehl} wird nach dem Lesen der ersten Datei ausgeführt. Als {Befehl} wird
|
||||
ein Ex\-Befehl erwartet. Sind in {Befehl} Leerzeichen vorhanden, muss alles
|
||||
in Anführungszeichen gesetzt werden (hängt von der verwendeten Shell
|
||||
ab). Beispiel: vim "+set si" main.c
|
||||
.br
|
||||
Anmerkung: Sie können bis zu 10 »+«\- oder „\-c«\-Befehle verwenden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-S {Datei}
|
||||
{Datei} wird nach dem Lesen der ersten Datei ausgeführt. Dies entspricht »\-c
|
||||
"source {Datei}"«. {Datei} darf nicht mit einem Bindestrich (\-)
|
||||
anfangen. Wenn kein Dateiname angegeben wird, wird »Session.vim« verwendet
|
||||
(Funktioniert nur, wenn »\-S« als letzter Parameter steht).
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-cmd {Befehl}
|
||||
Wie »\-c«, aber dieser Befehl wird vor allen VimRC\-Dateien ausgeführt. Sie
|
||||
können unabhängig von den »\-c«\-Befehlen bis zu 10 dieser Befehle verwenden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-A
|
||||
Falls \fBVim\fP mit Unterstützung für das Schreiben von rechts nach links und
|
||||
arabischer Tastaturbelegung compiliert wurde (ARABIC), startet dieser
|
||||
Parameter den Modus fürs Arabische (:set arabic). Anderenfalls beendet sich
|
||||
\fBVim\fP mit einer Fehlermeldung.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
b
|
||||
Binärer Modus: Es werden einige Variablen gesetzt, sodass es möglich ist,
|
||||
eine binäre oder ausführbare Datei zu bearbeiten.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-C
|
||||
Kompatibel: Setzt die Option 'compatible'. Das macht \fBVim\fP im Verhalten
|
||||
sehr ähnlich zu Vi, selbst wenn eine VimRC\-Datei existiert.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-d
|
||||
Startet im diff\-Modus. Es sollten zwei, drei oder vier Dateinamen als
|
||||
Parameter übergeben werden. \fBVim\fP öffnet sie alle und zeigt die
|
||||
Unterschiede an. Arbeitet wie vimdiff(1).
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-d {Gerät}
|
||||
Öffnet das {Gerät}, um es als Terminal zu nutzen. Nur für AmigaOS. Beispiel:
|
||||
"\-d con:20/30/600/150".
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
D
|
||||
Debug\-Modus: \fBVim\fP geht in den Debug\-Modus, wenn der erste Befehl in einem
|
||||
Skript ausgeführt wird.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-e
|
||||
Startet \fBVim\fP im Ex\-Modus, als würde als ausführbare Datei »ex« aufgerufen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-E
|
||||
Startet \fBVim\fP im erweiterten Ex\-Modus, als würde die ausführbare Datei als
|
||||
»exim« aufgerufen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-f
|
||||
Vordergrund: Bei der GUI\-Version erzeugt \fBVim\fP keinen neuen Prozess und
|
||||
löst sich nicht von der Shell, in der er aufgerufen wurde. Bei AmigaOS wird
|
||||
kein neues Fenster geöffnet. Dieser Parameter wird benutzt, damit das
|
||||
aufrufende Programm auf das Beenden des Bearbeitungssitzung wartet (z.B.:
|
||||
mail). Bei AmigaOS funktionieren die Befehle »:sh« und „:!« nicht.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-nofork
|
||||
Vordergrund: Bei der GUI\-Version erzeugt \fBVim\fP keinen neuen Prozess und
|
||||
löst sich nicht von der Shell, in der er aufgerufen wurde.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-F
|
||||
Wenn \fBVim\fP mit FKMAP\-Unterstützung für das Schreiben von rechts nach links
|
||||
und Farsi\-Tastatur\-Belegung kompiliert wurde, startet Vim im Farsi\-Modus,
|
||||
d.h. die Optionen 'fkmap' und 'rightleft' werden gesetzt. Andernfalls bricht
|
||||
\fBVim\fP mit einer Fehlermeldung ab.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-g
|
||||
Falls \fBVim\fP mit GUI\-Unterstützung kompiliert wurde, wird die GUI
|
||||
aktiviert. Falls keine GUI\-Unterstützung einkompiliert wurde, wird mit einer
|
||||
Fehlermeldung abgebrochen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-h
|
||||
Gibt eine kleine Hilfe für die Befehlszeilenparameter aus. Danach beendet
|
||||
sich \fBVim.\fP
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-H
|
||||
Hebräisch\-Modus, falls \fBVim\fP mit RIGHTLEFT\-Unterstützung für das Schreiben
|
||||
von rechts nach links und hebräischer Tastaturbelegung kompiliert wurde,
|
||||
werden die Optionen 'hkmap' und 'rightleft' gesetzt. Andernfalls beendet
|
||||
sich \fBVim\fP mit einer Fehlermeldung.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-i {VimInfo}
|
||||
Wenn eine VimInfo\-Datei verwendet wird: Verwendet statt »~/.viminfo« die
|
||||
angegebene Datei. Es ist auch möglich die Verwendung einer VimInfo\-Datei
|
||||
durch Angabe des Dateinamen »NONE« zu verhindern,
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-L
|
||||
dasselbe wie »\-r«
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-l
|
||||
Lisp\-Modus. Aktiviert die Optionen 'lisp' und 'showmatch'.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-m
|
||||
Deaktiviert das Verändern von Dateien, indem die Option 'write' gelöscht
|
||||
wird. Der Puffer kann verändert werden, nur das Schreiben einer Datei ist
|
||||
nicht möglich.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-M
|
||||
Keine Veränderungen erlaubt: Die Optionen 'modifiable' und 'write' werden
|
||||
gelöscht, so dass Änderungen nicht erlaubt sind und Dateien nicht
|
||||
geschrieben werden können. Man beachte, dass diese Optionen ('modifiable',
|
||||
\&'write') dennnoch nachträglich zum Erlauben von Änderungen gesetzt werden
|
||||
können.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-N
|
||||
Nicht\-kompatibler Modus: Löscht die Option 'compatible'. Dies veranlasst
|
||||
\fBVim\fP, sich ein wenig besser, aber weniger Vi\-kompatibel zu verhalten,
|
||||
selbst wenn es keine VimRC\-Datei gibt.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-n
|
||||
Verwendet keine Auslagerungsdatei: Eine Wiederherstellung nach einem Absturz
|
||||
ist nicht möglich. Auf einem langsamen Medium (Diskette) kann diese
|
||||
Einstellung nützlich sein. Kann auch mit »set uc=0« erreicht werden; kann
|
||||
mit »set uc=200« aufgehoben werden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-nb
|
||||
\fBVim\fP fungiert als Server für NetBeans. Details siehe Dokumentation.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-o[N]
|
||||
Öffnet [N] Fenster übereinander. Wenn keine Zahl angegeben wird, öffne ein
|
||||
Fenster pro Datei.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-O[N]
|
||||
Öffnet [N] Fenster nebeneinander. Wenn keine Zahl angegeben wird, öffne ein
|
||||
Fenster pro Datei.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-p[N]
|
||||
Öffnet [N] Reiterseiten. Wenn keine Zahl angegeben wird, öffne eine
|
||||
Reiterseite pro Datei.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-R
|
||||
Nur\-Lesen\-Modus: Die Option 'readonly' wird gesetzt. Der Puffer kann noch
|
||||
bearbeitet werden, aber es wird verhindert, eine Datei aus Versehen zu
|
||||
überschreiben. Wenn Sie wirklich eine Datei überschreiben wollen, fügen Sie
|
||||
dem Ex\-Befehl ein Ausrufezeichen hinzu (wie in »:w!«). Die Option „\-R«
|
||||
bedingt die Option »\-n« (siehe oben). Die Option 'readonly' kann durch „:set
|
||||
noro« gelöscht werden. Siehe »:help 'readonly'«.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-r
|
||||
Listet die Auslagerungsdateien und gibt Informationen zu ihrer
|
||||
Verwendbarkeit zur Wiederherstellung.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-r {Datei}
|
||||
Wiederherstellungsmodus: Die Auslagerungsdatei wird zur Wiederherstellung
|
||||
verwendet und hat denselben Dateinamen wie die Text\-Datei + ».swp«. Siehe
|
||||
„:help recovery«.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-s
|
||||
Der stille Modus: Nur wenn die ausführbare Datei als »ex« aufgerufen wird
|
||||
oder vor »\-s« die Option „\-e« gegeben wird.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-s {Eingabeskript}
|
||||
Die Datei {Eingabeskript} wird gelesen und ausgeführt, als würden Sie die
|
||||
Zeichen in ihr tippen. Dasselbe kann mit dem Befehl »:source!
|
||||
{Eingabeskript}« erreicht werden. Wird das Ende der Datei vor dem Beenden
|
||||
des Editors erreicht, werden weitere Zeichen von der Tastatur gelesen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-T {Terminal}
|
||||
Setzt den Namen des benutzten Terminals. Nur erforderlich, wenn die
|
||||
Automatik nicht funktioniert. Sollte ein \fBVim\fP bekanntes Terminal sein:
|
||||
(builtin) oder in einer termcap\- oder terminfo\-Datei definiert.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-u {VimRC}
|
||||
Verwendet zur Initialisierung die Befehle in der Datei {VimRC}. Alle anderen
|
||||
Initialisierungen werden übersprungen. Benutzen Sie dies, um eine besondere
|
||||
Art von Dateien zu bearbeiten. Dies kann auch benutzt werden, um alle
|
||||
Initialisierungen zu überspringen, indem der Name »NONE« angegeben wird. Für
|
||||
weitere Einzelheiten siehe »:help initialisation« innerhalb von Vim.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-U {GvimRC}
|
||||
Benutzt die Befehle in der Datei {GvimRC} für die Initialisierung der
|
||||
grafischen Oberfläche. Alle anderen Initialisierungen werden
|
||||
übersprungen. Dies kann ebenfalls benutzt werden, um alle
|
||||
GUI\-Initialisierungen zu überspringen, indem der Name »NONE« angegeben
|
||||
wird. Siehe »:help gui\-init« innerhalb von Vim für weitere Einzelheiten.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-V[N]
|
||||
Ausführlich (verbose): Gibt Meldungen darüber, welche Befehlsdateien
|
||||
eingelesen werden, und über das Lesen und Schreiben einer VimInfo\-Datei. Die
|
||||
optionale Zahl N ist der Wert für 'verbose'. Vorgabe ist 10.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-v
|
||||
Startet \fBVim\fP im Vi\-Modus, so als würde die ausführbare Datei mit »vi«
|
||||
aufgerufen. Dies wirkt sich nur aus, wenn die ausführbare Datei als »ex«
|
||||
aufgerufen wird.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-w {Ausgabeskript}
|
||||
Alle Zeichen, die eingetippt werden, werden in der Datei {Ausgabeskript}
|
||||
aufgezeichnet, solange bis Sie \fBVim\fP beenden. Dies ist nützlich, falls Sie
|
||||
eine Skript\-Datei zum Benutzen mit »vim \-s« oder „:source!« erzeugen
|
||||
wollen. Falls die Datei {Ausgabeskript} vorhanden ist, werden die Zeichen
|
||||
angehängt.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-W {Ausgabeskript}
|
||||
Wie \-w, aber eine bereits vorhandene Datei wird überschrieben.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-x
|
||||
Benutzt beim Schreiben von Dateien eine Verschlüsselung. Fragt nach dem
|
||||
Schlüssel.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-X
|
||||
Führt keine Verbindung zum X\-Server durch. Dadurch verkürzt sich die
|
||||
Startzeit, aber der Fenstertitel und die Zwischenablage werden nicht
|
||||
verwendet.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-y
|
||||
Startet \fBVim\fP im einfachen Modus, als würde die ausführbare Datei mit
|
||||
»evim« oder »eview« aufgerufen. \fBVim\fP verhält sich dann wie ein Editor zum
|
||||
Klicken und Tippen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-Z
|
||||
Eingeschränkter Modus: Funktioniert, als würde der Name der ausführbaren
|
||||
Datei mit »r« beginnen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-
|
||||
Markiert das Ende der Optionen. Argumente, die folgen, werden als Dateinamen
|
||||
behandelt. Dies kann benutzt werden, um einen Dateinamen mit »\-« am Anfang
|
||||
zu verwenden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-echo\-wid
|
||||
Nur GTK\-GUI: Schreibe die Fenster\-ID auf die Standardausgabe.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-help
|
||||
Gibt eine Hilfe\-Nachricht aus und beendet, wie »\-h«.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-literal
|
||||
Nimmt die Dateinamen so wie sie sind und vervollständigt sie nicht nach
|
||||
Metazeichen (*,?). Dies wirkt sich nicht unter Unix aus, wo die Shell die
|
||||
Metazeichen expandiert.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-noplugin
|
||||
Lade keine Plugins. Impliziert durch »\-u NONE«.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote
|
||||
Verbindet mit einem Vim\-Server und lässt ihn die in den restlichen
|
||||
Argumenten angegeben Dateien editieren. Wenn kein Server gefunden wird,
|
||||
führt dies zu einer Warnmeldung und die Dateien werden im gegenwärtigen Vim
|
||||
zum Bearbeiten geöffnet.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote\-expr {Ausdruck}
|
||||
Verbindet mit einem Vim\-Server, führt {Ausdruck} aus und zeigt das Ergebnis
|
||||
auf der Standardausgabe an.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote\-send {Zeichen}
|
||||
Verbindet mit einem Vim\-Server und sendet ihm {Zeichen}.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote\-silent
|
||||
Wie »\-\-remote«, aber ohne Warnung, wenn kein Server gefunden wird.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote\-wait
|
||||
Wie »\-\-remote«, aber Vim beendet sich nicht, bis die Dateien bearbeitet
|
||||
wurden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-remote\-wait\-silent
|
||||
Wie »\-\-remote\-wait«, aber ohne Warnung, wenn kein Server gefunden wird.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-serverlist
|
||||
Listet die Namen aller gefundenen Vim\-Server auf.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-servername {Name}
|
||||
Benutzt {Name} als Server\-Namen. Wird für den gegenwärtigen Vim benutzt,
|
||||
außer es wird mit dem Argument »\-\-remote« benutzt, dann ist es der Name des
|
||||
zu kontaktierenden Servers.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-socketid {id}
|
||||
Nur GTK\-GUI: Benutzt den GtkPlug\-Mechanismus, um GVim in einem anderen
|
||||
Fenster laufen zu lassen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
\-\-version
|
||||
Versionsinformation anzeigen und beenden
|
||||
.SH "EINGEBAUTE HILFE"
|
||||
Tippen Sie in \fBVim\fP »:help«, um zu beginnen. Geben Sie „:help begriff« ein,
|
||||
um Hilfe über ein bestimmtes Thema zu bekommen. Zum Beispiel »:help ZZ« für
|
||||
Hilfe über den Befehl »ZZ«. Benutzen Sie <Tab> und CTRL\-D, um
|
||||
Begriffe zu vervollständigen (»:help cmdline\-completion«). Tags sind
|
||||
vorhanden, um von einem Ort zum anderen zu springen (eine Art
|
||||
Hypertext\-Verknüpfungen, siehe »:help«). Auf diese Weise können alle
|
||||
Dokumentations\-Dateien aufgerufen werden, zum Beispiel »:help syntax.txt«.
|
||||
.SH DATEIEN
|
||||
.TP 15
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/doc/*.txt
|
||||
Dokumentations\-Dateien für \fBVim\fP. Verwenden Sie »:help doc\-file\-list«, um
|
||||
die gesamte Liste zu bekommen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/doc/tags
|
||||
Die »Tag«\-Datei, die verwendet wird, um Informationen in der Dokumentation
|
||||
zu finden.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/syntax/syntax.vim
|
||||
Die systemweite Einrichtung der Syntaxhervorhebung.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/syntax/*.vim
|
||||
Syntaxdateien für die verschiedenen Sprachen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/vimrc
|
||||
Systemweite Einstellungsdatei für \fBVim\fP
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
~/.vimrc
|
||||
Persönliche Einstellungsdatei für \fBVim\fP
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/gvimrc
|
||||
Systemweite Einstellungsdatei für GVim
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
~/.gvimrc
|
||||
Persönliche Einstellungsdatei für GVim
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/optwin.vim
|
||||
Das Script, das von dem Befehl »:options« verwendet wird, eine schöne
|
||||
Möglichkeit, um Optionen zu betrachten und zu setzen.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/menu.vim
|
||||
Systemweite Einstellungsdatei für das Menü von GVim
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/bugreport.vim
|
||||
Das Script zum Generieren eines Fehlerberichts. Siehe »:help bugs«.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/filetype.vim
|
||||
Mit diesem Script erkennt Vim den Typ einer Datei anhand ihres
|
||||
Dateinamens. Siehe »:help 'filetype'«.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/scripts.vim
|
||||
Mit diesem Script erkennt Vim den Typ einer Datei anhand ihres
|
||||
Inhaltes. Siehe »:help 'filetype'«.
|
||||
.TP
|
||||
/usr/local/lib/vim/print/*.ps
|
||||
Diese Dateien werden zum Drucken von PostScript verwendet.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Für die neuesten Informationen lesen Sie die Vim\-Homepage:
|
||||
.br
|
||||
<URL:http://www.vim.org/>
|
||||
.SH "SIEHE AUCH"
|
||||
vimtutor(1)
|
||||
.SH AUTOR
|
||||
\fBVim\fP wurde größtenteils von Bram Moolenaar erstellt, mit viel Hilfe von
|
||||
anderen Leuten. Siehe »:help credits« in \fBVim.\fP
|
||||
.br
|
||||
\fBVim\fP basiert auf Stevie, der von Tim Thompson, Tony Andrews und
|
||||
G.R. (Fred) Walter geschrieben wurde. Es ist jedoch kaum etwas vom
|
||||
ursprünglichen Code übrig geblieben.
|
||||
.SH FEHLER
|
||||
Die sind möglich. Siehe »:help todo« für eine Liste bekannter Probleme.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
Beachten Sie, dass gewisse Dinge, die manche Leute als Fehler betrachten
|
||||
mögen, in Wirklichkeit durch zu getreue Nachbildung des Vi\-Verhaltens
|
||||
verursacht werden. Und falls Sie denken, dass andere Dinge Fehler sind,
|
||||
»weil Vi es anders tut«, sollten Sie einen genaueren Blick auf die Datei
|
||||
vi_diff.txt werfen (oder in Vim »:help vi_diff.txt« tippen). Sehen Sie sich
|
||||
auch die Optionen 'compatible' und 'cpoptions' an.
|
||||
@@ -586,3 +586,4 @@ Cette page de manuel a
|
||||
.br
|
||||
Cette page de manuel a <20>t<EFBFBD> mise <20> jour par David Blanchet.
|
||||
<david.blanchet@free.fr> 2006-04-10.
|
||||
Mise <20> jour 2012-05-06, Dominique Pell<6C> <dominique.pelle@gmail.com>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -586,3 +586,4 @@ Cette page de manuel a été traduite par Richard Hitier.
|
||||
.br
|
||||
Cette page de manuel a été mise à jour par David Blanchet.
|
||||
<david.blanchet@free.fr> 2006-04-10.
|
||||
Mise à jour 2012-05-06, Dominique Pellé <dominique.pelle@gmail.com>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -14,7 +14,7 @@ d
|
||||
.B Vim
|
||||
avec deux (ou trois ou quatre) fichiers.
|
||||
Chaque fichier est ouvert dans sa propre fen<65>tre.
|
||||
Les diff<66>rences entres ces fichiers sont mises en surbrillance.
|
||||
Les diff<66>rences entre ces fichiers sont mises en surbrillance.
|
||||
C'est un outil tr<74>s pratique pour visualiser et reporter les
|
||||
changements entre deux versions d'un m<>me fichier.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
@@ -51,3 +51,4 @@ Voir ":help credits" dans
|
||||
.SH TRADUCTION
|
||||
Cette page de manuel a <20>t<EFBFBD> traduite par David Blanchet
|
||||
<david.blanchet@free.fr> 2005-03-12.
|
||||
Mise <20> jour 2012-05-06, Dominique Pell<6C> <dominique.pelle@gmail.com>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -14,7 +14,7 @@ démarre
|
||||
.B Vim
|
||||
avec deux (ou trois ou quatre) fichiers.
|
||||
Chaque fichier est ouvert dans sa propre fenêtre.
|
||||
Les différences entres ces fichiers sont mises en surbrillance.
|
||||
Les différences entre ces fichiers sont mises en surbrillance.
|
||||
C'est un outil très pratique pour visualiser et reporter les
|
||||
changements entre deux versions d'un même fichier.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
@@ -51,3 +51,4 @@ Voir ":help credits" dans
|
||||
.SH TRADUCTION
|
||||
Cette page de manuel a été traduite par David Blanchet
|
||||
<david.blanchet@free.fr> 2005-03-12.
|
||||
Mise à jour 2012-05-06, Dominique Pellé <dominique.pelle@gmail.com>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@
|
||||
vimtutor \- tutoriel Vim
|
||||
.SH SYNOPSIS
|
||||
.br
|
||||
.B vimtutor [-g] [langue]
|
||||
.B vimtutor [\-g] [langue]
|
||||
.SH DESCRIPTION
|
||||
.B Vimtutor
|
||||
lance le tutoriel
|
||||
@@ -17,7 +17,7 @@ est utile pour les personnes souhaitant apprendre leurs premi
|
||||
.B Vim
|
||||
\.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
L'argument optionnel -g lance vimtutor avec gvim plut<75>t qu'avec vim, si l'IHM
|
||||
L'argument optionnel \-g lance vimtutor avec gvim plut<75>t qu'avec vim, si l'IHM
|
||||
graphique de vim est disponible, ou le lance avec vim si gvim n'est pas
|
||||
disponible.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
@@ -57,3 +57,4 @@ vim(1)
|
||||
.SH TRADUCTION
|
||||
Cette page de manuel a <20>t<EFBFBD> traduite par David Blanchet
|
||||
<david.blanchet@free.fr> 2004-12-27.
|
||||
Mise <20> jour 2012-05-06, Dominique Pell<6C> <dominique.pelle@gmail.com>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -3,7 +3,7 @@
|
||||
vimtutor \- tutoriel Vim
|
||||
.SH SYNOPSIS
|
||||
.br
|
||||
.B vimtutor [-g] [langue]
|
||||
.B vimtutor [\-g] [langue]
|
||||
.SH DESCRIPTION
|
||||
.B Vimtutor
|
||||
lance le tutoriel
|
||||
@@ -17,7 +17,7 @@ est utile pour les personnes souhaitant apprendre leurs premières commandes
|
||||
.B Vim
|
||||
\.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
L'argument optionnel -g lance vimtutor avec gvim plutôt qu'avec vim, si l'IHM
|
||||
L'argument optionnel \-g lance vimtutor avec gvim plutôt qu'avec vim, si l'IHM
|
||||
graphique de vim est disponible, ou le lance avec vim si gvim n'est pas
|
||||
disponible.
|
||||
.PP
|
||||
@@ -57,3 +57,4 @@ vim(1)
|
||||
.SH TRADUCTION
|
||||
Cette page de manuel a été traduite par David Blanchet
|
||||
<david.blanchet@free.fr> 2004-12-27.
|
||||
Mise à jour 2012-05-06, Dominique Pellé <dominique.pelle@gmail.com>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*visual.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2010 Feb 17
|
||||
*visual.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Aug 15
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -61,15 +61,27 @@ position.
|
||||
2. Starting and stopping Visual mode *visual-start*
|
||||
|
||||
*v* *characterwise-visual*
|
||||
v start Visual mode per character.
|
||||
[count]v Start Visual mode per character.
|
||||
With [count] select the same number of characters or
|
||||
lines as used for the last Visual operation, but at
|
||||
the current cursor position, multiplied by [count].
|
||||
When the previous Visual operation was on a block both
|
||||
the width and height of the block are multiplied by
|
||||
[count].
|
||||
When there was no previous Visual operation [count]
|
||||
characters are selected. This is like moving the
|
||||
cursor right N * [count] characters. One less when
|
||||
'selection' is not "exclusive".
|
||||
|
||||
*V* *linewise-visual*
|
||||
V start Visual mode linewise.
|
||||
[count]V Start Visual mode linewise.
|
||||
With [count] select that many lines.
|
||||
|
||||
*CTRL-V* *blockwise-visual*
|
||||
CTRL-V start Visual mode blockwise. Note: Under Windows
|
||||
[count]CTRL-V Start Visual mode blockwise. Note: Under Windows
|
||||
CTRL-V could be mapped to paste text, it doesn't work
|
||||
to start Visual mode then, see |CTRL-V-alternative|.
|
||||
[count] is used as with `v` above.
|
||||
|
||||
If you use <Esc>, click the left mouse button or use any command that
|
||||
does a jump to another buffer while in Visual mode, the highlighting stops
|
||||
@@ -94,6 +106,18 @@ gv Start Visual mode with the same area as the previous
|
||||
After using "p" or "P" in Visual mode the text that
|
||||
was put will be selected.
|
||||
|
||||
*gn* *v_gn*
|
||||
gn Search forward for the last used search pattern, like
|
||||
with `n`, and start Visual mode to select the match.
|
||||
If the cursor is on the match, visually selects it.
|
||||
If an operator is pending, operates on the match.
|
||||
E.g., "dgn" deletes the text of the next match.
|
||||
If Visual mode is active, extends the selection
|
||||
until the end of the next match.
|
||||
|
||||
*gN* *v_gN*
|
||||
gN Like |gn| but searches backward, like with `N`.
|
||||
|
||||
*<LeftMouse>*
|
||||
<LeftMouse> Set the current cursor position. If Visual mode is
|
||||
active it is stopped. Only when 'mouse' option is
|
||||
@@ -269,7 +293,10 @@ with {motion}, which is only ONE movement command.
|
||||
Another way to operate on the Visual area is using the |/\%V| item in a
|
||||
pattern. For example, to replace all '(' in the Visual area with '#': >
|
||||
|
||||
:%s/\%V(/X/g
|
||||
:'<,'>s/\%V(/#/g
|
||||
|
||||
Note that the "'<,'>" will appear automatically when you press ":" in Visual
|
||||
mode.
|
||||
|
||||
==============================================================================
|
||||
5. Blockwise operators *blockwise-operators*
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,4 +1,4 @@
|
||||
*windows.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Apr 13
|
||||
*windows.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Nov 15
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
|
||||
@@ -939,9 +939,9 @@ list of buffers. |unlisted-buffer|
|
||||
:buffers[!] *:buffers* *:ls*
|
||||
:ls[!] Show all buffers. Example:
|
||||
|
||||
1 #h "/test/text" line 1 ~
|
||||
2u "asdf" line 0 ~
|
||||
3 %a+ "version.c" line 1 ~
|
||||
1 #h "/test/text" line 1 ~
|
||||
2u "asdf" line 0 ~
|
||||
3 %a + "version.c" line 1 ~
|
||||
|
||||
When the [!] is included the list will show unlisted buffers
|
||||
(the term "unlisted" is a bit confusing then...).
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -393,3 +393,4 @@ Modifications mineures par Bram Moolenaar.
|
||||
.SH TRADUCTION
|
||||
Cette page de manuel a <20>t<EFBFBD> traduite par David Blanchet
|
||||
<david.blanchet@free.fr> 2004-12-24.
|
||||
Mise <20> jour 2012-05-06, Dominique Pell<6C> <dominique.pelle@gmail.com>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -393,3 +393,4 @@ Modifications mineures par Bram Moolenaar.
|
||||
.SH TRADUCTION
|
||||
Cette page de manuel a été traduite par David Blanchet
|
||||
<david.blanchet@free.fr> 2004-12-24.
|
||||
Mise à jour 2012-05-06, Dominique Pellé <dominique.pelle@gmail.com>
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Vim support file to detect file types
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 13
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Nov 28
|
||||
|
||||
" Listen very carefully, I will say this only once
|
||||
if exists("did_load_filetypes")
|
||||
@@ -128,6 +128,11 @@ au BufNewFile,BufRead .asoundrc,*/usr/share/alsa/alsa.conf,*/etc/asound.conf set
|
||||
" Arc Macro Language
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.aml setf aml
|
||||
|
||||
" APT config file
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead apt.conf setf aptconf
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead */.aptitude/config setf aptconf
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead */etc/apt/apt.conf.d/{[-_[:alnum:]]\+,[-_.[:alnum:]]\+.conf} setf aptconf
|
||||
|
||||
" Arch Inventory file
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead .arch-inventory,=tagging-method setf arch
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -633,6 +638,9 @@ au BufNewFile,BufRead *.dsl setf dsl
|
||||
" DTD (Document Type Definition for XML)
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.dtd setf dtd
|
||||
|
||||
" DTS/DSTI (device tree files)
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.dts,*.dtsi setf dts
|
||||
|
||||
" EDIF (*.edf,*.edif,*.edn,*.edo)
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.ed\(f\|if\|n\|o\) setf edif
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1119,6 +1127,9 @@ au BufNewFile,BufRead *.nb setf mma
|
||||
" Maya Extension Language
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.mel setf mel
|
||||
|
||||
" Mercurial (hg) commit file
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead hg-editor-*.txt setf hgcommit
|
||||
|
||||
" Mercurial config (looks like generic config file)
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.hgrc,*hgrc setf cfg
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1200,7 +1211,7 @@ au BufNewFile,BufRead *.mysql setf mysql
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead */etc/Muttrc.d/* call s:StarSetf('muttrc')
|
||||
|
||||
" M$ Resource files
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.rc setf rc
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.rc,*.rch setf rc
|
||||
|
||||
" MuPAD source
|
||||
au BufRead,BufNewFile *.mu setf mupad
|
||||
@@ -1267,7 +1278,7 @@ endfunc
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.nqc setf nqc
|
||||
|
||||
" NSIS
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.nsi setf nsis
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.nsi,*.nsh setf nsis
|
||||
|
||||
" OCAML
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.ml,*.mli,*.mll,*.mly,.ocamlinit setf ocaml
|
||||
@@ -1555,7 +1566,7 @@ au BufNewFile,BufRead *.reg
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.rib setf rib
|
||||
|
||||
" Rexx
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.rexx,*.rex,*.jrexx,*.rxj,*.orx setf rexx
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.rex,*.orx,*.rxo,*.rxj,*.jrexx,*.rexxj,*.rexx,*.testGroup,*.testUnit setf rexx
|
||||
|
||||
" R (Splus)
|
||||
if has("fname_case")
|
||||
@@ -1734,7 +1745,8 @@ au BufNewFile,BufRead *.sgm,*.sgml
|
||||
\ if getline(1).getline(2).getline(3).getline(4).getline(5) =~? 'linuxdoc' |
|
||||
\ setf sgmllnx |
|
||||
\ elseif getline(1) =~ '<!DOCTYPE.*DocBook' || getline(2) =~ '<!DOCTYPE.*DocBook' |
|
||||
\ let b:docbk_type="sgml" |
|
||||
\ let b:docbk_type = "sgml" |
|
||||
\ let b:docbk_ver = 4 |
|
||||
\ setf docbk |
|
||||
\ else |
|
||||
\ setf sgml |
|
||||
@@ -1769,6 +1781,10 @@ func! SetFileTypeSH(name)
|
||||
" Some .sh scripts contain #!/bin/tcsh.
|
||||
call SetFileTypeShell("tcsh")
|
||||
return
|
||||
elseif a:name =~ '\<zsh\>'
|
||||
" Some .sh scripts contain #!/bin/zsh.
|
||||
call SetFileTypeShell("zsh")
|
||||
return
|
||||
elseif a:name =~ '\<ksh\>'
|
||||
let b:is_kornshell = 1
|
||||
if exists("b:is_bash")
|
||||
@@ -1842,7 +1858,7 @@ au BufNewFile,BufRead .zsh*,.zlog*,.zcompdump* call s:StarSetf('zsh')
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.zsh setf zsh
|
||||
|
||||
" Scheme
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.scm,*.ss setf scheme
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.scm,*.ss,*.rkt setf scheme
|
||||
|
||||
" Screen RC
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead .screenrc,screenrc setf screen
|
||||
@@ -1869,6 +1885,8 @@ au BufNewFile,BufRead *.st setf st
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.cls
|
||||
\ if getline(1) =~ '^%' |
|
||||
\ setf tex |
|
||||
\ elseif getline(1)[0] == '#' && getline(1) =~ 'rexx' |
|
||||
\ setf rexx |
|
||||
\ else |
|
||||
\ setf st |
|
||||
\ endif
|
||||
@@ -2290,8 +2308,16 @@ func! s:FTxml()
|
||||
let n = 1
|
||||
while n < 100 && n < line("$")
|
||||
let line = getline(n)
|
||||
if line =~ '<!DOCTYPE.*DocBook'
|
||||
" DocBook 4 or DocBook 5.
|
||||
let is_docbook4 = line =~ '<!DOCTYPE.*DocBook'
|
||||
let is_docbook5 = line =~ ' xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"'
|
||||
if is_docbook4 || is_docbook5
|
||||
let b:docbk_type = "xml"
|
||||
if is_docbook5
|
||||
let b:docbk_ver = 5
|
||||
else
|
||||
let b:docbk_ver = 4
|
||||
endif
|
||||
setf docbk
|
||||
return
|
||||
endif
|
||||
@@ -2371,6 +2397,9 @@ au BufNewFile,BufRead *.yaml,*.yml setf yaml
|
||||
" yum conf (close enough to dosini)
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead */etc/yum.conf setf dosini
|
||||
|
||||
" Zimbu
|
||||
au BufNewFile,BufRead *.zu setf zimbu
|
||||
|
||||
" Zope
|
||||
" dtml (zope dynamic template markup language), pt (zope page template),
|
||||
" cpt (zope form controller page template)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Vim filetype plugin file
|
||||
" Language: Abaqus finite element input file (www.abaqus.com)
|
||||
" Maintainer: Carl Osterwisch <osterwischc@asme.org>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Mar 11
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr 30
|
||||
|
||||
" Only do this when not done yet for this buffer
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin") | finish | endif
|
||||
@@ -51,7 +51,7 @@ if has("gui_win32") && !exists("b:browsefilter")
|
||||
\ "Abaqus Results (*.dat)\t*.dat\n" .
|
||||
\ "Abaqus Messages (*.pre *.msg *.sta)\t*.pre;*.msg;*.sta\n" .
|
||||
\ "All Files (*.*)\t*.*\n"
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin .= "|unlet b:browsefilter"
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin .= "|unlet! b:browsefilter"
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Define patterns for the matchit plugin
|
||||
@@ -62,7 +62,7 @@ if exists("loaded_matchit") && !exists("b:match_words")
|
||||
\ '\*assembly:\*end\s*assembly,' .
|
||||
\ '\*instance:\*end\s*instance,' .
|
||||
\ '\*step:\*end\s*step'
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin .= "|unlet b:match_ignorecase b:match_words"
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin .= "|unlet! b:match_ignorecase b:match_words"
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Define keys used to move [count] keywords backward or forward.
|
||||
@@ -85,6 +85,13 @@ endfunction
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin .= "|unmap <buffer> [[|unmap <buffer> ]]"
|
||||
\ . "|unmap <buffer> <LocalLeader><LocalLeader>"
|
||||
|
||||
" Undo must be done in nocompatible mode for <LocalLeader>.
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin = "let s:cpo_save = &cpoptions|"
|
||||
\ . "set cpoptions&vim|"
|
||||
\ . b:undo_ftplugin
|
||||
\ . "|let &cpoptions = s:cpo_save"
|
||||
\ . "|unlet s:cpo_save"
|
||||
|
||||
" Restore saved compatibility options
|
||||
let &cpoptions = s:cpo_save
|
||||
unlet s:cpo_save
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -12,5 +12,4 @@ endif
|
||||
run ftplugin/lisp.vim
|
||||
|
||||
setl lw-=if
|
||||
setl lw+=def-art-fun,deffacts,defglobal,defrule,defschema,
|
||||
\for,schema,while
|
||||
setl lw+=def-art-fun,deffacts,defglobal,defrule,defschema,for,schema,while
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Vim filetype plugin file
|
||||
" Language: C
|
||||
" Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2011 Aug 04
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Jul 10
|
||||
|
||||
" Only do this when not done yet for this buffer
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
@@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ let b:match_words = &matchpairs . ',^\s*#\s*if\(\|def\|ndef\)\>:^\s*#\s*elif\>:^
|
||||
let b:match_skip = 's:comment\|string\|character'
|
||||
|
||||
" Win32 can filter files in the browse dialog
|
||||
if has("gui_win32") && !exists("b:browsefilter")
|
||||
if (has("gui_win32") || has("gui_gtk")) && !exists("b:browsefilter")
|
||||
if &ft == "cpp"
|
||||
let b:browsefilter = "C++ Source Files (*.cpp *.c++)\t*.cpp;*.c++\n" .
|
||||
\ "C Header Files (*.h)\t*.h\n" .
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Vim filetype plugin file
|
||||
" Language: generic Changelog file
|
||||
" Maintainer: Nikolai Weibull <now@bitwi.se>
|
||||
" Latest Revision: 2011-05-02
|
||||
" Latest Revision: 2012-08-23
|
||||
" Variables:
|
||||
" g:changelog_timeformat (deprecated: use g:changelog_dateformat instead) -
|
||||
" description: the timeformat used in ChangeLog entries.
|
||||
@@ -106,10 +106,10 @@ if &filetype == 'changelog'
|
||||
|
||||
function! s:passwd_field(line, field)
|
||||
let fields = split(a:line, ':', 1)
|
||||
if len(fields) < field
|
||||
if len(fields) < a:field
|
||||
return ""
|
||||
endif
|
||||
return fields[field - 1]
|
||||
return fields[a:field - 1]
|
||||
endfunction
|
||||
|
||||
function! s:capitalize(word)
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -10,6 +10,8 @@ endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Don't load another plugin for this buffer
|
||||
let b:did_ftplugin = 1
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
" Set 'formatoptions' to break comment lines but not other lines,
|
||||
" and insert the comment leader when hitting <CR> or using "o".
|
||||
@@ -22,3 +24,6 @@ if has("gui_win32") && !exists("b:browsefilter")
|
||||
let b:browsefilter = "C# Source Files (*.cs)\t*.cs\n" .
|
||||
\ "All Files (*.*)\t*.*\n"
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Vim filetype plugin file
|
||||
" Language: DocBook
|
||||
" Maintainer: Nikolai Weibull <now@bitwi.se>
|
||||
" Latest Revision: 2010-10-14
|
||||
" Latest Revision: 2012-04-25
|
||||
|
||||
if exists('b:did_ftplugin')
|
||||
finish
|
||||
@@ -20,3 +20,5 @@ if b:docbk_type == 'sgml'
|
||||
else
|
||||
runtime! ftplugin/xml.vim ftplugin/xml_*.vim ftplugin/xml/*.vim
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin = "unlet! b:docbk_type"
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Vim filetype plugin file
|
||||
" Language: MS-DOS .bat files
|
||||
" Maintainer: Mike Williams <mrw@eandem.co.uk>
|
||||
" Last Change: 27th May 2009
|
||||
" Last Change: 8th May 2012
|
||||
|
||||
" Only do this when not done yet for this buffer
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
@@ -11,6 +11,9 @@ endif
|
||||
" Don't load another plugin for this buffer
|
||||
let b:did_ftplugin = 1
|
||||
|
||||
let s:cpo_save = &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
" BAT comment formatting
|
||||
setlocal comments=b:rem,b:@rem,b:REM,b:@REM,:::
|
||||
setlocal formatoptions-=t formatoptions+=rol
|
||||
@@ -19,3 +22,9 @@ setlocal formatoptions-=t formatoptions+=rol
|
||||
if has("gui_win32") && !exists("b:browsefilter")
|
||||
let b:browsefilter = "DOS Batch Files (*.bat, *.cmd)\t*.bat;*.cmd\nAll Files (*.*)\t*.*\n"
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin = "setlocal comments< formatoptions<"
|
||||
\ . "| unlet! b:browsefiler"
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:cpo_save
|
||||
unlet s:cpo_save
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,11 +1,12 @@
|
||||
" Vim settings file
|
||||
" Language: Fortran90 (and Fortran95, Fortran77, F and elf90)
|
||||
" Version: 0.47
|
||||
" Last Change: 2011 December 28
|
||||
" Language: Fortran 2008 (and older: Fortran 2003, 95, 90, 77, 66)
|
||||
" Version: 0.48
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Apr. 18
|
||||
" Maintainer: Ajit J. Thakkar <ajit@unb.ca>; <http://www.unb.ca/chem/ajit/>
|
||||
" Usage: Do :help fortran-plugin from Vim
|
||||
" Credits:
|
||||
" Useful suggestions were made by Stefano Zacchiroli and Hendrik Merx.
|
||||
" Useful suggestions were made by Stefano Zacchiroli, Hendrik Merx, and Ben
|
||||
" Fritz.
|
||||
|
||||
" Only do these settings when not done yet for this buffer
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
@@ -28,7 +29,7 @@ if !exists("b:fortran_fixed_source")
|
||||
" User guarantees fixed source form
|
||||
let b:fortran_fixed_source = 1
|
||||
else
|
||||
" f90 and f95 allow both fixed and free source form
|
||||
" Modern Fortran allows both fixed and free source form
|
||||
" assume fixed source form unless signs of free source form
|
||||
" are detected in the first five columns of the first s:lmax lines
|
||||
" Detection becomes more accurate and time-consuming if more lines
|
||||
@@ -79,7 +80,7 @@ endif
|
||||
setlocal fo+=tcql
|
||||
|
||||
setlocal include=^\\c#\\=\\s*include\\s\\+
|
||||
setlocal suffixesadd+=.f95,.f90,.for,.f,.F,.f77,.ftn,.fpp
|
||||
setlocal suffixesadd+=.f08,.f03,.f95,.f90,.for,.f,.F,.f77,.ftn,.fpp
|
||||
|
||||
" Define patterns for the matchit plugin
|
||||
if !exists("b:match_words")
|
||||
@@ -89,6 +90,7 @@ if !exists("b:match_words")
|
||||
let s:notprocedure = '\%(\s\+procedure\>\)\@!'
|
||||
let b:match_ignorecase = 1
|
||||
let b:match_words =
|
||||
\ '(:),' .
|
||||
\ '\<select\s*case\>:' . s:notselect. '\<case\>:\<end\s*select\>,' .
|
||||
\ s:notelse . '\<if\s*(.\+)\s*then\>:' .
|
||||
\ '\<else\s*\%(if\s*(.\+)\s*then\)\=\>:\<end\s*if\>,'.
|
||||
@@ -96,6 +98,9 @@ if !exists("b:match_words")
|
||||
\ s:notend . '\<do\>:\<end\s*do\>,'.
|
||||
\ s:notelse . '\<where\>:\<elsewhere\>:\<end\s*where\>,'.
|
||||
\ s:notend . '\<type\s*[^(]:\<end\s*type\>,'.
|
||||
\ s:notend . '\<forall\>:\<end\s*forall\>,'.
|
||||
\ s:notend . '\<associate\>:\<end\s*associate\>,'.
|
||||
\ s:notend . '\<enum\>:\<end\s*enum\>,'.
|
||||
\ s:notend . '\<interface\>:\<end\s*interface\>,'.
|
||||
\ s:notend . '\<subroutine\>:\<end\s*subroutine\>,'.
|
||||
\ s:notend . '\<function\>:\<end\s*function\>,'.
|
||||
@@ -105,7 +110,7 @@ endif
|
||||
|
||||
" File filters for :browse e
|
||||
if has("gui_win32") && !exists("b:browsefilter")
|
||||
let b:browsefilter = "Fortran Files (*.f;*.F;*.for;*.f77;*.f90;*.f95;*.fpp;*.ftn)\t*.f;*.F;*.for;*.f77;*.f90;*.f95;*.fpp;*.ftn\n" .
|
||||
let b:browsefilter = "Fortran Files (*.f;*.for;*.f77;*.f90;*.f95;*.f03;*.f08;*.fpp;*.ftn)\t*.f;*.for;*.f77;*.f90;*.f95;*.f03;*.f08;*.fpp;*.ftn\n" .
|
||||
\ "All Files (*.*)\t*.*\n"
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -8,6 +8,8 @@ let b:did_ftplugin = 1
|
||||
|
||||
setlocal foldmethod=syntax
|
||||
|
||||
" Using line continuation here.
|
||||
let s:cpo_save = &cpo
|
||||
set cpo-=C
|
||||
|
||||
" matchit support
|
||||
@@ -26,3 +28,6 @@ if has("gui_win32") && !exists("b:browsefilter")
|
||||
let b:browsefilter = "InstallShield Files (*.rul)\t*.rul\n" .
|
||||
\ "All Files (*.*)\t*.*\n"
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:cpo_save
|
||||
unlet s:cpo_save
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Vim filetype plugin file
|
||||
" Language: Mail
|
||||
" Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2009 Jun 03
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Nov 20
|
||||
|
||||
" Only do this when not done yet for this buffer
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
@@ -9,7 +9,7 @@ if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let b:did_ftplugin = 1
|
||||
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin = "setl modeline< tw< fo<"
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin = "setl modeline< tw< fo< comments<"
|
||||
|
||||
" Don't use modelines in e-mail messages, avoid trojan horses and nasty
|
||||
" "jokes" (e.g., setting 'textwidth' to 5).
|
||||
@@ -23,6 +23,9 @@ endif
|
||||
" Set 'formatoptions' to break text lines and keep the comment leader ">".
|
||||
setlocal fo+=tcql
|
||||
|
||||
" Add n:> to 'comments, in case it was removed elsewhere
|
||||
setlocal comments+=n:>
|
||||
|
||||
" Add mappings, unless the user doesn't want this.
|
||||
if !exists("no_plugin_maps") && !exists("no_mail_maps")
|
||||
" Quote text by inserting "> "
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -9,6 +9,8 @@ if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let b:did_ftplugin = 1
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
"{{{ Indent settings
|
||||
" Set shift width for indent
|
||||
@@ -42,3 +44,6 @@ let b:undo_ftplugin = "setlocal shiftwidth< softtabstop< expandtab<"
|
||||
\ . " formatoptions< comments< textwidth<"
|
||||
\ . "| unlet! b:browsefiler"
|
||||
"}}}
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -8,8 +8,8 @@ if exists("b:did_ftplugin") | finish | endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Make sure the continuation lines below do not cause problems in
|
||||
" compatibility mode.
|
||||
let s:save_cpo = &cpo
|
||||
set cpo-=C
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
" Define some defaults in case the included ftplugins don't set them.
|
||||
let s:undo_ftplugin = ""
|
||||
@@ -79,5 +79,5 @@ let b:undo_ftplugin = "setlocal commentstring< include< omnifunc<" .
|
||||
\ s:undo_ftplugin
|
||||
|
||||
" Restore the saved compatibility options.
|
||||
let &cpo = s:save_cpo
|
||||
unlet s:save_cpo
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Vim filetype plugin file
|
||||
" Language: PostScript
|
||||
" Maintainer: Mike Williams <mrw@eandem.co.uk>
|
||||
" Last Change: 16th January 2012
|
||||
" Last Change: 24th April 2012
|
||||
|
||||
" Only do this when not done yet for this buffer
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
@@ -31,5 +31,8 @@ if has("gui_win32") && !exists("b:browsefilter")
|
||||
\ "All Files (*.*)\t*.*\n"
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin = "setlocal comments< formatoptions<"
|
||||
\ . "| unlet! b:browsefiler b:match_ignorecase b:match_words"
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:cpo_save
|
||||
unlet s:cpo_save
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -2,12 +2,14 @@
|
||||
" Language: Pyrex
|
||||
" Maintainer: Marco Barisione <marco.bari@people.it>
|
||||
" URL: http://marcobari.altervista.org/pyrex_vim.html
|
||||
" Last Change: 2004 May 16
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 May 18
|
||||
|
||||
" Only do this when not done yet for this buffer
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
" Behaves just like Python
|
||||
runtime! ftplugin/python.vim ftplugin/python_*.vim ftplugin/python/*.vim
|
||||
@@ -20,3 +22,6 @@ if has("gui_win32") && exists("b:browsefilter")
|
||||
\ "C++ Source Files (*.cpp *.c++)\t*.cpp;*.c++\n" .
|
||||
\ "All Files (*.*)\t*.*\n"
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -5,6 +5,8 @@
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin") | finish | endif
|
||||
let b:did_ftplugin = 1
|
||||
let s:keepcpo= &cpo
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
setlocal cinkeys-=0#
|
||||
setlocal indentkeys-=0#
|
||||
@@ -41,3 +43,6 @@ if has("gui_win32") && !exists("b:browsefilter")
|
||||
let b:browsefilter = "Python Files (*.py)\t*.py\n" .
|
||||
\ "All Files (*.*)\t*.*\n"
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:keepcpo
|
||||
unlet s:keepcpo
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,7 +1,7 @@
|
||||
" Vim filetype plugin file
|
||||
" Language: Vim's quickfix window
|
||||
" Maintainer: Lech Lorens <Lech.Lorens@gmail.com>
|
||||
" Last Changed: 18 Dec 2010
|
||||
" Last Changed: 30 Apr 2012
|
||||
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
@@ -13,4 +13,4 @@ let b:did_ftplugin = 1
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin = "set stl<"
|
||||
|
||||
" Display the command that produced the list in the quickfix window:
|
||||
setlocal stl=%t%{exists('w:quickfix_title')?\ '\ '.w:quickfix_title\ :\ ''}
|
||||
setlocal stl=%t%{exists('w:quickfix_title')?\ '\ '.w:quickfix_title\ :\ ''}\ %=%-15(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -1,8 +1,8 @@
|
||||
" SQL filetype plugin file
|
||||
" Language: SQL (Common for Oracle, Microsoft SQL Server, Sybase)
|
||||
" Version: 8.0
|
||||
" Version: 10.0
|
||||
" Maintainer: David Fishburn <dfishburn dot vim at gmail dot com>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Mar 11
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Dec 04
|
||||
" Download: http://vim.sourceforge.net/script.php?script_id=454
|
||||
|
||||
" For more details please use:
|
||||
@@ -30,34 +30,48 @@
|
||||
" To change the default dialect, add the following to your vimrc:
|
||||
" let g:sql_type_default = 'sqlanywhere'
|
||||
"
|
||||
" This file also creates a command, SQLGetType, which allows you to
|
||||
" This file also creates a command, SQLGetType, which allows you to
|
||||
" determine what the current dialect is in use.
|
||||
" :SQLGetType
|
||||
"
|
||||
" History
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 10.0 (Dec 2012)
|
||||
"
|
||||
" NF: Changed all maps to use noremap instead of must map
|
||||
" NF: Changed all visual maps to use xnoremap instead of vnoremap as they
|
||||
" should only be used in visual mode and not select mode.
|
||||
" BF: Most of the maps were using doubled up backslashes before they were
|
||||
" changed to using the search() function, which meant they no longer
|
||||
" worked.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 9.0
|
||||
"
|
||||
" NF: Completes 'b:undo_ftplugin'
|
||||
" BF: Correctly set cpoptions when creating script
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 8.0
|
||||
"
|
||||
"
|
||||
" NF: Improved the matchit plugin regex (Talek)
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 7.0
|
||||
"
|
||||
"
|
||||
" NF: Calls the sqlcomplete#ResetCacheSyntax() function when calling
|
||||
" SQLSetType.
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 6.0
|
||||
"
|
||||
"
|
||||
" NF: Adds the command SQLGetType
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Version 5.0
|
||||
"
|
||||
" NF: Adds the ability to choose the keys to control SQL completion, just add
|
||||
"
|
||||
" NF: Adds the ability to choose the keys to control SQL completion, just add
|
||||
" the following to your .vimrc:
|
||||
" let g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key = '<C-C>'
|
||||
" let g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key_right = '<Right>'
|
||||
" let g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key_left = '<Left>'
|
||||
"
|
||||
" BF: format-options - Auto-wrap comments using textwidth was turned off
|
||||
" BF: format-options - Auto-wrap comments using textwidth was turned off
|
||||
" by mistake.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -67,7 +81,7 @@ if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let s:save_cpo = &cpo
|
||||
set cpo=
|
||||
set cpo&vim
|
||||
|
||||
" Disable autowrapping for code, but enable for comments
|
||||
" t Auto-wrap text using textwidth
|
||||
@@ -81,7 +95,7 @@ setlocal formatoptions+=c
|
||||
" This works with both Vim 6 and 7.
|
||||
|
||||
if !exists("*SQL_SetType")
|
||||
" NOTE: You cannot use function! since this file can be
|
||||
" NOTE: You cannot use function! since this file can be
|
||||
" sourced from within this function. That will result in
|
||||
" an error reported by Vim.
|
||||
function SQL_GetList(ArgLead, CmdLine, CursorPos)
|
||||
@@ -105,9 +119,9 @@ if !exists("*SQL_SetType")
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Recursively, since there are many filenames that contain
|
||||
" the word SQL in the indent, syntax and ftplugin directory
|
||||
let sqls = substitute( sqls,
|
||||
\ '[\n]\%(.\{-}\)\(\w\+\.\w\+\)\n\@=',
|
||||
\ '\1\n',
|
||||
let sqls = substitute( sqls,
|
||||
\ '[\n]\%(.\{-}\)\(\w\+\.\w\+\)\n\@=',
|
||||
\ '\1\n',
|
||||
\ 'g'
|
||||
\ )
|
||||
|
||||
@@ -142,10 +156,10 @@ if !exists("*SQL_SetType")
|
||||
function SQL_SetType(name)
|
||||
|
||||
" User has decided to override default SQL scripts and
|
||||
" specify a vendor specific version
|
||||
" specify a vendor specific version
|
||||
" (ie Oracle, Informix, SQL Anywhere, ...)
|
||||
" So check for an remove any settings that prevent the
|
||||
" scripts from being executed, and then source the
|
||||
" scripts from being executed, and then source the
|
||||
" appropriate Vim scripts.
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
unlet b:did_ftplugin
|
||||
@@ -163,10 +177,10 @@ if !exists("*SQL_SetType")
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Ensure the name is in the correct format
|
||||
let new_sql_type = substitute(a:name,
|
||||
let new_sql_type = substitute(a:name,
|
||||
\ '\s*\([^\.]\+\)\(\.\w\+\)\?', '\L\1', '')
|
||||
|
||||
" Do not specify a buffer local variable if it is
|
||||
" Do not specify a buffer local variable if it is
|
||||
" the default value
|
||||
if new_sql_type == 'sql'
|
||||
let new_sql_type = 'sqloracle'
|
||||
@@ -203,10 +217,10 @@ endif
|
||||
|
||||
if !exists("*SQL_GetType")
|
||||
function SQL_GetType()
|
||||
if exists('b:sql_type_override')
|
||||
if exists('b:sql_type_override')
|
||||
echomsg "Current SQL dialect in use:".b:sql_type_override
|
||||
else
|
||||
echomsg "Current SQL dialect in use:".g:sql_type_default
|
||||
echomsg "Current SQL dialect in use:".g:sql_type_default
|
||||
endif
|
||||
endfunction
|
||||
command! -nargs=0 SQLGetType :call SQL_GetType()
|
||||
@@ -233,7 +247,8 @@ if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin = "setl comments<"
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin = "setl comments< formatoptions< define< omnifunc<" .
|
||||
\ " | unlet! b:browsefilter b:match_words"
|
||||
|
||||
" Don't load another plugin for this buffer
|
||||
let b:did_ftplugin = 1
|
||||
@@ -280,7 +295,7 @@ if !exists("b:match_words")
|
||||
" doend
|
||||
"
|
||||
" case
|
||||
" when
|
||||
" when
|
||||
" when
|
||||
" default
|
||||
" end case
|
||||
@@ -296,8 +311,10 @@ if !exists("b:match_words")
|
||||
" create[ or replace] procedure|function|event
|
||||
" \ '^\s*\<\%(do\|for\|while\|loop\)\>.*:'.
|
||||
|
||||
let b:match_words =
|
||||
\ '\<begin\>:\<end\>\W*$,'.
|
||||
" For ColdFusion support
|
||||
setlocal matchpairs+=<:>
|
||||
let b:match_words = &matchpairs .
|
||||
\ ',\<begin\>:\<end\>\W*$,'.
|
||||
\
|
||||
\ s:notend . '\<if\>:'.
|
||||
\ '\<elsif\>\|\<elseif\>\|\<else\>:'.
|
||||
@@ -337,14 +354,14 @@ let &l:define = '\c\<\(VARIABLE\|DECLARE\|IN\|OUT\|INOUT\)\>'
|
||||
|
||||
" Mappings to move to the next BEGIN ... END block
|
||||
" \W - no characters or digits
|
||||
nmap <buffer> <silent> ]] :call search('\\c^\\s*begin\\>', 'W' )<CR>
|
||||
nmap <buffer> <silent> [[ :call search('\\c^\\s*begin\\>', 'bW' )<CR>
|
||||
nmap <buffer> <silent> ][ :call search('\\c^\\s*end\\W*$', 'W' )<CR>
|
||||
nmap <buffer> <silent> [] :call search('\\c^\\s*end\\W*$', 'bW' )<CR>
|
||||
vmap <buffer> <silent> ]] :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('\\c^\\s*begin\\>', 'W' )<CR>
|
||||
vmap <buffer> <silent> [[ :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('\\c^\\s*begin\\>', 'bW' )<CR>
|
||||
vmap <buffer> <silent> ][ :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('\\c^\\s*end\\W*$', 'W' )<CR>
|
||||
vmap <buffer> <silent> [] :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('\\c^\\s*end\\W*$', 'bW' )<CR>
|
||||
nnoremap <buffer> <silent> ]] :call search('\c^\s*begin\>', 'W' )<CR>
|
||||
nnoremap <buffer> <silent> [[ :call search('\c^\s*begin\>', 'bW' )<CR>
|
||||
nnoremap <buffer> <silent> ][ :call search('\c^\s*end\W*$', 'W' )<CR>
|
||||
nnoremap <buffer> <silent> [] :call search('\c^\s*end\W*$', 'bW' )<CR>
|
||||
xnoremap <buffer> <silent> ]] :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('\c^\s*begin\>', 'W' )<CR>
|
||||
xnoremap <buffer> <silent> [[ :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('\c^\s*begin\>', 'bW' )<CR>
|
||||
xnoremap <buffer> <silent> ][ :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('\c^\s*end\W*$', 'W' )<CR>
|
||||
xnoremap <buffer> <silent> [] :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('\c^\s*end\W*$', 'bW' )<CR>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
" By default only look for CREATE statements, but allow
|
||||
@@ -361,7 +378,7 @@ endif
|
||||
" backwards, you must use \{,1}
|
||||
if !exists('g:ftplugin_sql_objects')
|
||||
let g:ftplugin_sql_objects = 'function,procedure,event,' .
|
||||
\ '\\(existing\\\\|global\\s\\+temporary\\s\\+\\)\\\{,1}' .
|
||||
\ '\(existing\\|global\s\+temporary\s\+\)\{,1}' .
|
||||
\ 'table,trigger' .
|
||||
\ ',schema,service,publication,database,datatype,domain' .
|
||||
\ ',index,subscription,synchronization,view,variable'
|
||||
@@ -382,47 +399,47 @@ endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Replace all ,'s with bars, except ones with numbers after them.
|
||||
" This will most likely be a \{,1} string.
|
||||
let s:ftplugin_sql_objects =
|
||||
\ '\\c^\\s*' .
|
||||
\ '\\(\\(' .
|
||||
\ substitute(g:ftplugin_sql_statements, ',\d\@!', '\\\\\\|', 'g') .
|
||||
\ '\\)\\s\\+\\(or\\s\\+replace\\\s\+\\)\\{,1}\\)\\{,1}' .
|
||||
\ '\\<\\(' .
|
||||
\ substitute(g:ftplugin_sql_objects, ',\d\@!', '\\\\\\|', 'g') .
|
||||
\ '\\)\\>'
|
||||
let s:ftplugin_sql_objects =
|
||||
\ '\c^\s*' .
|
||||
\ '\(\(' .
|
||||
\ substitute(g:ftplugin_sql_statements, ',\d\@!', '\\\\|', 'g') .
|
||||
\ '\)\s\+\(or\s\+replace\s\+\)\{,1}\)\{,1}' .
|
||||
\ '\<\(' .
|
||||
\ substitute(g:ftplugin_sql_objects, ',\d\@!', '\\\\|', 'g') .
|
||||
\ '\)\>'
|
||||
|
||||
" Mappings to move to the next CREATE ... block
|
||||
exec "nmap <buffer> <silent> ]} :call search('".s:ftplugin_sql_objects."', 'W')<CR>"
|
||||
exec "nmap <buffer> <silent> [{ :call search('".s:ftplugin_sql_objects."', 'bW')<CR>"
|
||||
exec "nnoremap <buffer> <silent> ]} :call search('".s:ftplugin_sql_objects."', 'W')<CR>"
|
||||
exec "nnoremap <buffer> <silent> [{ :call search('".s:ftplugin_sql_objects."', 'bW')<CR>"
|
||||
" Could not figure out how to use a :call search() string in visual mode
|
||||
" without it ending visual mode
|
||||
" Unfortunately, this will add a entry to the search history
|
||||
exec 'vmap <buffer> <silent> ]} /'.s:ftplugin_sql_objects.'<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'vmap <buffer> <silent> [{ ?'.s:ftplugin_sql_objects.'<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'xnoremap <buffer> <silent> ]} /'.s:ftplugin_sql_objects.'<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'xnoremap <buffer> <silent> [{ ?'.s:ftplugin_sql_objects.'<CR>'
|
||||
|
||||
" Mappings to move to the next COMMENT
|
||||
"
|
||||
" Had to double the \ for the \| separator since this has a special
|
||||
" meaning on maps
|
||||
let b:comment_leader = '\\(--\\\|\\/\\/\\\|\\*\\\|\\/\\*\\\|\\*\\/\\)'
|
||||
let b:comment_leader = '\(--\\|\/\/\\|\*\\|\/\*\\|\*\/\)'
|
||||
" Find the start of the next comment
|
||||
let b:comment_start = '^\\(\\s*'.b:comment_leader.'.*\\n\\)\\@<!'.
|
||||
\ '\\(\\s*'.b:comment_leader.'\\)'
|
||||
let b:comment_start = '^\(\s*'.b:comment_leader.'.*\n\)\@<!'.
|
||||
\ '\(\s*'.b:comment_leader.'\)'
|
||||
" Find the end of the previous comment
|
||||
let b:comment_end = '\\(^\\s*'.b:comment_leader.'.*\\n\\)'.
|
||||
\ '\\(^\\s*'.b:comment_leader.'\\)\\@!'
|
||||
let b:comment_end = '\(^\s*'.b:comment_leader.'.*\n\)'.
|
||||
\ '\(^\s*'.b:comment_leader.'\)\@!'
|
||||
" Skip over the comment
|
||||
let b:comment_jump_over = "call search('".
|
||||
\ '^\\(\\s*'.b:comment_leader.'.*\\n\\)\\@<!'.
|
||||
\ '^\(\s*'.b:comment_leader.'.*\n\)\@<!'.
|
||||
\ "', 'W')"
|
||||
let b:comment_skip_back = "call search('".
|
||||
\ '^\\(\\s*'.b:comment_leader.'.*\\n\\)\\@<!'.
|
||||
\ '^\(\s*'.b:comment_leader.'.*\n\)\@<!'.
|
||||
\ "', 'bW')"
|
||||
" Move to the start and end of comments
|
||||
exec 'nnoremap <silent><buffer> ]" :call search('."'".b:comment_start."'".', "W" )<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'nnoremap <silent><buffer> [" :call search('."'".b:comment_end."'".', "W" )<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'vnoremap <silent><buffer> ]" :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('."'".b:comment_start."'".', "W" )<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'vnoremap <silent><buffer> [" :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('."'".b:comment_end."'".', "W" )<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'xnoremap <silent><buffer> ]" :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('."'".b:comment_start."'".', "W" )<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'xnoremap <silent><buffer> [" :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('."'".b:comment_end."'".', "W" )<CR>'
|
||||
|
||||
" Comments can be of the form:
|
||||
" /*
|
||||
@@ -431,7 +448,7 @@ exec 'vnoremap <silent><buffer> [" :<C-U>exec "normal! gv"<Bar>call search('."'"
|
||||
" or
|
||||
" --
|
||||
" or
|
||||
" //
|
||||
" //
|
||||
setlocal comments=s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,:--,://
|
||||
|
||||
" Set completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O to autoloaded function.
|
||||
@@ -443,7 +460,7 @@ if exists('&omnifunc')
|
||||
|
||||
" This is used by the sqlcomplete.vim plugin
|
||||
" Source it for it's global functions
|
||||
runtime autoload/syntaxcomplete.vim
|
||||
runtime autoload/syntaxcomplete.vim
|
||||
|
||||
setlocal omnifunc=sqlcomplete#Complete
|
||||
" Prevent the intellisense plugin from loading
|
||||
@@ -451,32 +468,32 @@ if exists('&omnifunc')
|
||||
if !exists('g:omni_sql_no_default_maps')
|
||||
" Static maps which use populate the completion list
|
||||
" using Vim's syntax highlighting rules
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'a <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("syntax")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'k <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("sqlKeyword")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'f <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("sqlFunction")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'o <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("sqlOption")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'T <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("sqlType")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'s <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("sqlStatement")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'a <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("syntax")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'k <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("sqlKeyword")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'f <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("sqlFunction")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'o <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("sqlOption")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'T <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("sqlType")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'s <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("sqlStatement")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
" Dynamic maps which use populate the completion list
|
||||
" using the dbext.vim plugin
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'t <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("table")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'p <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("procedure")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'v <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("view")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'c <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("column")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'l <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("column_csv")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'t <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("table")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'p <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("procedure")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'v <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("view")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'c <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("column")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'l <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("column_csv")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
" The next 3 maps are only to be used while the completion window is
|
||||
" active due to the <CR> at the beginning of the map
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'L <C-Y><C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("column_csv")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'L <C-Y><C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("column_csv")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
" <C-Right> is not recognized on most Unix systems, so only create
|
||||
" these additional maps on the Windows platform.
|
||||
" If you would like to use these maps, choose a different key and make
|
||||
" the same map in your vimrc.
|
||||
" if has('win32')
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key_right.' <C-R>=sqlcomplete#DrillIntoTable()<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key_left.' <C-R>=sqlcomplete#DrillOutOfColumns()<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key_right.' <C-R>=sqlcomplete#DrillIntoTable()<CR>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key_left.' <C-R>=sqlcomplete#DrillOutOfColumns()<CR>'
|
||||
" endif
|
||||
" Remove any cached items useful for schema changes
|
||||
exec 'imap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'R <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("resetCache")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
exec 'inoremap <buffer> '.g:ftplugin_sql_omni_key.'R <C-\><C-O>:call sqlcomplete#Map("resetCache")<CR><C-X><C-O>'
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
if b:sql_compl_savefunc != ""
|
||||
|
||||
151
runtime/ftplugin/zimbu.vim
Normal file
151
runtime/ftplugin/zimbu.vim
Normal file
@@ -0,0 +1,151 @@
|
||||
" Vim filetype plugin file
|
||||
" Language: Zimbu
|
||||
" Maintainer: Bram Moolenaar <Bram@vim.org>
|
||||
" Last Change: 2012 Sep 08
|
||||
|
||||
" Only do this when not done yet for this buffer
|
||||
if exists("b:did_ftplugin")
|
||||
finish
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Don't load another plugin for this buffer
|
||||
let b:did_ftplugin = 1
|
||||
|
||||
" Using line continuation here.
|
||||
let s:cpo_save = &cpo
|
||||
set cpo-=C
|
||||
|
||||
let b:undo_ftplugin = "setl fo< com< ofu< efm< tw< et< sts< sw< | if has('vms') | setl isk< | endif"
|
||||
|
||||
" Set 'formatoptions' to break comment lines but not other lines,
|
||||
" and insert the comment leader when hitting <CR> or using "o".
|
||||
setlocal fo-=t fo+=croql
|
||||
|
||||
" Set completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O to autoloaded function.
|
||||
if exists('&ofu')
|
||||
setlocal ofu=ccomplete#Complete
|
||||
endif
|
||||
|
||||
" Set 'comments' to format dashed lists in comments.
|
||||
" And to keep Zudocu comment characters.
|
||||
setlocal comments=sO:#\ -,mO:#\ \ ,:#=,:#-,:#%,:#
|
||||
|
||||
setlocal errorformat^=%f\ line\ %l\ col\ %c:\ %m,ERROR:\ %m
|
||||
|
||||
" When the matchit plugin is loaded, this makes the % command skip parens and
|
||||
" braces in comments.
|
||||
let b:match_words = '\(^\s*\)\@<=\(MODULE\|CLASS\|INTERFACE\|BITS\|ENUM\|SHARED\|FUNC\|REPLACE\|DEFINE\|PROC\|EQUAL\|MAIN\|IF\|GENERATE_IF\|WHILE\|REPEAT\|WITH\|DO\|FOR\|SWITCH\|TRY\)\>\|{\s*$:\(^\s*\)\@<=\(ELSE\|ELSEIF\|GENERATE_ELSE\|GENERATE_ELSEIF\|CATCH\|FINALLY\)\>:\(^\s*\)\@<=\(}\|\<UNTIL\>\)'
|
||||
|
||||
let b:match_skip = 's:comment\|string\|zimbuchar'
|
||||
|
||||
setlocal tw=78
|
||||
setlocal et sts=2 sw=2
|
||||
|
||||
" Does replace when a dot, space or closing brace is typed.
|
||||
func! GCUpperDot(what)
|
||||
if v:char != ' ' && v:char != "\r" && v:char != "\x1b" && v:char != '.' && v:char != ')' && v:char != '}' && v:char != ','
|
||||
" no space or dot after the typed text
|
||||
let g:got_char = v:char
|
||||
return a:what
|
||||
endif
|
||||
return GCUpperCommon(a:what)
|
||||
endfunc
|
||||
|
||||
" Does not replace when a dot is typed.
|
||||
func! GCUpper(what)
|
||||
if v:char != ' ' && v:char != "\r" && v:char != "\x1b" && v:char != ')' && v:char != ','
|
||||
" no space or other "terminating" character after the typed text
|
||||
let g:got_char = v:char
|
||||
return a:what
|
||||
endif
|
||||
return GCUpperCommon(a:what)
|
||||
endfunc
|
||||
|
||||
" Only replaces when a space is typed.
|
||||
func! GCUpperSpace(what)
|
||||
if v:char != ' '
|
||||
" no space after the typed text
|
||||
let g:got_char = v:char
|
||||
return a:what
|
||||
endif
|
||||
return GCUpperCommon(a:what)
|
||||
endfunc
|
||||
|
||||
func! GCUpperCommon(what)
|
||||
let col = col(".") - strlen(a:what)
|
||||
if col > 1 && getline('.')[col - 2] != ' '
|
||||
" no space before the typed text
|
||||
let g:got_char = 999
|
||||
return a:what
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let synName = synIDattr(synID(line("."), col(".") - 2, 1), "name")
|
||||
if synName =~ 'Comment\|String\|zimbuCregion\|\<c'
|
||||
" inside a comment or C code
|
||||
let g:got_char = 777
|
||||
return a:what
|
||||
endif
|
||||
let g:got_char = 1111
|
||||
return toupper(a:what)
|
||||
endfunc
|
||||
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> alias GCUpperSpace("alias")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> arg GCUpperDot("arg")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> break GCUpper("break")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> case GCUpperSpace("case")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> catch GCUpperSpace("catch")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> check GCUpperDot("check")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> class GCUpperSpace("class")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> interface GCUpperSpace("interface")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> implements GCUpperSpace("implements")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> shared GCUpperSpace("shared")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> continue GCUpper("continue")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> default GCUpper("default")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> extends GCUpper("extends")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> do GCUpper("do")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> else GCUpper("else")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> elseif GCUpperSpace("elseif")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> enum GCUpperSpace("enum")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> exit GCUpper("exit")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> false GCUpper("false")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> fail GCUpper("fail")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> finally GCUpper("finally")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> for GCUpperSpace("for")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> func GCUpperSpace("func")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> if GCUpperSpace("if")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> import GCUpperSpace("import")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> in GCUpperSpace("in")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> io GCUpperDot("io")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> main GCUpper("main")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> module GCUpperSpace("module")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> new GCUpper("new")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> nil GCUpper("nil")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> ok GCUpper("ok")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> proc GCUpperSpace("proc")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> proceed GCUpper("proceed")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> return GCUpper("return")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> step GCUpperSpace("step")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> switch GCUpperSpace("switch")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> sys GCUpperDot("sys")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> this GCUpperDot("this")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> throw GCUpperSpace("throw")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> try GCUpper("try")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> to GCUpperSpace("to")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> true GCUpper("true")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> until GCUpperSpace("until")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> while GCUpperSpace("while")
|
||||
iabbr <buffer> <expr> repeat GCUpper("repeat")
|
||||
|
||||
nnoremap <silent> <buffer> [[ m`:call ZimbuGoStartBlock()<CR>
|
||||
nnoremap <silent> <buffer> ]] m`:call ZimbuGoEndBlock()<CR>
|
||||
|
||||
" Using a function makes sure the search pattern is restored
|
||||
func! ZimbuGoStartBlock()
|
||||
?^\s*\(FUNC\|PROC\|MAIN\|ENUM\|CLASS\|INTERFACE\)\>
|
||||
endfunc
|
||||
func! ZimbuGoEndBlock()
|
||||
/^\s*\(FUNC\|PROC\|MAIN\|ENUM\|CLASS\|INTERFACE\)\>
|
||||
endfunc
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
let &cpo = s:cpo_save
|
||||
unlet s:cpo_save
|
||||
Some files were not shown because too many files have changed in this diff Show More
Reference in New Issue
Block a user